NHBC
NHBC
NHBC
Standards 2017
Mike Quinton
NHBC Chief Executive
Designed and produced by NHBC
Contents 2017
Contents
Welcome Part 1
Contents
Contact us
Whats changed
Introduction Part 2
2.1 The Standards and Technical Requirements
General Part 3
3.1 Concrete and its reinforcement
3.2 Cold weather working
3.3 Timber preservation (natural solid timber)
Foundations Part 4
4.1 Land quality managing ground conditions
4.2 Building near trees
4.3 Strip and trench fill foundations
4.4 Raft, pile, pier and beam foundations
4.5 Vibratory ground improvement techniques
Substructure, ground floors, drainage and basements Part 5
5.1 Substructure and ground bearing floors
5.2 Suspended ground floors
5.3 Drainage below ground
5.4 Waterproofing of basements and other below ground structures
Superstructure (excluding roofs) Part 6
6.1 External masonry walls
6.2 External timber framed walls
6.3 Internal walls
6.4 Timber and concrete upper floors
6.5 Steelwork
6.6 Staircases
6.7 Doors, windows and glazing
6.8 Fireplaces, chimneys and flues
6.9 Curtain walling and cladding
6.10 Light steel framed walls and floors
6.11 Render new
Roofs Part 7
7.1 Flat roofs and balconies
7.2 Pitched roofs
Services Part 8
8.1 Internal services
8.2 Low or zero carbon technologies
8.3 Mechanical ventilation with heat recovery
Finishes Part 9
9.1 A consistent approach to finishes
9.2 Wall and ceiling finishes
9.3 Floor finishes
9.4 Finishes and fitments
9.5 Painting and decorating
External works Part 10
10.1 Garages
10.2 Drives, paths and landscaping
Contact information
Standards Plus The online version of the NHBC Standards 2017 Standards Plus is freely available
to all visitors to the NHBC website. Complete with supplementary technical content and
further guidance notes, supporting links to external sites and 3D animations, Standards Plus
expands and optimises the NHBC Standards 2017 for use on desktop and mobile devices.
Visit: www.nhbc.co.uk/Standardsplus2017
For any questions or comments regarding Standards Plus,
Email: [email protected]
Whats changed?
Major technical changes
The following major technical changes have been made to Standards 2017:
Chapter 6.11 Render introduced.
of homes acceptable to NHBC. The home is defined in NHBC Rules for builders and developers registered with NHBC.
The Standards come into effect for everyNHBC registered home whose foundationsare begun on or after 1 January 2017,
and they apply throughout the UK, unlessotherwise stated.
Composition of theStandards
The Standards are divided into 10 Parts, each covering a particular element and subdivided into chapters which, in principle, follow
the normal build sequence (the list of chapters is shown in the Contents section of Part 1). The front cover of each chapter contains
its scope, together with a list of its contents.
Technical Requirements
The Technical Requirements are shown in red text in this chapter, and must be met by the builder.
Performance standards
The performance standards support the Technical Requirements and are shown in bold black text backed with a shaded box.
Where the performance standards are followed, the Technical Requirements for that particular item of work will be met.
Alternative standards of performance will be acceptable only if, in the opinion of NHBC, the Technical Requirements for that
particular item of work are met and the standard achieved is not lower than the stated performance standard.
Guidance
Guidance on how the performance standard may be met is shown in black text and is based on normal construction procedures
and recommended practices which have been shown to be satisfactory and acceptable over time. NHBC will consider alternative
methods to meet specific requirements, subject to prior consultation and evaluation.
Guidance is also contained in illustrations and digital 3D models.
Guidance is provided to demonstrate specific technical principles, and should not be used as working construction details.
Limitations on use
The Technical Requirements, performancestandards and guidance form acceptable technical benchmarks for a particular item
of work, but do not form a complete specification and should not beused as such in contracts.Individual chapters cover, as far
as practical, the requirements for particularelements of construction. To avoid repetition, some cross-referencing is made
between chapters.
The NHBC Standards do not apply to:
health and safety matters relating to building operations
planning matters except where specifically referred to in
these Standards.
Such matters are covered by statutory requirements.
Interpretation
Where a difference exists in how to interpret the Technical Requirements,performance standards and guidance, this would generally
be resolved by further consultation,failing which, NHBC will exercise its right todecide in accordance with the NHBC Rules.
Testing
Where required, samples of materials, products andsystems shall be tested in accordance with Technical Requirement R3 and the
NHBC Rules.
2.1
the time of Building Regulation approval, unless other recommendations are agreed by NHBC in writing.
The standards referred to in the NHBC Standards comprise specifications, codes of practice and published documents that are
published by BSI, the European Committee for Standardization (CEN) and the International Organization for Standardization (ISO).
Tolerances
All work shall be within acceptable tolerances. Where applicable, account should be taken of Chapter 9.1 A consistent approach
to finishes. In other situations, tolerances will be those currently acceptable in the house-building industry.
Acknowledgements
NHBC is indebted to members of the Standards Committee, the Standards Review Group, the Scottish Technical Subcommittee and
the Northern Ireland Technical Subcommittee for their work in developing and maintaining the NHBC Standards.
NHBC also wishes to acknowledge thehelp given by consultants, authoritativeorganisations, individuals and staff.
Technical Requirements
The Builder shall ensure that the work complies with the Technical Requirements.
R1 Statutory requirements
Work shall comply with all relevant Building Regulations and other statutory requirements relating to the completed
construction work.
NHBC will generally accept work that accords with relevant Building Regulations/Building Standards and supporting documents.
Exceptions would be where NHBC has a higher standard.
R2 Design requirement
Design and specification shall provide satisfactory performance.
Account shall be taken of:
a) The land quality, including:
i)
climate
ii)
topography
iii)
geology and ground conditions
iv)
contamination
v)
workings below ground
vi)
previous use of the site
vii) any other aspect, on or adjacent to the site, which could affect the design.
Where appropriate, the land quality will have to be determined by a person acceptable to NHBC.
b) The structural adequacy of the works. The design, with appropriate factors of safety, shall satisfactorily allow for loads during and
after construction and for their transfer to the supporting structure, or foundation, without undue movement, including:
i)
self weight
ii)
all imposed loads, including wind loads
iii)
construction loads.
he geographical location of the site, including:
c) T
i)
exposure to wind and rain
ii)
topography.
d) The position of the dwelling on the site, especially with reference to the dwellings exposure to the weather, including at early
stages in the development of a site, even if it is eventually protected by structures built later.
e) The position of building elements within the construction works, including the interrelationship of materials and constructions.
he security of the dwellings.
f) T
R3 Materials requirement
All materials, products and building systems shall be suitable for their intended purpose.
2.1
The structure of the home shall, unless specifically agreed otherwise in writing with NHBC, have a life of at least 60 years.
Individual components and assemblies, not integral to the structure, may have a lesser durability and need planned maintenance,
repair or replacement during that period.
Account shall be taken of the use and location of materials, products and building systems in relation to:
durability of both the structure and individual components
position on the site
and assemblies position within the structure.
geographical location
Materials, products and building systems will normally be acceptable if they comply with the following:
a) MATERIALS AND PRODUCTS USED FOR CRITICAL FUNCTIONS
Functions critical to performance are: structure, fire resistance, weatherproofing, durability, thermal and sound insulation,
services including heating appliances and flues. Any of the following are acceptable:
i)
performance in accordance with standards set by NHBC, or
where no NHBC standard is set, compliance with the relevant British Standard or equivalent European Technical
ii)
Specification approved by a Committee for Standardisation, provided they are used in accordance with the relevant Code of
Practice, or
compliance with standards not lower than those defined in a relevant British Standard specification or equivalent, provided
iii)
their use is accepted by NHBC, or
iv)
satisfactory assessment by an appropriate independent technical approvals authority accepted by NHBC, or
use of materials and products in accordance with well established satisfactory custom and practice, provided that such
v)
custom and practice is acceptable to NHBC, or
vi)
acceptance, in writing, by NHBC that the quality and use is satisfactory.
b) MATERIALS AND PRODUCTS USED FOR NON-CRITICAL FUNCTIONS
Compliance with the above acceptance criteria for critical functions or strictly in accordance with manufacturers
recommendations for the specific use.
c) RECLAIMED MATERIALS
Reclaimed materials may only be reused with the prior agreement of NHBC. Independent certification of suitability may
be required.
d) PROPRIETARY BUILDING SYSTEMS
Reference should be made to R3a iv.
e) TIMBER DURABILITY
Reference should be made to Chapter 3.3 Timber preservation (natural solid timber).
f) RECOVERED AGGREGATES
Aggregates derived from recovered inert waste, e.g. recycled aggregate, should only be used where it can be demonstrated
that the inert waste material has been fully recovered, has ceased to be a waste as defined by the Waste Framework Directive
2008 and has become a product. To this end, recovered aggregates produced by a supplier complying with a recognised defined
quality management scheme such as the WRAP Quality Protocoland meeting end-of-waste criteria, will be acceptable to NHBC.
Note
Equivalents to British Standards or technical approvals authority shall be those accepted in the UK.
R4 Workmanship requirement
All work shall be carried out in a proper, neat and workmanlike manner.
The Builder shall ensure that:
a) the conditions of the materials, products and the completed work are satisfactory
b) appropriate precautions are taken to prevent damage
c) account is taken of the following:
i)
the requirements of the design
ii)
suitable methods of unloadingand handling
iii)
proper protection during storage
iv)
use of correct installation methods
v)
protection against weather during construction (includingexcessive heat, cold, wetting or drying)
vi)
protection against damage by following trades.
2.1
Codes of Practice.
The following shall be designed by Chartered Civil or Structural Engineers whose status (including professional indemnity insurance)
is accepted by NHBC:
a) foundations on hazardous ground where the hazard makes special consideration necessary. (Note: This would not apply to
matters for which NHBC sets standards, such as building near trees, except where specified to the contrary)
b) foundations and superstructure of every building over three storeys in height
c) c ertain types of foundations and retaining walls, as required in the individual chapters of the NHBC Standards
d) any structural element which is not based on specific design criteria as laid down in the chapters of the NHBC Standards
e) any dwelling not constructed in accordance with UK traditional practice.
Note
Other structural elements may be designed by a Chartered Civil or Structural Engineer or others whose status
(including professional indemnity insurance) is accepted by NHBC.
The structural design shall take account of the durability requirement in Technical Requirement R3 Materials.
In England, Wales, Northern Ireland and the Isle of Man, structural design may be undertaken by the Builders own Engineer or
a Consulting Engineer employed by the Builder. Where specialist subcontractors undertake the design, it must be separately
appraised by the Builders own Engineer or by a Consulting Engineer employed by the Builder to ensure that the site investigation,
choice of foundations, siting and construction of dwellings are properly taken into account and that the design is appropriate for the
loading and conditions.
In Scotland, the Engineer shall be independent of the Builder and specialist subcontractor.
Account shall be taken of all parts of the following British Standards:
Eurocodes and their respective National Annexes.
BS EN 1993. Eurocode 3: Design of steel structures.
BS EN 1990. Eurocode 0: Basis of structural design.
BS EN 1995. Eurocode 5: Design of timber structures.
BS EN 1991. Eurocode 1: Actions on structures.
BS EN 1996. Eurocode 6: Design of masonry structures.
BS EN 1992. Eurocode 2: Design of concrete structures.
BS EN 1997. Eurocode 7: Geotechnical design.
Alternatively, designs in accordance with BS 8103 Structural design of low rise buildings will be acceptable.
The Builder shall:
require the Engineer to issue clear instructions for
require the Engineer or his representative to carry out such
site personnel inspections as may be required by NHBC to ensure the
not permit departure from the design without the Engineers
adequacy of the design and construction.
written consent
The Builder shall ensure that the Engineer visits the site during construction:
when the foundations have been designed under this
when specifically required by NHBC in these Standards.
Technical Requirement, or
The Engineer shall satisfy himself that the design is suitable for the conditions encountered on the site of each dwelling.
When requested by NHBC, the Builder shall:
produce such design documents, calculations and prescribed
arrange for NHBC staff to have access to places where
forms of certification as NHBC requires forscrutiny off-site fabrication is taking place.
provide design documents and assembly instructions,
3.1.1 Compliance 01
3.1.2 Provision of information 01
3.1.3 Storage of materials 01
3.1.4 Site-mixed concrete 01
3.1.5 Ready-mixed concrete 03
3.1.6 Concrete specification 03
3.1.7 Admixtures 06
3.1.8 Special types of concrete 07
3.1.9 Design of reinforced concrete 07
3.1.10 Installation of reinforcement 08
3.1.11 Blinding concrete 09
3.1.12 Formwork 09
3.1.13 Before concreting 09
3.1.14 Casting 09
3.1.15 Curing 10
3.1.16 Testing 10
3.1.17 Glossary 10
Introduction
Concrete design and specification should comply with the relevant British Standards. Mix design should take account
of strength and durability, and follow recognised standards and practices. Alternatively, mixes in accordance with the
guidance in this chapter will be acceptable. This applies to plain and reinforced concrete, whether precast or in-situ.
Concrete and its reinforcement that complies with the guidance in this chapter, which covers plain and reinforced concrete,
precast or in-situ, will generally be acceptable.
Mix design should take account of strength and durability, and comply with the relevant British Standards.
3.1
for concrete. shrinkable aggregates, aggregates susceptible
Mixed, and precautions taken, as described in
to alkali attack or excessive moisture
BRE Digest 357. movement, or unfamiliar materials are used.
Fine and/or of coarse proportions mixed as
Within the limits of the aggregate carbon range
specified. (ACR), when subject to aggressive sulfate
Proportioned to ensure a reasonable
ground conditions.
consistency, when supplied as a mixture. Assessed in accordance with Technical
Requirement R3 where materials are
recovered or proprietary.
The information below applies to cement strength class 32.5 and 20mm maximum aggregate size. Where cement strength class
42.5 or higher is used, the cement weight should be decreased by 10%.
Table 2: Mix proportions by weight
Standardised prescribed mix Consistence class (slump in mm) Cement (kg) Fine aggregate (kg) Coarse aggregate (kg)
ST1 S1 (10-40) 230 770 1155
ST2 S2 (50-90) 265 760 1135
ST2 S3 (100-150) 285 735 1105
ST2 S4 (160-210) 300 815 990
ST3 S2 (50-90) 295 745 1120
ST4 S2 (50-90) 330 735* 1100
ST5 S2 (50-90) 375 720* 1080
* Fine aggregate grading to be grades CP or MP only of BS EN 12620.
When designated mixes are used, the ready-mix supplier will only require the mix designation, and consistence class.
Ready-mixed concrete should be:
GEN mix
RC mix.
FND mix, or
Delivery information should be checked to ensure that the concrete meets the requirements given in the design.
Concrete specification 3.1.6 Also see: BRE Digest 357, BRE Special Digest 1, BS 8500, BS 8500-1 and BS EN 206-1
Concrete shall be specified correctly to ensure adequate strength and durability. Issues to be taken into
account include:
a) concrete in non-hazardous conditions e) effects of chlorides
b) exposure to climatic and atmospheric conditions f) effects of alkali-silica reaction
c) exposure to aggressive ground conditions g) aggregates.
d) exposure to sulfates and acids in groundwater
Concrete mixes should be suitable for particular end uses and specified in accordance with BS 8500-1 as either:
designated mix, which is supplied ready mixed, or
standardised prescribed mix for site mixing.
Designated mixes should conform to Table 5 of BS 8500-2:2012. Standardised prescribed mixes should conform to Tables 2 and 3 in
this chapter.
Mixes should also be designed for the expected conditions of the geographical location of the site and the location of the concrete
element in the structure. Higher grade concrete has greater resistance to chemical and mechanical damage and should be
specified accordingly.
In addition to the issues in this section, durability is reliant on:
correct control of the water:cement ratio
good curing.
full compaction of the placed concrete
3.1
General reinforced concrete exposure class(3) to BS8500-1:
Nominal cover to reinforcement of 35mm (which is the minimum
cover of 25mm plus an allowance in design for deviation of 10mm). RC30 (4)
S2
XC1 (dry) and XC2 (wet, rarely dry). RC40 S2
XC3 (moderate humidity), XC4 (cyclic wet and dry) and XF1
(freeze/thaw attack and no de-icing agent).
Nominal cover to reinforcement of 40mm (which is the minimum
cover of 30mm plus an allowance in design for deviation of 10mm). RC35 (5)
S2
Any exposure class (XC1-4 and XF1).
In-situ external concrete
Drives and paths. PAV1 ST5(6) S2
Foundations for precast concrete paving slabs. GEN1 ST1 S1
Notes
1
Consistence class S3 should be used for strip foundation concrete and consistence class S4 should be used for trench fill foundation concrete.
2 ST4 mix for house and garage floors may only be used in conjunction with Chapter 5.2 Suspended ground floors. In all other cases, the designated mix should
be used.
3 Exposure classes (XC1-4 and XF1) are defined in BS 8500-1 Table A.1.
4 In this situation, ST4 mix may be used only for small quantities of concrete. In all other cases, the appropriate designated mix should be used.
5 In this situation, an ST5 mix may be used only for small quantities of concrete. In all other cases, the appropriate designated mix should be used.
6
Not suitable in areas of severe exposure to frost attack. This is equivalent to exposure class XC4 above.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
SO4 Mg SO4 Mg SO4 pH pH pH(5) pH(5)
mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l %
DS-1 <500 All Mg <400 All Mg <0.24 >2.5 >2.5 AC-1s
values values >5.5(6) >6.5 AC-1
2.5 -5.5 5.5-6.5 AC-2z
4.5-5.5 AC-3z
2.5-4.5 AC-4z
DS-2 500-1500 All Mg 400-1400 All Mg 0.24- >3.5 >5.5 AC-1s
values values 0.6 >5.5 >6.5 AC-2
2.5-3.5 2.5-5.5 AC-2s
2.5-5.5 5.5-6.5 AC-3z
4.5-5.5 AC-4z
<4.5 AC-5z
Notes
1
For concrete quality and APM for ACEC classes above AC-2z, follow specialist advice. For the full list of ACEC classes, refer to Table A.2 of BS 8500-1 or
BRE Special Digest Part C Table C1 for natural ground locations, and Table C2 for brownfield locations.
2 Applies only to sites where concrete will be exposed to sulfate ions (SO4), which may result from the oxidation of sulfides such as pyrite, following ground disturbance.
3 Applies to locations on sites that comprise either undisturbed ground that is in its natural state or clean fill derived from such ground.
4 Brownfield is defined as sites which may contain chemical residues remaining from previous industrial use or from imported wastes.
5 An additional account is taken of hydrochloric and nitric acids by adjustment to sulfate content.
6 For flowing water that is potentially aggressive to concrete owing to high purity or an aggressive carbon dioxide level greater than 15mg/l, increase the ACEC class to
AC-2z.
3.1
Effects of chlorides
Chlorides, which are contained in all concrete materials, increase the risk of corrosion in metal and can reduce the chemical
resistance of concrete, therefore chloride content of fresh concrete should be limited in accordance with BS EN 206-1 Table 10.
Cured concrete can be damaged by chlorides in the ground, sea spray, or products used for de-icing highways, and specialist
guidance should be followed.
Alkali content calculated in accordance with BRE Digest 330 or Concrete Society Technical Report 30 should not exceed 3kg/m3.
Where unfamiliar aggregate materials are used, special precautions may be required.
Standardised prescribed mixes should conform to BS 8500.
Aggregates
Aggregates should be of a grade which ensures adequate durability of the concrete. Certain types of aggregate are shrinkable
and require special precautions in mixing. Certain types of aggregate may be susceptible to alkali attack or excessive
moisture movement.
Proprietary and recovered aggregates should only be specified where they have been assessed in accordance with Technical
Requirement R3.
Admixtures 3.1.7
Admixtures shall only be used to enhance the performance and durability of concrete.
Issues that should be taken into account include:
improved workability
accelerated strength
waterproofing
retardation
foaming agents
chlorides.
Admixtures should comply with BS EN 934-2 Admixtures for concrete mortar and grout - Concrete admixtures - Definitions,
requirements, conformity, marking and labelling, should be used in accordance with BS EN 206-1 should be:
specified only with full knowledge of their limitations
added to the mix water to ensure complete dispersal
and effects dosed correctly
used only where permitted in the specification
used strictly in accordance with the
tested in trial mixes, where necessary
manufacturers instructions.
Accelerators produce early setting of the concrete, and plasticisers can improve concrete cohesion and the bond with reinforcement.
Air-entraining agents should not be used as an anti-freeze for fresh concrete. Though they can increase the frost resistance of cured
concrete and are recommended for paths, drives and pavements which are likely to be exposed to freezing conditions.
Retarding agents can increase the risk of frost damage.
Admixtures containing chlorides can cause metal corrosion and should not be used in reinforced concrete.
Reinforced concrete should be designed by an engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5. BS 8103-4 can be used for
the design of suspended ground floors in homes and garages.
End restraint
Where the ends of slabs are cast monolithically with concrete members, surface cracking may develop over the supports.
Reinforcement should therefore be provided in accordance with BS EN 1992-1-1.
Concrete cover
There should be adequate cover to the reinforcement,
especially where it is exposed or in contact with the ground.
Cover should be adequate for all reinforcement, including
main bars and stirrups. No ties or clips should protrude into the
concrete cover. cover measured
between links
For concrete not designed by an engineer, the minimum cover and formwork
for reinforcement should be in accordance with Table 8.
Table 8: Minimum cover for reinforcement for concrete not designed by an engineer
Position of the concrete Minimum cover (mm)
In contact with the ground. 75
External conditions. 50
Cast against a DPM on sand blinding. 40
Against adequate blinding concrete. 40
Protected or internal conditions. 25
Fire resistance
Concrete cover to reinforcement should be adequate to resist fire. Requirements for fire resistance are given in BS EN 1992-1-2.
Cover required by BS EN 1992-1-1 will normally provide up to one hour of fire resistance for columns, simply supported beams
and floors.
Carbonation
Carbonation reduces the corrosion protection of the reinforcement by increasing porosity and decreasing alkalinity. Such corrosion
can be reduced by providing as much concrete cover as possible, and by ensuring that the wet concrete is of good quality and
properly compacted to reduce the rate of carbonation.
3.1
Installation of reinforcement 3.1.10 Also see: Chapter 5.2
Reinforcement shall be installed in accordance with the design. Issues to take into account include:
a) shape, placing and condition of reinforcement bars c) support for reinforcement.
b) lapping bars and mesh
mild steel
supporting
top layer
Formwork 3.1.12
3.1
Reinforced concrete should be fully compacted using poker vibration unless the design states otherwise. Poker vibration should be
carried out by experienced operators to ensure complete coverage and to avoid honeycombing. Vibrating beams or hand tamping
may be used to consolidate slabs up to 150mm thick, unless the design details otherwise. Excessive use of vibration can cause
segregation and prevent concrete reaching an adequate strength.
3.1
Freshly poured concrete should be kept moist by covering as soon as the surface is hard enough to resist damage. This is
particularly important in hot, windy or cold weather to to prevent the surface drying out too rapidly, or freezing. Damp hessian,
damp sharp sand or an impervious sheet (such as polyethylene) are acceptable as surface coverings. Alternatively, a curing agent
can be applied to the surface.
No load should be applied to the work until the concrete has cured sufficiently. It is recommended that plain unreinforced concrete
made with ordinary Portland cement is left for at least four days to cure.
It is possible to proceed with substructure masonry above strip or trench fill foundations on unreinforced ordinary Portland cement
concrete at an early stage, provided that care is taken to protect the surface from damage.
Reinforced concrete or concrete containing cement replacements, such as PFA, will require a longer curing period. This will normally
take seven days, during which the concrete structure should not be loaded.
Any curing agents should comply with Technical Requirement R3 and should be applied strictly in accordance with the
manufacturers instructions. Curing agents should never be used on floors which are to receive either a topping or a screed, as it
could affect the future bond. Curing periods may be extended at low temperatures.
Testing 3.1.16
Testing shall be carried out to the full satisfaction of NHBC.
Testing, where required, shall be conducted to BS EN 12390 by UKAS approved laboratories. Test cubes should be prepared as
requested by the engineer. These should be marked, cured and stored safely until testing.
Proof of testing, with reports, certificates and allied documentation, should be kept for reference and made available to NHBC
upon request.
Ready-mixed concrete supplier should prepare test cubes in accordance with quality assurance procedures.
Glossary 3.1.17
Aggressive chemical A system for the classification of aggressive ground conditions that are derived from
environment for concrete design sulfate class. It takes into account the site (natural or brownfield) and the mobility and
classification (ACEC class) pH of ground water. Brownfield, mobile water and low pH (acidic) conditions may have adverse
effects on buried concrete and hence result in a more severe ACEC class.
Additional protective These are defined as the extra measures that could be taken to protect concrete where the basic
measures (APM) concrete specification might not give adequate resistance to chemical attack.
Design chemical class This defines the qualities of concrete that are required to resist chemical attack. The DC class
(DC class) is derived from the ACEC class of the ground and other factors, including the type of concrete
element and its required structural performance.
Design sulfate class A site classification based on the determined sulfate (including potential sulfate) contents of
(DS class) the ground and/or ground water. It is also dependent on the type of site, presence or absence
of magnesium ions, pyrite, and for pH less than 5.5, chloride and nitrate ions. Five levels of
classification are given that are equivalent to those given in BRE Digest 363 (now superseded).
Enhanced concrete quality An incremental step in concrete quality that could be used as an Additional Protective Measure
(APM). Each increment in concrete quality is counted as an extra APM.
Mobile ground water Sites where water is free to flow into an excavation to give a standing water level are affected by
mobile ground water. The threshold ground permeability is greater than 10-6 m/s (i.e. 86 mm/day).
Static ground water The sites where the free flow of water is confined due to either permanently dry conditions or the
soil is relatively impermeable (of permeability less than 10-6 m/s).
Total potential sulfate (TPS) The total potential sulfate content is the result of the combination of sulfates already present in the
ground and that which may be added due to the oxidation of pyrite in the ground.
3.2.1 Compliance 01
3.2.2 External conditions 01
3.2.3 Materials 01
3.2.4 Concreting 01
3.2.5 Masonry 02
3.2.6 Rendering, plastering andscreeding 02
3.2.7 Admixtures 03
3.2.8 Painting 03
stopping work, or
taking adequate precautions.
The following conditions should be considered when scheduling work:
Wind (this can create a cooling effect which can reduce
Shade (in particular high trees or adjacent buildings can
temperatures further, i.e. affecting the curing of concrete block low winter sun and reduce temperatures further).
and mortar). Valleys (sites in valleys are susceptible to increased
risk of frost).
Where air temperature is below, or likely to fall below, 2C, work should not proceed unless the precautions detailed in this chapter
are adopted.
A thermometer should be sited in the shade and used to indicate if temperatures are rising or falling.
Materials 3.2.3
Materials shall beadequately protected against cold weather.
Materials should:
not be used if frozen
be protected using appropriate covers to prevent damage by
snow, ice, frost or damp.
Appropriate covers should be provided for bricks and blocks,
sand,aggregates and cement, to prevent themfrom becoming
saturated and damaged by frost.
Where it is necessary to continue building during longer periods
of colder weather, heaters should be used to protect materials.
Concreting 3.2.4 Also see: BS EN 13670 Table 4 Curing class 2 and Table F1 Curing class 2
Concrete shall not be placed in cold weather unless suitable precautions are taken.
The minimum temperature of ready-mixed concrete when
delivered should be 5C, in accordance with BS EN 206-1.
When concreting is undertaken during colder weather,
curing periods should be adjusted according to
environmental conditions. Concrete should:
be covered to maintain the temperatureabove freezing,
and heated if necessary
not be placed where the ground, oversite or the surfaces that
will be in contact with the concrete are frozen
be placed with caution where small quantities of fresh
concrete are against a large volume of hardened concrete
which is at a lower temperature.
Where slight overnight frosts are expected, 50mm of insulation held down firmly at the edges should be used to help protect
oversite concrete. Where very severe frosts are expected, insulationalone is inadequate and heating should be provided.
Site-mixed concrete
If the air temperature drops to 2C, concrete work should not proceed unless:
the ground into which the concrete is to be placed is
the water for mixing is heated, but not above 60C
not frozen (cement should not be heated)
the aggregate temperature is above 2C
the cast concrete can be properly protected, taking account
the aggregate is free of frost and snow
of the cross-sectional area and location.
3.2
where work is to continue, it may be necessary to steam
heat aggregates or to use hot air blowers below covers remain frozen.
Masonry 3.2.5
Masonry shall not be laid in cold weather unless suitable precautions are taken.
When laying masonry in cold weather:
and temperatures are below, or are likely to fall below,
low temperatures
polyethylene covers should be used to provide protection and
be required
protection against frost may be required for up to six days,
Admixtures 3.2.7
Admixtures shall be used correctly and in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
When using admixtures:
accelerators may assist the mortar or concrete to set before
in cold weather, retarding agents should not be used as they
temperatures fall (admixtures do not prevent frost damage to can increase the setting times of cement
uncured concrete or mortar) in cold weather, bonding agents may be ineffective
plasticisers can entrain air during mixing to provide frost
those containing calcium chloride should be avoided.
resistance to mature mortar and concrete
3.2
Painting 3.2.8
Painting shall not be carried out when there is a risk of damage due to cold weather.
Paint should not be applied:
on surfaces affected by damp, frost or condensation
when condensation, snow or rain is likely to affect paintwork
where the air temperature is below, or likely to fall below, 2C
before it is dry.
3.3.1 Compliance 01
3.3.2 Durability 01
3.3.3 Sitework 03
3.3.4 Protection and storage 03
3.3.5 Treatment of cut surfaces 03
3.3.6 Compatibility with metal 03
3.3.7 Further information 03
Introduction
This chapter gives acceptable treatment schedules for the treatment of natural solid timber but does not cover:
products such as plywood and wood particle boards
the condition before the treatment
treatment process techniques, which is the responsibility of the organisation carrying out the operation.
ensure that the timber is safely and satisfactorily protected against fungal decay and insect attack.
Timber preservative treatments that comply with the guidance in this chapter will generally be acceptable. Timber and external
joinery should either be:
naturally durable and resistant to insect attack, or
treated with preservative in accordance with this chapter.
It is important that treatment of timber and joinery is carried out to appropriate standards which are both suitable and safe.
Treatments in accordance with procedures set out in British Standards, Codes of Practice, or which have been satisfactorily
assessed by an independent authority in accordance with Technical Requirement R3, will generally be acceptable. The specification
should state the specific treatment and standard required.
All preservatives should meet the requirements of the Control of Pesticides Regulations (1986) administered by the Health and
Safety Executive. The safety instructions published by the manufacturers should be followed.
Durability 3.3.2
Timber and joinery used in the construction of homes shall either have adequate natural durability or, where
treatment is undertaken, receive a satisfactory preservative treatment against fungal decay and insect attack.
Timber component groups and preservative treatment required are shown in Table 1 below (based on BS 8417), which provides
information to establish the appropriate type of treatment according to the particular element and conditions of use. Table 2 provides
information on the timber species and durability.
Table 1: Timber component groups and preservative treatment
Component Examples Use Desired Preservative type required Preservative treatment
group class service not required
life Copper Water- Organic Boron(2)
organic(1) based solvent or
organic(1) microemul-
sion(1)
3.3
heartwood only(3) and of
durability class 1 2(4).
External joinery, Window frames, door frames, 3 30 (7) (7)
Where timber used is
coated (not in doors, cladding (coated), heartwood only(3) and of
ground contact)(6) soffits, fascias, barge boards durability class 1 2(4).
Uncoated external Decking (where the deck is up 3 15 Where timber used is
timbers (not in to 600mm from ground level) heartwood only(3) and of
ground contact) (8)
, cladding (uncoated) durability class 1 2(4).
Timber in contact Decking timber in ground 4 15 Where timber used is
with the ground contact (where the deck heartwood only(3) and of
is up to 600mm from durability class 1 2(4).
ground level)(8)
Timber in contact Timber retaining walls up to 4 15 Where timber used is
with the ground 1m high and within heartwood only(3) and of
garden areas(7) durability class 1 2(4).
Timber in contact Timber retaining walls greater 4 30 Where timber used is
with the ground than 1m high and within heartwood only(3) and of
garden areas(7) durability class 1(4).
Timber in contact Timber retaining walls up 4 30 Where timber used is
with the ground to 600mm high and in a heartwood only(3) and of
boundary situation(9) durability class 1(4).
Notes
1.Preservative treatment of timber should be in accordance with the recommendations of BS 8417, Table 4.
2.Preservative treatment of timber should be in accordance with the recommendations of BS 8417, Table 5.
3.Almost always, packs of timber contain sapwood. It should be assumed that timber is sapwood and preservative treated accordingly unless the timber has been
specifically selected as heartwood only.
4.Natural durability classes are given in Table 2.
5.Sole plates should be positioned above DPC. Preservatives used should be resistant to leaching or, for boron, treatment should be to full cross-section retention
standard. Treatment should be carried out in accordance with BS 8417.
6.The hardwoods known as Meranti, Seraya or Lauan should be treated in the same way as European redwood / Scots Pine when used for joinery.
7.The pressure treatment process used for these types of preservative will cause timber to swell, so these treatments are generally not used for window or door frames
and other uses where dimensional precision is required.
8.Decking that is more than 600mm in height should have a desired service life of 60 years. Reference should be made to Chapters 7.1 Flat roofs and balconies and 10.2
Drives, paths and landscaping.
9.Where timber structures more than 600mm high are used for retaining ground in boundary situations, they should be designed with a desired service life of 60 years.
Reference should be made to Chapter 10.2 Drives, paths and landscaping.
Pine
(Caribbean pitch, western white)
American pitch) Fir (noble, silver, balsam,
Cedar
grand)
(UK western red) Hem-fir (USA and Canada)
Redwood (European)
Sitework 3.3.3
Sitework shall follow established good practice and workmanship.
Checks should ensure that, when timber is delivered to site, timber and joinery products have received the specified treatment.
This should be stated on the delivery note.
4.1.1 Compliance 01
4.1.2 Initial Assessment desk study
(all sites) 03
4.1.3 Initial Assessment walkover survey
(all sites) 04
4.1.4 Initial Assessment results 04
4.1.5 Basic Investigation
(sites where hazards are not
identified or suspected) 05
4.1.6 Detailed Investigation
(sites where hazards are identified
or suspected) 05
4.1.7 Managing the risks
(sites where hazards are found) 06
4.1.8 Unforeseen hazards 06
4.1.9 Documentation and verification 07
4.1.10 Guidance for investigations 07
4.1.11 Further information 08
Introduction
This chapter provides a framework for managing geotechnical and contamination risks, with the objective of ensuring that:
all sites are properly assessed and investigated for potential geotechnical and contamination hazards
foundations and substructure designs are suitable for the ground conditions
sites are properly remediated where necessary or appropriate, and design precautions are taken
appropriate documentation and verification is provided to NHBC.
Ground investigations and management of risk that complies with the guidance in this chapter will generally be acceptable.
The following criteria should be used as guidance for the appointment of a consultant or specialist responsible for Detailed
Investigation, management of hazards, documentation and verification:
Experience Similar types of site and development.
Appropriate discipline (s) Understanding of all relevant skills required on the project and access to other disciplines,
including geologists, hydrogeologists, toxicologists and environmental chemists.
Legislation Understanding of legislation and liabilities associated with the site.
Professional indemnity insurance Appropriate cover for the work being carried out.
Health and safety Awareness of occupational hygiene issues and Health and Safety legislation.
Quality assurance Use of a quality management system, including appropriately accredited laboratories.
Project management Ability to manage a project team consisting of the appropriate disciplines.
Site investigation Ability to design site investigation programmes, including soil sampling, testing and
laboratory analysis.
Risk management Ability to conduct risk assessments as required by the risk management process.
Reporting and communication Ability to prepare comprehensive and well presented reports. Effective communication within
their organisation and with the client, statutory authorities and the general public.
Engineering design Understanding of effective risk reduction techniques, e.g. engineered foundations and
substructure details of suitable remediation.
Procedure
The process to assess and manage the ground conditions Initial Assessment:
desk study
is as follows: walkover study
results.
Initial Assessment
NHBC requires all sites to be assessed by a desk study and Hazards known
or suspected?
a walkover survey. The results should be used to determine
No Yes
whether or not hazards are known or suspected. Basic Investigation Detailed Investigation
Basic Investigation
Required to support the results of the Initial Assessment where Further Assessment:
hazards are not suspected. geotechnical and
contamination risks
acceptable?
Detailed Investigation Yes No
Required where hazards are known or suspected. Further Investigation
required? Yes
Further Assessment No
Required after the Basic or Detailed Investigation has been
4.1
conducted, to confirm that all objectives have been met. Where Manage risks
the design
all necessary remediation has been carried out.
4.1
it is hot or has an odour.
Soils and rocks the basic ground type
evidence of peat, silt or other highly compressible material at or below the surface
cracking or stickiness of the surface which may indicate a shrinkable sub-soil
sudden changes in conditions, e.g. clay to chalk or soil to rock.
Surface water a high water table indicated, e.g. by waterlogged ground
and vegetation signs of flooding
reeds or water-loving plants
springs, ponds, wells, ditches or streams
the source of any discoloured water.
Vegetation vegetation which may indicate the nature of the soils
sparse dead or dying vegetation
type and condition of vegetation on land adjoining the site
species, height and condition of the trees
species, height, spread and condition of hedges and scrub on clay
evidence of former trees, hedges or scrub on clay.
Structural information damage to structures, e.g. cracking in buildings, on or around the site
other evidence of movement, e.g. tilting or distortion
any structures or services below ground.
Local information local knowledge of the site, e.g. mining, refuse tipping or flooding
local industrial history records indicating past and present uses of the site
place names and street names that may give clues to previous site usage,
e.g. Brickfield Cottage, Water Lane.
Basic Investigation (sites where hazards are not identified or suspected) 4.1.5 Also see: BS EN 1997-2
Where hazards are not suspected, a Basic Investigation of the site, including geotechnical and contamination
investigations, shall be carried out by a suitable person and recorded to the satisfaction of NHBC.
The Basic Investigation aims to provide assurance for all sites, regardless of how free of hazards they may appear, and forms the
minimum requirement for a site investigation.
The number and depth of trial pits should be located so they are representative of the site and will depend upon the:
proposed development
inconsistency of the soil and geology across the site.
nature of the site
Trial pits should be located outside the proposed foundation area, and generally be a minimum of 3m deep. The distance from
the edge of the foundation should not be less than the depth of the trial pit. Where trial pits do not provide sufficient information,
boreholes will be necessary.
Basic geotechnical and contamination investigations should be conducted and include:
physical tests, such as plasticity index tests, to support the
a basic contamination investigation based on sampling and
results of the Initial Assessment testing of soil taken from trial pits during the
4.1
geotechnical investigation.
During the excavation of the trial pits, the use of sight and smell may help to identify certain contaminants.
If the Basic Investigation reveals the presence of geotechnical and/or contamination hazards, or has not addressed all of the original
objectives, or where there is any doubt about the condition of the ground, further Detailed Investigation should be conducted.
The problems and liabilities which have to be managed in order to develop the site should be clearly communicated in the Detailed
Investigation report.
Further investigation should be conducted if the Detailed Investigation has not satisfactorily addressed all of the original objectives.
4.1
factors associated with the site and surrounding area
local and statutory requirements should be met to avoid
which could restrict the design precautions or remediation abortive works
techniques should be identified time constraints may influence the choice of solution, but do
not alter the requirement for effective remediation.
Design precautions
Solutions for dealing with geotechnical hazards include:
specialist foundations such as rafts, piling and ground beams
ground improvement techniques such as vibro,
dynamic compaction and surcharging.
Remediation techniques
Solutions for dealing with contamination hazards include:
risk avoidance by changing the pathway or isolating the
process-based treatment to remove,modify, stabilise or
target, by adjusting the layout and/or by building protective destroy contaminants by physical, biological,
measures into the construction chemical or thermal means.
engineering-based treatments that remove or isolate
Note
Evidence may still be required by NHBC to substantiate that contamination and hazards are not present on the site.
Investigation technique
A site investigation normally comprises techniques which are classed as either indirect or direct.
Indirect investigations use geophysical techniques, including electromagnetic, resistivity, seismic, gravity and ground radar,
to interpret ground conditions. Conducted from the surface, they measure variations in properties of the ground, both horizontally
and vertically, to define subsurface conditions. Geophysical methods rely on contrasts in the physical properties, for example,
between sand and gravel and rockhead. Contrast may also be provided by faulting, underground cables and pipelines or by cavities.
Direct investigation techniques involve intrusive activities to enable the retrieval and examination of the ground using trial pits,
trenches, boreholes or probes.
Trial pits allow the detailed inspection, logging, sampling and in-situ testing of large volumes of natural soil or fill and the assessment
of ground water conditions. Trenches are extended trial pits, or linked trial pits, which are excavated where greater exposure of the
ground conditions is required. Trial pits and trenches should be positioned where they will not affect future foundations.
Boreholes are typically formed using the following techniques:
Light cable percussion drilling A shell and auger rig typically used in the UK to drill boreholes in soils and weak rocks.
Continuous flight auger Exploratory boreholes may be drilled in soils by mechanical continuous flight augers of
various sizes. Hollow stem methods are typically employed where sample retrieval is required.
Rotary drilling Either open-hole drilling or rotary coring, is used to investigate rock and sometimes stiff soils,
such as boulder clay.
Probing techniques Used to analyse the relative density of soils and for environmental sampling and monitoring
(such as chemical and physical testing of gases, liquids and solids).
Sampling
The number and type of samples taken should be:
appropriate for the results of the desk study, the walkover
taken, stored and transported so that they avoid
survey and the site investigation cross-contamination.
appropriate for the range of ground materials encountered
4.1
Testing
Testing may be undertaken in-situ, or in a laboratory.
A wide variety of in-situ tests can be used to support the results of direct testing. These range from basic tests undertaken by
geologists or engineers using simple hand-held devices or portable test kits to methods that require specialist personnel
and equipment.
Testing laboratories should participate in quality assurance programmes and be accredited for relevant tests by bodies such as
UKAS and MCERTS. Physical tests on soil and rock materials are carried out to provide the following information on ground:
strength
settlement
relative density
consolidation characteristics
deformation
permeability.
Chemical tests on soils, rocks, ground water and gases can be carried out to provide an indication of potential contamination
on the site.
Report BR376 Radon: guidance on protective measures preparation and resistance to contaminants and moisture
for new dwellings in Scotland Report BR413
DEFRA and its predecessor departments
Radon: guidance on protective measures for new
CLAN 02/05 Soil guideline values and the determination of
dwellings in Northern Ireland land as contaminated land under Part 2A
BS 8485 Code of practice for the characterization and guidance and software Science Reports SR 1,2,3 and 7
remediation of ground gas in affected development
Guidance for the safe development of housing on land
4.2.1 Compliance 01
4.2.2 Provision of information 01
4.2.3 Building near trees 02
4.2.4 The effects of trees on shrinkable soils 03
4.2.5 Foundations in all soil types 06
4.2.6 Excavation of foundations 06
4.2.7 Foundations in shrinkable soils 06
4.2.8 Design and construction of
foundations in shrinkable soils 08
4.2.9 Foundation depths for specific conditions
in shrinkable soils 09
4.2.10 Heave precautions 10
4.2.11 New drainage 13
4.2.12 Foundation depth charts 13
4.2.13 Foundation depth tables 16
4.2.14 Example 22
4.2.15 Further information 24
Introduction
The combination of shrinkable soils and trees, hedgerows or shrubs represents a hazard to structures that requires
special consideration. Trees, hedgerows and shrubs take moisture from the ground and, in cohesive soils such as clay,
this can cause significant volume changes resulting in ground movement. This has the potential to affect foundations
and damage the supported structure. In order to minimise this risk, foundations should be designed to accommodate the
movement or be taken to a depth where the likelihood of damaging movement is low.
This chapter gives guidance for common foundation types to deal with the hazard and includes suitable foundation depths
which have been established from field data, research, NHBC data and practical experience. The depths are not those at
which root activity, desiccation and ground movement are non-existent, but they are intended to provide an acceptable
level of risk. However, if significant quantities of roots are unexpectedly encountered in the base of the trench,
the excavation may need to be deepened.
The interaction between trees, soil and buildings is dependent on many factors and is inherently complex. The relationship
becomes less predictable as factors combine to produce extreme conditions. These are signified by the need for deeper
foundations. Depths greater than 2.5m indicate that conditions exist where prescriptive guidance is less reliable.
The services of a specialist arboriculturalist may be helpful for the identification of the type and condition of trees that may
affect building work. This includes trees both on and adjacent to the site.
4.2
Consideration has been given to the potential effects of climate change in the guidance provided.
The following situations are beyond the scope of the guidance in this chapter and will require a site-specific assessment
by an engineer (see Technical Requirement R5):
Foundations deeper than 2.5m within the influence of trees.
Ground with a slope of greater than 1 in 7 (approximately 8) and man-made slopes such as embankments and cuttings.
Underpinning.
Building near trees 4.2.3 Also see: Technical Requirements R5 and BS 5837
When building near trees, hedgerows or shrubs, the designs shall take account of:
a) physical growth of young trees
b) protection of remaining trees and hedgerows
c) removal of existing trees and hedgerows.
Before the site is cleared, a survey is required to record the location, heights and species of trees, hedgerows and shrubs on and
adjacent to the site, which may affect the proposed development.
If the location of previously removed vegetation is not known, local enquiries and reference to aerial photographs should be
carried out. Alternatively, the design should assume the worst conditions, or an engineer consulted to undertake a site-specific
design based on all relevant information and in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
Where root growth is noted within shrinkable soil and where records are not available, an engineer should be consulted to assess
whether volume change is likely.
4.2
safe distance. Where this cannot be achieved, precautions which allow for future growth should be taken which include:
reinforcing foundations to resist lateral forces
laying paving and other surfaces on a flexible base to allow
bridging walls or structural slabs over the roots, allowing
for some movement.
sufficient clearance or reinforcing to avoid cracking
out on the fine particles and any medium and fine sand particles. Soil particles with a nominal diameter
greater than 425m are removed by sieving beforehand and the smaller particles analysed. This is a
requirement of BS 1377 which specifies the test procedure.
Modified Plasticity Defined as the Ip of the soil multiplied by the percentage of particles less than 425m.
Index (Ip) Ip = Ip x % less than 425m
100%
Alternatively, the Plasticity Index may be used without modification. For pure clays and other soils with 100% of particles less than
425m, the result will be the same. However, for mixed soils such as glacial tills, use of the Modified Plasticity Index may result in a
more economic design.
The volume change potential should be established from site investigation and reliable local knowledge of the geology.
Sufficient samples should be taken to provide confidence that the results are representative. High volume change potential
should be assumed if the volume change potential is unknown.
Table 3 shows the water demand categories and the average mature heights to which healthytrees of the species may be expected
to grow in favourable ground and environmental conditions. This information:
should be used for trees that are to remain or are scheduled
may be used even when actual heights are greater.
to be planted
4.2
White poplar 15 Horse chestnut 20
Crack willow 24 Sweet chestnut 24
Weeping willow 16 Lime 22
White willow 24 Japanese maple 8
Norway maple 18
Mountain ash 11
Pear 12
Plane 26
Plum 10
Sycamore 22
Tree of heaven 20
Walnut 18
Whitebeam 12
Coniferous trees:
Lawsons cypress 18 Cedar 20
Leyland cypress 20 Douglas fir 20
Monterey cypress 20 Larch 20
Monkey puzzle 18
Pine 20
Spruce 18
Wellingtonia 30
Yew 12
Tree identification can be assisted by reference to a tree recognition book. Information may be obtained from suitable alternative
authoritative sources for trees not listed in this chapter.
When the species is known but the subspecies is not, the greatest height listed for the species should be assumed.
Where hedgerows contain trees, their effect should be assessed separately and the height of the species likely to have the greatest
effect should be used.
Table 3a: Guidance for factors affecting the mature height and water demand of trees
Influencing factor Guidance
Heavy crown reduction The mature height should be used, or a registered arboricuturalist should be consulted to undertake
or pollarding (previously a site-specific assessment.
or planned)
Removal of trees The water demand of a semi-mature tree may be equal to that of a mature tree, though for a sapling
(previously or planned) or young tree will be significantly less.
mature height Height H should be determined in accordance
with this diagram when:
in this range use deriving foundation depths when trees have
H = mature height been removed, based on tree height at the
as listed in Table 3
time of removal
50%
checking the appropriate level from which
depths should be measured when trees
remain and the ground level is increased,
in this range use
H = actual height based on tree height at time of construction
relative to original ground level, or
determining if heave precautions are to
4.2
Climate
High rainfall reduces moisture deficits caused by trees
and hedgerows, while cool, damp weather reduces the
rate of water loss from trees thus reducing the risk of Thurso 0.50m (500mm)
soil movement.
Wick
The driest and hottest areas in the UK generally exist in 0.45m (450mm)
southeast England; therefore, the greatest risk occurs in that Dingwall
area and diminishes with distance north and west. A 50mm Inverness Peterhead
Aberdeen 0.40m (400mm)
decrease can be made to the foundation depth Fort William
determined in accordance with this chapter for every Pitlochry
Montrose
50 miles distance north and west of London. Where it Oban Perth 0.35m (350mm)
Ayr
Excavation of foundations 4.2.6 Also see: Chapter 4.1, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5 and Technical Requirement R5
Excavation of foundations shall take account of the design and be suitable to receive concrete.
Where trench bottoms become excessively dried or softened due to rain or ground water, the excavation should be re-bottomed
prior to concreting.
Foundation depths should be measured on the centre line of the excavation and from ground level determined from Clause 4.2.9.
4.2
Some root activity may be expected below the depths determined in accordance with this guidance. However, if significant quantities
of roots are unexpectedly encountered in the base of the trench, an engineer should be consulted to determine if the excavation
should be deepened.
4.2.7
Foundations in shrinkable soils Also see: NHBC Foundation Depth Calculator App. www.nhbc.co.uk/apps
Foundations shall be capable of accommodating the effects of trees, shrubs and hedgerows on shrinkable
soils without excessive movement. Items to be taken into account include:
a) foundation type
b) distance between tree and foundation
c) method of assessment of foundation depths
d) foundation depths related to the zone of influence of new tree planting
e) foundation depths related to new shrub planting.
Landscape and foundation designs should be compatible, and planting schedules produced by a qualified landscape architect or
other suitably qualified person and agreed with the local planning authority before work commences on site.
Foundation type
Foundations to all permanent structures, including garages, porches and conservatories, should take account of the effects of
soil desiccation. Foundation types that are acceptable in shrinkable soils include strip, trench fill, pier and beam, pile and beam,
and raft, providing they:
are capable of supporting the applied loads without
include suitable heave precautions.
undue settlement
Variations to the foundation depths derived from this chapter may be permitted where:
it is necessary to take account of local ground conditions
designed in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
other foundation depths are traditionally acceptable
Table 5: Where foundation depths are in accordance with column A or column B in Table 4, tree planting should be restricted to:
Water demand No tree planting zone for column A in Table 4 No tree planting zone / zone of influence for
column B in Table 4
High 1.0 x mature height 1.25 x mature height
Moderate 0.5 x mature height 0.75 x mature height
Low 0.2 x mature height 0.50 x mature height
4.2
from foundation.
Raft foundations
Raft foundations in shrinkable soils will only be acceptable where all of the following apply:
design is by an engineer in accordance with
the raft is generally rectangular in plan with a side ratio of not
Technical Requirement R5 more than 2:1
NHBC is satisfied that the raft is sufficiently stiff to resist
foundation depth is derived in accordance with Clause 4.2.7,
differential movements and is less than 2.5m.
NHBC is satisfied that the raft is founded on granular infill
placed and fully compacted in layers and in accordance with
the engineers specification. Where required by NHBC, site
inspections are to be undertaken by the engineer to verify
suitable compaction of the fill
a) strip and trench fill foundations in non-shrinkable soils overlying shrinkable soil
b) measurement of foundation depths
c) granular infill beneath raft foundations in shrinkable soils
d) steps in foundations.
Strip and trench fill foundations in non-shrinkable soils overlying shrinkable soil
Non shrinkable soils such as sands and gravels may overlie shrinkable soil. Foundations may be constructed on overlying
non-shrinkable soil if all the following are satisfied:
Conditions of Chapter 4.3 Strip and trench fill foundations
are met.
acceptable
Consistent soil conditions exist across each plot and this is
foundation
depth depth X
confirmed by the site investigation. depth
determined
greater
assuming
Depth of the non-shrinkable soil is greater than foundation
B
than
X shrinkable
soil
depth X, where X is the foundation depth determined using T equal to or greater than B
charts in Clause 4.2.12, tables in Clause 4.2.13 or the non-shrinkable soil
Foundation Depth Calculator App, assuming all the soil is shrinkable soil
shrinkable.
The thickness T of non-shrinkable soil below the foundation is
equal to, or more than, the width of the foundation B.
Proposals are submitted to, and approved by, NHBC prior to
work commencing on site.
Where any of the above are not met foundation depths should be determined as for shrinkable soil.
tree to remain
vel
nd le
al grou
origin
b
b
a
Figure 2: Levels from which foundation depths are measured Figure 3: Levels from which foundation depths are measured
where trees or hedgerows are removed where trees or hedgerows are proposed
tree to be removed proposed tree
proposed tree
tree to be removed l
d leve
l groun
ve l origina
nd le
grou
inal a b b
orig a
b
a Use the lower of:
a) minimum foundation depth (see Table 4 column B)
b) foundation depth based on mature height of tree.
Use the lower of:
a) foundation depth based on appropriate tree height (see Table 3a)
b) minimum foundation depth (see Table 4 column B).
4.2
ground level
shrinkable soils as shown below.
Infill should: 1.25m max. depth
Steps in foundations
On sloping ground, foundation trenches can be gradually stepped so that the required foundation depth is reasonably uniform below
ground level.
Where foundations are to be stepped to take account of the influence of trees, hedgerows and shrubs, they should be
stepped gradually, with no step exceeding 0.5m.
Where foundations and substructure may be subject to heave, they should be protected by voids, void formers or
compressible materials.
Where proprietary materials are used, the design of foundations and substructure should take into account the upward force
transmitted through the compressible material or void former prior to collapse (refer to manufacturers data).
This section provides guidance on heave precautions for common building elements when located within the influence of trees which
are to remain or be removed, including:
trench fill foundations
other foundation types
pier and beam foundations
paths and driveways
pile and beam foundations
new drainage.
Void formers consist of materials that collapse to form a void into which the clay can swell. The void dimension is the remaining void
after collapse. The thickness of the void former should be in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
Figure 4: Heave precautions for trench fill foundations up to Figure 5: Heave precautions for pier and beam foundations
2.5m deep
3D 3D
500mm 500mm
4.2
Where the excavation is battered or if there is overbreak or
concrete overspill, it may be necessary to consult an engineer.
Figure 6: Heave precautions for pile and beam foundations Raft foundations constructed in accordance with
Clause 4.2.8 and Clause 4.2.9 should provide adequate
3D protection from heave.
compressible material
or void former to
inside face of external embedment of
ground beams pile tension
reinforcement
to be 40 bar
diameters or
designed by
an engineer
(see Technical
Requirement R5)
compressible material optional rigid
or void former beneath slip liner
ground beams
pile length to
engineer's design
Note
Existing land drains should be maintained or diverted.
Where no value is given in the table, minimum foundation depths apply (i.e.1.0m, 0.9m and 0.75 m for high, medium and low volume
change potential soils respectively).
Chart 1: Soils with HIGH volume change potential Modified Plasticity Index 40% or greater
D/H
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2
0 TREE WATER DEMANDS
Broad-leafed trees
High
Moderate
Low
0.5
Coniferous trees
High
1.0
4.2
1.5
w
Lo
ate
e
at
er
der
od
Mo
M h
ig
h
Hig
H
2.0
2.5
Chart 2: Soils with MEDIUM volume change potential Modified Plasticity Index between 20% and less than 40%
D/H
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2
0 TREE WATER DEMANDS
Broad-leafed trees
High
Moderate
Low
0.5
Coniferous trees
Moderate
Foundation depths (m)
1.0
w
Lo
1.5
e
ate
rat
er
de
d
Mo
Mo
gh
h
Hi
Hig
2.0
2.5
Chart 3: Soils with LOW volume change potential Modified Plasticity Index 10 to less than 20%
D/H
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2
0 TREE WATER DEMANDS
Broad-leafed trees
High
Moderate
Low
0.5
Coniferous trees
Minimum depth 0.75m
High
Moderate
Foundation depths (m)
1.0
Low
4.2
e
at
e
rat
er
de
od
Mo
M
1.5
gh
gh
Hi
Hi
2.0
2.5
4.2
12 1.00 1.10 1.50 1.80 2.00 2.20 2.30 2.45 2.50 12 1.00 1.25 1.45 1.60 1.75 1.85
13 1.00 1.35 1.65 1.90 2.10 2.20 2.35 2.45 2.50 13 1.00 1.05 1.25 1.45 1.60 1.70
14 1.00 1.20 1.50 1.75 1.95 2.10 2.25 2.35 2.45 2.50 14 1.00 1.10 1.30 1.45 1.60
15 1.00 1.40 1.65 1.85 2.00 2.15 2.25 2.35 2.45 2.50 15 1.00 1.10 1.30 1.45
16 1.00 1.25 1.50 1.75 1.90 2.05 2.20 2.30 2.40 2.45 16 1.00 1.15 1.30
17 1.00 1.10 1.40 1.65 1.80 1.95 2.10 2.20 2.30 2.40 17 1.00 1.15
18 1.00 1.25 1.50 1.70 1.90 2.00 2.15 2.25 2.30 18 1.00
19 1.00 1.15 1.40 1.60 1.80 1.95 2.05 2.15 2.25 19 1.0m minimum foundation depth
20 1.00 1.30 1.50 1.70 1.85 2.00 2.10 2.20 20
21 1.00 1.20 1.40 1.60 1.75 1.90 2.00 2.10 21
22 1.00 1.10 1.30 1.50 1.70 1.85 1.95 2.05 22
23 1.00 1.20 1.45 1.60 1.75 1.90 2.00 23
24 1.00 1.10 1.35 1.50 1.65 1.80 1.90 24
25 1.00 1.25 1.45 1.60 1.75 1.85 25
26 1.00 1.15 1.35 1.50 1.65 1.80 26
27 1.00 1.05 1.25 1.45 1.60 1.70 27
28 1.00 1.20 1.35 1.50 1.65 28
29 1.00 1.10 1.30 1.45 1.60 29
30 1.00 1.20 1.40 1.50 30
31 1.00 1.15 1.30 1.45 31
32 1.00 1.05 1.25 1.40 32
33 1.00 1.15 1.30 33
34 1.00 1.10 1.25 34
35 1.00 1.20 35
36 1.00 1.10 36
37 1.0m minimum foundation depth 1.00 1.05 37
38 1.00 38
Table 12: HIGH Shrinkage soil and MODERATE water demand tree
Broad-leafed trees Coniferous trees
Foundation depth (m) Foundation depth (m)
Distance Tree height H (m) Distance Tree height H (m)
D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30
1 2.20 2.25 2.25 2.30 2.30 2.30 2.35 2.35 2.35 2.35 2.35 2.35 1 1.90 2.00 2.10 2.15 2.15 2.20 2.20 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.30 2.30
2 1.95 2.05 2.10 2.15 2.20 2.20 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.30 2.30 2.30 2 1.40 1.60 1.75 1.85 1.90 2.00 2.00 2.05 2.10 2.10 2.15 2.15
3 1.70 1.85 1.95 2.00 2.05 2.10 2.15 2.15 2.20 2.20 2.20 2.25 3 1.00 1.20 1.40 1.55 1.65 1.75 1.80 1.85 1.90 1.95 2.00 2.00
4 1.50 1.65 1.80 1.90 1.95 2.00 2.05 2.10 2.10 2.15 2.15 2.15 4 1.00 1.10 1.30 1.40 1.55 1.60 1.70 1.75 1.80 1.85 1.90
5 1.25 1.50 1.65 1.75 1.85 1.90 1.95 2.00 2.05 2.05 2.10 2.10 5 1.00 1.00 1.15 1.30 1.40 1.50 1.60 1.65 1.70 1.75
6 1.00 1.30 1.50 1.60 1.70 1.80 1.85 1.90 1.95 2.00 2.00 2.05 6 1.00 1.10 1.20 1.35 1.40 1.50 1.55 1.60
7 1.00 1.10 1.35 1.50 1.60 1.70 1.75 1.85 1.90 1.90 1.95 2.00 7 1.00 1.00 1.15 1.25 1.35 1.40 1.50
8 1.00 1.20 1.35 1.50 1.60 1.65 1.75 1.80 1.85 1.90 1.90 8 1.00 1.10 1.20 1.30 1.35
9 1.00 1.20 1.35 1.50 1.60 1.65 1.70 1.75 1.80 1.85 9 1.00 1.05 1.15 1.20
10 1.00 1.10 1.25 1.40 1.50 1.55 1.65 1.70 1.75 1.80 10 1.00 1.00 1.10
11 1.00 1.15 1.30 1.40 1.50 1.55 1.65 1.70 1.75 11 1.00
12 1.00 1.20 1.30 1.40 1.50 1.55 1.60 1.65 12
13 1.00 1.05 1.20 1.30 1.40 1.50 1.55 1.60 13
4.2
Table 13: HIGH shrinkage soil and LOW water demand tree
Broad-leafed trees
Foundation depth (m)
Distance Tree height H (m)
D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30
1 1.60 1.65 1.70 1.70 1.70 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.75
2 1.40 1.50 1.55 1.60 1.60 1.65 1.65 1.65 1.65 1.70 1.70 1.70
3 1.20 1.35 1.40 1.50 1.50 1.55 1.60 1.60 1.60 1.65 1.65 1.65
4 1.00 1.20 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.45 1.50 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.60 1.60
5 1.00 1.15 1.25 1.30 1.40 1.40 1.45 1.50 1.50 1.55 1.55
6 1.00 1.15 1.20 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.40 1.45 1.50 1.50
7 1.00 1.10 1.20 1.25 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.40 1.45
8 1.00 1.10 1.20 1.25 1.30 1.35 1.35 1.40
9 1.00 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.25 1.30 1.35
10 1.00 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.25 1.30
11 1.00 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.25
12 1.00 1.10 1.15 1.20
13 1.0m minimum foundation depth 1.00 1.10 1.15
14 1.00 1.05
15 1.00
Table 14: MEDIUM shrinkage soil and HIGH water demand tree
Broad-leafed trees Coniferous trees
Foundation depth (m) Foundation depth (m)
Distance Tree height H (m) Distance Tree height H (m)
D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30
1 1 Foundations greater than 2.5m
2 Foundations greater than 2.5m 2 2.15 2.30 2.45 2.50 deep to be engineer designed
3 2.40 2.50 deep to be engineer designed 3 1.70 1.95 2.15 2.25 2.35 2.45 2.50
4 2.20 2.35 2.45 4 1.25 1.60 1.85 2.00 2.15 2.25 2.30 2.40 2.45 2.50 2.50
5 1.95 2.20 2.30 2.40 2.50 5 0.90 1.25 1.55 1.75 1.95 2.05 2.15 2.20 2.30 2.35 2.40 2.45
6 1.75 2.00 2.20 2.30 2.40 2.45 2.50 6 0.90 1.25 1.50 1.70 1.85 1.95 2.05 2.15 2.20 2.25 2.30
7 1.55 1.85 2.05 2.20 2.30 2.35 2.45 2.50 7 1.00 1.25 1.50 1.65 1.80 1.90 2.00 2.10 2.15 2.20
8 1.35 1.70 1.90 2.05 2.20 2.25 2.35 2.40 2.45 2.50 8 0.90 1.00 1.25 1.45 1.60 1.75 1.85 1.95 2.00 2.10
9 1.15 1.50 1.75 1.95 2.10 2.20 2.25 2.35 2.40 2.45 2.50 2.50 9 0.90 1.05 1.25 1.45 1.60 1.70 1.80 1.90 1.95
10 0.90 1.35 1.60 1.80 1.95 2.10 2.20 2.25 2.30 2.35 2.40 2.45 10 0.90 1.10 1.25 1.45 1.55 1.65 1.75 1.85
11 0.90 1.15 1.50 1.70 1.85 2.00 2.10 2.20 2.25 2.30 2.35 2.40 11 0.90 1.10 1.25 1.40 1.55 1.65 1.75
12 0.90 1.00 1.35 1.60 1.75 1.90 2.00 2.10 2.20 2.25 2.30 2.35 12 0.90 1.10 1.25 1.40 1.50 1.60
13 0.90 1.20 1.45 1.65 1.80 1.95 2.05 2.10 2.20 2.25 2.30 13 0.90 0.95 1.10 1.25 1.40 1.50
4.2
14 0.90 1.05 1.35 1.55 1.70 1.85 1.95 2.05 2.10 2.20 2.25 14 0.90 1.00 1.15 1.25 1.40
15 0.90 1.20 1.45 1.60 1.75 1.85 1.95 2.05 2.10 2.20 15 0.90 1.00 1.15 1.25
16 0.90 1.10 1.35 1.55 1.70 1.80 1.90 2.00 2.05 2.10 16 0.90 1.00 1.15
17 0.90 1.00 1.25 1.45 1.60 1.70 1.85 1.90 2.00 2.05 17 0.90 1.05
18 0.90 1.15 1.35 1.50 1.65 1.75 1.85 1.95 2.00 18 0.90
19 0.90 1.05 1.25 1.40 1.55 1.70 1.80 1.90 1.95 19
20 0.90 1.15 1.35 1.50 1.60 1.75 1.80 1.90 20
21 0.90 1.05 1.25 1.40 1.55 1.65 1.75 1.85 21
22 0.90 0.95 1.15 1.35 1.50 1.60 1.70 1.80 22
23 0.90 1.10 1.25 1.40 1.55 1.65 1.75 23
24 0.90 1.00 1.20 1.35 1.45 1.60 1.70 24
25 0.90 1.10 1.25 1.40 1.50 1.60 25
26 0.90 1.05 1.20 1.35 1.45 1.55 26
27 0.90 0.95 1.15 1.30 1.40 1.50 27
28 0.90 1.05 1.20 1.35 1.45 28
29 0.90 1.00 1.15 1.30 1.40 29
30 0.90 1.10 1.20 1.35 30
31 0.90 1.00 1.15 1.30 31
32 0.90 0.95 1.10 1.25 32
33 0.90 1.05 1.15 33
34 0.90 1.00 1.10 34
35 0.90 1.05 35
36 0.9m minimum foundation depth 0.90 1.00 36 0.9m minimum foundation depth
37 0.90 0.95 37
38 0.90 38
Table 15: MEDIUM shrinkage soil and MODERATE water demand tree
Broad-leafed trees Coniferous
Foundation depth (m) Foundation depth (m)
Distance Tree height H (m) Distance Tree height H (m)
D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30
1 1.85 1.85 1.90 1.90 1.95 1.95 1.95 1.95 1.95 1.95 1.95 1.95 1 1.65 1.70 1.75 1.80 1.80 1.85 1.85 1.90 1.90 1.90 1.90 1.90
2 1.65 1.75 1.80 1.80 1.85 1.85 1.85 1.90 1.90 1.90 1.90 1.90 2 1.25 1.40 1.50 1.55 1.65 1.65 1.70 1.75 1.75 1.80 1.80 1.80
3 1.45 1.60 1.65 1.70 1.75 1.80 1.80 1.80 1.85 1.85 1.85 1.85 3 0.90 1.10 1.25 1.35 1.45 1.50 1.55 1.60 1.65 1.65 1.70 1.70
4 1.30 1.45 1.55 1.60 1.65 1.70 1.75 1.75 1.80 1.80 1.80 1.80 4 0.90 0.95 1.10 1.25 1.30 1.40 1.45 1.50 1.55 1.55 1.60
5 1.10 1.30 1.40 1.50 1.55 1.60 1.65 1.70 1.70 1.75 1.75 1.80 5 0.90 0.90 1.05 1.15 1.25 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.45 1.50
6 0.90 1.15 1.30 1.40 1.45 1.55 1.60 1.60 1.65 1.70 1.70 1.75 6 0.90 0.95 1.10 1.15 1.25 1.30 1.35 1.40
7 0.90 1.00 1.15 1.30 1.40 1.45 1.50 1.55 1.60 1.65 1.65 1.70 7 0.90 0.90 1.00 1.10 1.15 1.25 1.30
8 0.90 0.05 1.20 1.30 1.35 1.45 1.50 1.55 1.55 1.60 1.65 8 0.90 0.95 1.05 1.10 1.20
9 0.90 1.10 1.20 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.45 1.50 1.55 1.60 9 0.90 0.95 1.00 1.10
10 0.90 0.95 1.10 1.20 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.45 1.50 1.55 10 0.90 0.90 0.95
11 0.90 1.00 1.10 1.20 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.45 1.50 11 0.90
12 0.90 1.05 1.15 1.20 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.45 12
13 0.90 0.95 1.05 1.15 1.25 1.30 1.35 1.40 13
4.2
Table 16: MEDIUM shrinkage soil and LOW water demand tree
Broad-leafed trees
Foundation depth (m)
Distance Tree height H (m)
D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30
1 1.35 1.40 1.40 1.45 1.45 1.45 1.45 1.45 1.45 1.45 1.50 1.50
2 1.20 1.30 1.30 1.35 1.35 1.40 1.40 1.40 1.40 1.45 1.45 1.45
3 1.05 1.15 1.20 1.25 1.30 1.30 1.35 1.35 1.35 1.40 1.40 1.40
4 0.90 1.05 1.10 1.20 1.20 1.25 1.30 1.30 1.30 1.35 1.35 1.35
5 0.90 1.00 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.20 1.25 1.25 1.30 1.30 1.30
6 0.90 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.20 1.25 1.25 1.30
7 0.90 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.15 1.15 1.20 1.20 1.25
8 0.90 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.20
9 0.90 1.00 1.05 1.05 1.10 1.15 1.15
10 0.90 0.95 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.10
11 0.90 0.95 1.00 1.05 1.10
12 0.90 0.95 1.00 1.05
13 0.9m minimum foundation depth 0.90 0.95 1.00
14 0.90 0.95
15 0.90
Table 17: LOW shrinkage soil and HIGH water demand tree
Broad-leafed trees Coniferous
Foundation depth (m) Foundation depth (m)
Distance Tree height H (m) Distance Tree height H (m)
D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30
1 2.35 2.40 2.40 2.40 2.45 2.45 2.45 2.45 2.45 2.45 2.45 2.45 1 2.15 2.25 2.30 2.30 2.35 2.35 2.35 2.40 2.40 2.40 2.40 2.40
2 2.15 2.25 2.30 2.30 2.35 2.35 2.40 2.40 2.40 2.40 2.40 2.45 2 1.80 1.95 2.05 2.10 2.15 2.20 2.25 2.25 2.30 2.30 2.30 2.35
3 2.00 2.10 2.15 2.20 2.25 2.30 2.30 2.35 2.35 2.35 2.35 2.40 3 1.45 1.65 1.80 1.90 1.95 2.05 2.10 2.10 2.15 2.20 2.20 2.25
4 1.80 1.95 2.05 2.10 2.15 2.20 2.25 2.25 2.30 2.30 2.30 2.35 4 1.05 1.35 1.55 1.70 1.80 1.85 1.95 2.00 2.05 2.05 2.10 2.15
5 1.65 1.80 1.95 2.00 2.10 2.15 2.15 2.20 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.30 5 0.75 1.05 1.30 1.50 1.60 1.70 1.80 1.85 1.90 1.95 2.00 2.05
6 1.45 1.70 1.80 1.90 2.00 2.05 2.10 2.15 2.15 2.20 2.20 2.25 6 0.75 1.05 1.25 1.45 1.55 1.65 1.70 1.80 1.85 1.90 1.95
7 1.30 1.55 1.70 1.80 1.90 2.00 2.05 2.05 2.10 2.15 2.15 2.20 7 0.75 0.80 1.05 1.25 1.40 1.50 1.60 1.65 1.75 1.80 1.85
8 1.10 1.40 1.60 1.70 1.80 1.90 1.95 2.00 2.05 2.10 2.10 2.15 8 0.75 0.85 1.05 1.20 1.35 1.45 1.55 1.60 1.70 1.75
9 0.95 1.25 1.45 1.60 1.75 1.80 1.90 1.95 2.00 2.05 2.05 2.10 9 0.75 0.90 1.05 1.20 1.35 1.45 1.50 1.60 1.65
10 0.75 1.10 1.35 1.50 1.65 1.75 1.80 1.90 1.95 2.00 2.00 2.05 10 0.75 0.90 1.05 1.20 1.30 1.40 1.50 1.55
11 0.75 1.00 1.20 1.40 1.55 1.65 1.75 1.80 1.90 1.95 1.95 2.00 11 0.75 0.90 1.05 1.20 1.30 1.35 1.45
12 0.75 0.85 1.10 1.30 1.45 1.60 1.70 1.75 1.80 1.85 1.90 1.95 12 0.75 0.95 1.05 1.15 1.25 1.35
13 0.75 1.00 1.20 1.40 1.50 1.60 1.70 1.75 1.80 1.85 1.90 13 0.75 0.80 0.95 1.05 1.15 1.25
4.2
14 0.75 0.90 1.10 1.30 1.45 1.55 1.65 1.70 1.75 1.80 1.85 14 0.75 0.80 0.95 1.05 1.15
15 0.75 1.00 1.20 1.35 1.45 1.55 1.65 1.70 1.75 1.80 15 0.75 0.85 0.95 1.05
16 0.75 0.90 1.10 1.30 1.40 1.50 1.60 1.65 1.70 1.75 16 0.75 0.85 0.95
17 0.75 0.80 1.05 1.20 1.35 1.45 1.55 1.60 1.65 1.75 17 0.75 0.85
18 0.75 0.95 1.10 1.25 1.35 1.45 1.55 1.60 1.70 18 0.75
19 0.75 0.85 1.05 1.20 1.30 1.40 1.50 1.55 1.65 19
20 0.75 0.95 1.10 1.25 1.35 1.45 1.50 1.60 20
21 0.75 0.90 1.05 1.20 1.30 1.40 1.45 1.55 21
22 0.75 0.80 1.00 1.10 1.25 1.35 1.40 1.50 22
23 0.75 0.90 1.05 1.20 1.30 1.35 1.45 23
24 0.75 0.85 1.00 1.10 1.25 1.30 1.40 24
25 0.75 0.95 1.05 1.15 1.25 1.35 25
26 0.75 0.85 1.00 1.10 1.20 1.30 26
27 0.75 0.80 0.95 1.05 1.15 1.25 27
28 0.75 0.90 1.00 1.10 1.20 28
29 0.75 0.85 0.95 1.05 1.15 29
30 0.75 0.90 1.00 1.10 30
31 0.75 0.85 0.95 1.05 31
32 0.75 0.80 0.90 1.05 32
33 0.75 0.85 1.00 33
34 0.75 0.80 0.95 34
35 0.75 0.90 35
36 0.75 0.85 36
37 0.75m minimum foundation depth 0.75 0.80 37 0.75m minimum foundation depth
38 0.75 38
Table 18: LOW shrinkage soil and MODERATE water demand tree
Broad-leafed trees Coniferous
Foundation depth (m) Foundation depth (m)
Distance Tree height H (m) Distance Tree height H (m)
D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30
1 1.50 1.50 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.60 1.60 1.60 1 1.30 1.40 1.40 1.45 1.45 1.50 1.50 1.50 1.50 1.55 1.55 1.55
2 1.35 1.40 1.45 1.45 1.50 1.50 1.50 1.50 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 2 1.00 1.15 1.20 1.25 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.40 1.40 1.45 1.45 1.45
3 1.20 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.40 1.45 1.45 1.45 1.50 1.50 1.50 1.50 3 0.75 0.90 1.00 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.25 1.30 1.30 1.35 1.35 1.40
4 1.05 1.15 1.25 1.30 1.35 1.35 1.40 1.40 1.45 1.45 1.45 1.45 4 0.75 0.80 0.95 1.00 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.20 1.25 1.25 1.30
5 0.90 1.05 1.15 1.20 1.25 1.30 1.35 1.35 1.40 1.40 1.40 1.45 5 0.75 0.75 0.85 0.95 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.20
6 0.75 0.95 1.05 1.15 1.20 1.25 1.30 1.30 1.35 1.35 1.40 1.40 6 0.75 0.80 0.90 0.95 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.15
7 0.75 0.85 0.95 1.05 1.10 1.20 1.20 1.25 1.30 1.30 1.35 1.35 7 0.75 0.75 0.85 0.90 0.95 1.00 1.05
8 0.75 0.85 0.95 1.05 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.25 1.25 1.30 1.30 8 0.75 0.80 0.85 0.95 0.95
9 0.75 0.90 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.25 1.25 1.30 9 0.75 0.80 0.85 0.90
10 0.75 0.80 0.90 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.15 1.20 1.20 1.25 10 0.75 0.75 0.80
11 0.75 0.85 0.95 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.15 1.15 1.20 11 0.75
12 0.75 0.85 0.95 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.15 1.15 12
13 0.75 0.80 0.90 0.95 1.00 1.05 1.10 1.15 13
4.2
Table 19: LOW shrinkage soil and LOW water demand tree
Broad-leafed trees
Foundation depth (m)
Distance Tree height H (m)
D (m) 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30
1 1.10 1.15 1.15 1.15 1.15 1.15 1.20 1.20 1.20 1.20 1.20 1.20
2 1.00 1.05 1.05 1.10 1.10 1.10 1.15 1.15 1.15 1.15 1.15 1.15
3 0.90 0.95 1.00 1.05 1.05 1.05 1.10 1.10 1.10 1.10 1.10 1.15
4 0.75 0.85 0.90 0.95 1.00 1.00 1.05 1.05 1.05 1.10 1.10 1.10
5 0.75 0.85 0.90 0.95 0.95 1.00 1.00 1.05 1.05 1.05 1.05
6 0.75 0.85 0.90 0.90 0.95 0.95 1.00 1.00 1.05 1.05
7 0.75 0.85 0.85 0.90 0.95 0.95 1.00 1.00 1.00
8 0.75 0.80 0.85 0.90 0.90 0.95 0.95 1.00
9 0.75 0.80 0.85 0.90 0.90 0.95 0.95
10 0.75 0.80 0.85 0.85 0.90 0.90
11 0.75 0.80 0.85 0.85 0.90
12 0.75 0.80 0.85 0.85
13 0.75m minimum foundation depth 0.75 0.80 0.85
14 0.75 0.80
15 0.75
Example 4.2.14
The following is an example of how to determine foundation depths using the information in this chapter.
The process may be repeated to allow the foundation to be stepped as its distance from the tree increases.
Step 1
Determine the volume change potential of the soil. Ensure the site investigation includes representative sampling and testing.
Site at Oxford, building near a Lombardy poplar (to be retained) and a sycamore (to be removed).
From laboratory tests:
Plasticity Index, Ip = 36%
Test results also report that 100% of particles are smaller than 425m.
Therefore:
Modified Plasticity Index, Ip = 36 x100 = 36%
100
4.2
Volume change potential = medium
(In the absence of tests, assume high volume change potential.)
This example is typical of Oxford clay. More than 35% of the particles are smaller than 60m and therefore the soil is shrinkable.
100% of the particles are smaller than 425m and therefore Ip is the same as the Ip.
A typical boulder clay also has more than 35% of particles smaller than 60m and is therefore also shrinkable. However, it may have
only 80% of its particles smaller than 425m, in which case, the Ip is 80% of the Ip.
A typical clayey sand may have less than 30% of its particles smaller than 60m, in which case, the soil would be non-shrinkable.
Step 2
Establish the species, mature height and water demand of all trees and hedgerows within the influencing radii.
Lombardy poplar Sycamore
Mature height = 25m Mature height = 22m
Water demand = high Water demand = moderate
Step 3
Plot the trees and hedgerows relative to the foundations and
draw their zones of influence to determine which trees will affect
zone of influence
the foundation design. Use a scaled plan. of Lombardy poplar
1.25 x 25 = 31.25m
Lombardy poplar
mature height 25m 10m
sycamore
mature 8m
height 22m
zone of influence
of sycamore
0.75 x 22 = 16.5m
Step 4
Establish the appropriate tree height H to use.
Always use the mature height for remaining and proposed trees and hedgerows. The appropriate height to use for removed trees
and hedgerows depends on the actual height when they are removed.
Lombardy poplar Sycamore
Tree to remain. Therefore: Tree to be removed
H = mature height Mature height = 22m
= 25m Actual height = 15m
Actual height greater than 50% mature height. Therefore:
H = mature height
= 22m
Step 5
Measure the distance D from the centre of the trees or hedgerows to the face of the foundation.
Lombardy poplar Sycamore
4.2
Step 6
Either:
use the NHBC Foundation Depth Calculator App, or
select step 6T if using tables in Clause 4.2.13.
select steps 6C (a) and (b) if using charts in Clause 4.2.12 to
derive depths, or
Step 6C (a)
Calculate D/H value
Distance D from face of foundation (step 5) divided by the appropriate tree height H (Step 4).
Alternatively D/H can be obtained from Clause 4.2.12.
Lombardy poplar Sycamore
D = 10 = D/H = 0.4 D = 8 = D/H = 0.36
H = 25 H = 22
Step 6C (b)
Determine foundation depth using the charts in Clause 4.2.12 as follows:
Volume change potential Chart number
High 1
Medium 2
Low 3
The Lombardy poplar is the tree requiring the greater depth (2.33m).
Step 6T
Determine foundation depth using the tables in 4.2.13 as follows:
Volume change potential Tree water demand Table number
High High 11
Moderate 12
Low 13
Medium High 14
Moderate 15
Low 16
Low High 17
Moderate 18
Low 19
Step 7
Adjust the depth according to the climatic zone.
4.2
A reduction may be made for distance north and west of London, but the final depth should not be less than the minimum given in
each chart and table.
Oxford is between 50 and 100 miles NW of London. From 4.2.5, a reduction of 0.05m is permitted.
Final foundation depth = 2.33 0.05 = 2.28m
BRE Digest 298 The influence of trees on house Nottingham NG12 5GG; Tel: 0115 936 3100
foundations in clay soils
Tree root damage to buildings Vol.1 Causes, Diagnosis
BRE Digest 412 Desiccation in clay soils and Remedy, Vol. 2 Patterns of Soil Drying in Proximity to
BS 1377 Methods of test for soils for civil Trees on Clay Soils by P G Biddle, Willowmead Publishing,
engineering purposes Wantage OX12 9JA
Tree Recognition A Pocket Manual by Ian Richardson and 1-7 Great George Street, London SW1P 3AA;
Rowena Gale, Richardsons Botanical Identifications, Tel: 020 7222 7722; www.ice.org.uk
49/51 Whiteknights Road, Reading, Berks RG6 7BB
Institution of Structural Engineers
Field Guide to the Trees of Britain and Northern Europe 11 Upper Belgrave Street, London SW1X 8BH;
by Alan Mitchell, Harper Collins Tel: 020 7235 4535
Acknowledgements: NHBC gratefully acknowledges the help given by authoritative organisations and individuals in the preparation
of this chapter, particularly: Building Research Establishment; Dr P G Biddle, arboricultural consultant.
4.3.1 Compliance 01
4.3.2 Provision of information 01
4.3.3 Ground conditions 01
4.3.4 Hazardous ground 02
4.3.5 Setting out 02
4.3.6 Services and drainage 03
4.3.7 Safe transmission of loads 03
4.3.8 Sloping groundand stepped foundations 05
4.3.9 Excavations 05
4.3.10 Reinforcement 06
4.3.11 Concrete 06
4.3.12 Movement joints 06
4.3.13 Construction joints 06
In England, Wales, Northern Ireland and the Isle of Man, sleeper walls should be provided with suitable foundations where the
oversite concrete is:
cast on shrinkable clay soils where heave could take place
less than 100mm thick.
cast on infill deeper than 600mm
Ground conditions 4.3.3 Also see: Chapters 3.2, 4.1, 4.2 and 5.2
Strip and trench fill foundations shall be adequate, of a suitable depth and taken to a suitable bearing stratum.
Issues to be taken into account include:
a) the home design and layout c) frost susceptible soils and cold weather construction
b) ground conditions d) shrinkable and volume change soils.
Ground conditions
All relevant information about the history of the site, plus the nature and load-bearing capacity of the ground, should be available
before the foundations are designed. Information may be available from:
NHBC
gas, water and electricity companies
local authorities
aerial photographs, Ordnance Survey maps and geological
maps and surveys.
Site assessment surveys may require supplementary investigations involving trial pits and boreholes.
4.3
Table 1: Minimum foundation depths in shrinkable soil
Modified Plasticity Index Volume change potential Minimum depth (m)
40% and greater High 1.0
20% to less than 40% Medium 0.9
10% to less than 20% Low 0.75
Shrinkable soils are classified as containing more than 35% fine particles (clay and silt) and have a Modified Plasticity Index of
10% or greater.
These minimum depths may only be used where any existing or proposed trees or shrubs are outside the zone of tree influence.
Heave is possible in shrinkable soil where trees have been, or are being, removed.
trench widths
diagonals
Services and drainage 4.3.6 Also see: Chapters 5.1 and 5.3
All strip and trench fill foundations shall be installed to:
a) adequately protect existing services and ground water drainage
b) make allowance for drainage and other services.
4.3
fill) Minimum width of strip foundation (mm)
Rock Not inferior to sandstone, Requires at least a pneumatic or other Equal to the width of the wall plus 50mm
limestone or firm chalk mechanically operated pick for excavation. each side.
Gravel Medium dense Requires pick for excavation. 250 300 400 500 600 650
Sand Wooden peg 50mm square in cross-section
is hard to drive beyond 150mm.
Clay Stiff Can be indented slightly by thumb. 250 300 400 500 600 650
Sandy clay
Clay Firm Thumb makes impression easily. 300 350 450 600 750 850
Sandy clay
Sand Loose Can be excavated with a spade. 400 600 Does not fall within the
Silty sand Wooden peg 50mm square in cross-section provisions of this guidance
Clayey sand can be easily driven. where the total load
exceeds 30 kN/linear m.
Silt Soft Finger can be pushed in up to 10mm. 450 650
Clay
Sandy clay
Clay or silt
Silt Very soft Finger can be easily pushed in Refer to specialist advice.
Clay up to 25mm.
Sandy clay
Clay or silt
P
The thickness (T) of the foundation should be:
equal to projection (P) or 150mm (whichever is greater)
overlap
T (maximum 500mm), or
One metre, whichever is largest.
300mm, whichever is largest.
Design dimensions
Inaccuracy may prevent walls and piers from being located centrally and therefore result in eccentric loading of foundations and
possible foundation failure.
Excess excavation should be avoided. Accurate trench digging is particularly important where the width of the foundation is only
slightly wider than the wall to be supported.
Acceptance from the foundation designer is required where the foundation design is modified.
Localised effects
At soft spots, excavations should be deepened to a sound bottom or the concrete should be reinforced. Hard spots should
be removed.
Where roots are visible at the bottom or sides of trenches, especially in clay soils, excavations may need to be taken deeper,
or special precautions determined by an engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
placed correctly
4.3
Concrete for foundations shall be:
a) of a mix which is suitable for the intended use
b) durable against chemical or frost action
c) correctly mixed, placed and cured.
Concreting should be carried out, as far as possible, in one
operation, taking account of weather conditions and available
daylight. Concrete should be placed as soon as possible after
the excavation has been checked.
For trench fill foundations, it is particularly important to check
that the finished level is correct and horizontal, as it is difficult
to adjust for discrepancies in the small number of brick courses
between the foundation and the DPC.
4.4.1 Compliance 01
4.4.2 Provision of information 01
4.4.3 Site conditions 01
4.4.4 Hazardous ground 02
4.4.5 Services and drainage 02
4.4.6 Safe transmission of loads 03
4.4.7 Construction 03
4.4.8 Engineer checks 05
4.4.9 Compressible materials 05
4.4.10 Reinforcement 05
4.4.11 Concrete 05
4.4.12 Movement joints 05
4.4.13 Resistance to moisture 06
chimney breasts
Differential settlement
Foundations should be designed to avoid any local stress points or any differential settlement.
Foundations for terraced homes, or those adjoining an existing building, may require special precautions to prevent damage
from differential settlement. Foundations for attached bays, porches, garages, conservatories and other structures should be a
continuation of those for the main home, unless the design indicates an alternative which takes account of differential movement.
Hazardous ground 4.4.4 Also see: Chapters 3.1, 4.1, 4.2 and BRE Special Digest 1
Raft, pile, pier and beam foundations shall take account of ground conditions and hazards. Where hazardous
ground has been identified, notice shall be given to NHBC before work commences.
Where there is hazardous ground, the design of foundations must be carried out by an engineer in accordance with
4.4
Technical Requirement R5.
Where hazardous ground has been identified, NHBC should be notified in writing at least eight weeks before work on site begins,
in accordance with NHBC Rules.
Where toxic materials, or those likely to present a health hazard are found, allavailable information should be supplied to NHBC,
together with proposals for remediation.
Sulfate and acids
Sulfates and other chemicals can cause expansion and disruption of concrete. High acidity, for example in peat, or permeable soil
with acidic ground water can cause damage to concrete. Where sulfates or high acidity in ground or ground water are present,
reference should be made to Chapter 3.1 Concrete and its reinforcement for guidance concerning acceptable concrete mixes.
Where concrete is at risk from chemical attack from the ground, or where the ground water is highly mobile, the level of sulfate and
other chemicals should be determined in terms of the ACEC class (aggressive chemical environment for concrete class),
in accordance with BRE Special Digest 1.
Services and drainage 4.4.5 Also see: Chapters 5.1, 5.3 and 8.1
Raft, pile, pier and beam foundations shall take account of new and existing services. Issues to be taken into
account include:
a) provision for new services
b) adequate protection of existing services and drainage.
Land drains should be diverted to a suitable outfall; other drains should be diverted or bridged.
Fill for raft foundations should be in accordance with Chapter 5.1 Substructure and ground-bearing floors.
Semi-raft foundations on made ground:
The following notes are to be used as a guide for engineers designing raft foundations, but are by no means exhaustive.
Special consideration will be required for certain sites.
Raft foundations are to be designed by a chartered civil or Beams are to use properly formed reinforcement in
structural engineer taking account of ground conditions and accordance with BS EN 1992-1-1.
the results of the site appraisal and ground assessment. Where mesh is used in beams, it should be delivered to the
Sufficient internal beams are to be provided to stiffen the site pre-bent.
slab adequately. All beams should be cast on a minimum of 50mm
The area between downstand beams should not be greater concrete blinding.
than 35m2. Minimum cover to reinforcement should be 40mm.
The ratio of adjacent sides on plan should not exceed 2:1. Floor slabs should be a minimum 150mm thick, with nominal
The minimum depth of perimeter and party wall beams is to top face reinforcement as a minimum and anti-crack
be 450mm. On larger homes, some internal beams should reinforcement in the bottom face, where appropriate.
be of the same depth as the perimeter beams. Stools or similar should be used to support floor slab mesh
Perimeter and internal beams should be sufficiently wide at during casting.
their base to carry their total loading at the allowable bearing Corners and junctions to beams should be adequately tied
pressure for the site. using similar reinforcement to the beams.
Beams are to be designed to span 3m simply supported and A minimum cavity drain of 225mm below the DPC is to
cantilever 1.5m. be maintained.
Piled foundations:
The design of all piled foundations should specify precautions for cohesive soils where volume changes can occur.
The bearing capacity and integrity of pilesshould be confirmed by testing, when required.
Walls should be located centrally on the foundation, unless specifically designed otherwise. Inaccuracy may prevent walls and piers
being located centrally, resulting in eccentric loading and possible foundation failure.
Discrepancies to the design of the foundations or variations in the ground conditions should be reported formally to the engineer.
Variations in design or ground conditions should be recorded and distributed to NHBC and others concerned with sitework.
Foundation excavations should:
be kept free from water
not be excessive.
boundary boundary
4.4
distance from distance from
boundary boundary
diagonals diagonals
trench alignment
length
trench
width alignment
Reinforcement 4.4.10
Reinforcement of raft, pile, pier and beam foundations shall be in accordance with the design, sufficient to
ensure the safe transfer of loads and be suitable for localised ground conditions.
4.4
Reinforcement may be necessary, for example at construction joints or over small localised soft spots or changes in bearing strata.
Concrete 4.4.11
Concrete for raft, pile, pier and beam foundations shall be:
a) of a suitable mix design to achieve the required strength and resistance to chemical and frost action
b) correctly mixed, placed and cured.
Mixing, placing, testing and curing of concrete should be carried out as indicated in Chapter 3.1 Concrete and its reinforcement
and when work is carried out in cold weather, Chapter 3.2 Cold weather working.
Suitable mix
Concrete should be of a mix which:
will achieve the required strength and not impair the
is sufficiently resistant tochemical and frost action.
performance of the foundation
Resistance to moisture 4.4.13 Also see: Chapters 5.1, 5.2 and 5.4
Raft, pile, pier and beam foundations shall prevent the passage of moisture to the inside of the home and,
where necessary, include a drained cavity and damp proof membranes.
Cavity walls should drain below the DPC and should:
prevent water crossing from the outside to the inside
have a minimum 225mm clear cavity below the DPC
prevent the flooding of cavities above the DPC
where strip, trenchfill or ground beams are used, or have a
drain below the DPC
minimum 150mm clear cavity below the DPC where other
types of foundations are used, provided that weep holes
and other necessary measures are taken to ensure that the
cavity can drain freely.
DPC cavity trays are not an acceptable waterproofing to the edges of specialised foundations, such as rafts and ground beams.
DPC
225mm
4.4
DPC
min. 150mm min.
weep hole
above
cavity tray
4.5.1 Compliance 01
4.5.2 Hazardous sites and ground hazards 01
4.5.3 Desk study and site investigation 01
4.5.4 Confirmation of suitability for treatment 02
4.5.5 Suitability of ground conditions 02
4.5.6 Compatibility of the ground,
design and treatment 05
4.5.7 Acceptable methods 06
4.5.8 Materials for use as fill 07
4.5.9 Granular material 08
4.5.10 Sitework 08
4.5.11 Adjacent excavations 09
4.5.12 Verification of completed treatment 10
Introduction
The vibratory process is generally applied to weak natural soils and filled ground. The purpose is to improve the
load-bearing capacity, reduce settlement and provide an adequate bearing stratum for the foundation supporting
the home.
British Standards, codes of practice and authoritative documents relevant to vibratory ground improvement techniques and site
investigations include:
BS 10175 Investigation of potentially contaminated sites Code of practice.
BS EN 1991 Actions on structures.
BS EN 1997-1 General rules.
BS EN 1997-2 Ground investigation and testing
BS EN 14731 Execution of special geotechnical works Ground treatment by deep vibration.
BS EN ISO 14688 Geotechnical investigation and testing Identification and classification of rock.
BS EN ISO 14689 Geotechnical investigation and testing Identification and classification of rock.
BS EN ISO 22476 Geotechnical investigation and testing Field testing.
BR 391 Specifying vibro stone columns.
ICE Specification for Ground Treatment.
Hazardous sites and ground hazards 4.5.2 Also see: Chapter 2.1, 4.1 and 4.2
Vibratory ground improvement techniques on hazardous sites shall be reported to NHBC before work on site
commences, and be designed to take account of the characteristics of the site, including any ground hazards.
Hazardous sites, as defined in the NHBC Rules, should be reported to NHBC in writing at least eight weeks before sitework begins.
Details of ground hazards to be taken into consideration are given in Chapter 4.1 Land quality managing ground conditions
and Chapter 4.2 Building near trees.
Desk study and site investigation 4.5.3 Also see: Chapter 2.1, 4.1 and 4.2
The engineer shall ensure a desk study and site investigation are undertaken and findings used to inform
the design.
The engineer should establish the scope of, and supervise, the site investigation, taking account of the findings of the desk study,
and relevant standards listed in Clause 4.5.1.
The specialist contractor should be satisfied that the site investigation provides adequate and representative information in order to
design the ground improvements. The results of the site investigation and desk study should be sent to NHBC prior to work starting
and should, as a minimum, determine the items listed in Table 1.
4.5
Previous structures Includes any potential underground obstructions or hard-spots,e.g. basement walls,
floor slabs, which remain.
Occurrence of Includes the presence and extent of contaminatedsubstances or gases present
contaminated substances or suspected.
Confirmation of suitability for treatment 4.5.4 Also see: Chapter 2.1, 4.1 and 4.2
The builder shall obtain written confirmation from the engineer and specialist contractor that the site is
suitable for the proposed ground improvement system.
NHBC should be notified prior to work starting, that the site is suitable for the proposed system. The engineer and specialist
contractor should agree the following in writing before work commences on site:
Design objectives.
Tests to be conducted on completion of the work.
Detailed schedule of work.
Responsibility for procedures and tests.
Programme of work.
Suitability of ground conditions 4.5.5 Also see: Chapter 2.1, 4.1 and 4.2
Vibratory ground improvement techniques shall only be conducted on suitable ground and be appropriate for
the site conditions. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) unsuitable ground conditions
b) detrimental factors
c) ground water conditions.
The engineer should assess the ground and be satisfied that it is suitable for treatment. Conditions acceptable for treatment are only
those within zones A and B of Chart 1.
Micron
1.18
3.35
37.5
mm
150
212
300
425
600
6.3
63
10
14
20
28
50
63
75
2
5
100
90
80
Zone B
70
Percentage passing
60
50 Zone A
40
30
20
4.5
10
0
0.002 0.006 0.02 0.06 0.2 0.6 2 6 20 60 200 mm
Fine Medium Coarse Fine Medium Coarse Fine Medium Coarse
Clay Cobbles
Silt Sand Gravel
Fill containing Ground where organic material forms more than 15% of fill by volume.
degradable material
Detrimental factors
4.5
When specifying vibratory ground improvement techniques, the following factors should be considered:
Partial depth treatment of filled ground. The engineer should
Obstructions and variations in the density of fill and natural
be satisfied with the anticipated performance of both the ground (hard spots) and the location of changes in the
treated and untreated zones. profile of the natural underlying ground, e.g. edges of pits
The specialist contractor should take responsibility for the
or quarries, slopes, or manmade obstructions such as
treated zone and the depth of treatment. soakaways or drainage runs.
Alterations to the oversite level before or after treatment, or
The minimum depth of soil treated, which should allow for
the disturbance of ground by excavations after treatment. the interaction of adjacent foundations.
Soils with a Modified Plasticity Index of 10% or greater;
Stone columns that may form vertical drains, allowing the
foundations should be designed to accommodate passage of water to a moisture-susceptible strata, or provide
volume changes. seepage paths for gases.
house A house B
foundation depth in
accordance with interaction of adjacent foundations
Chapter 4.2
Surface water sewers should be used for rainwater disposal where possible, but where soakaways are necessary, these should be
positioned so that their construction and operation is not detrimental to the treated ground.
The effect of any new or existing sustainable drainage systems (SuDS)should be taken into account when vibro improvement
techniques are proposed.
4.5
reinforced concrete
strip foundation
raft or semi-raft foundation
For both types of foundation, top and bottom reinforcement should be provided.
4.5
The depth of foundations to be a minimum of 600mm below the surface of the treated ground, and founded on firm material of
adequate bearing capacity.
Where the treated ground is of a granular nature, a reinforced concrete strip foundation will normally be acceptable provided that
normally be acceptable.
The reinforced concrete foundation should be designed to span between the centres of adjacent stone columns unless a more
rigorous structural analysis is carried out to show that an alternative detail is acceptable.
If partial depth treatment of filled ground is proposed then a suitably designed reinforced concrete raft or semi-raft foundation
should be used.
If during excavations for foundations in treated ground it is found that excessive depths of concrete are required, then precautions
should be taken to ensure overall stability of the foundations, and the engineer should be satisfied that construction of the
foundation will not be detrimental to the treated ground.
Notice to NHBC
Where vibratory ground improvement is proposed, NHBC should be informed of:
proposed development
proposed start date of treatment.
appointment of the specialist contractor
Materials for use as fill 4.5.8 Also see: BRE Special Digest 1 Part 1, BRE Special Digest 433 and BS EN 771
Stone fill for forming columns shall be compatible with the ground conditions, and be suitable for the vibratory
ground improvement process.
Column fill should be a clean, hard, inert material. Limestone fill may not be acceptable in acidic ground conditions.
Suitable sources for fill material
All material used for fill should be suitable.
Where the material is of a stable and uniform type from one source, it may only be necessary to check its suitability once.
Regular inspections and/or testing may be required where material is variable or from a number of sources.
Where material is obtained from stockpiles, the uniformity should be checked. Different forms of stockpiling can affect particle size
and grading. The outside of a stockpile may be weathered and may not be the same as unweathered material. The use of recycled
aggregate as fill should comply with BRE Digest 433 or other suitable guidance as agreed with NHBC.
Hazardous materials
The following materials require testing toensure their suitability for use as fill to support structural foundations and slabs, or as
backfill to associated trenches:
Acid wastes.
Toxic materials.
Reactive materials.
Materials that cause noxious fumes, rot, undue settlement or
Materials that include sulfates, e.g. gypsum.
damage to surrounding materials.
Organic materials.
4.5
Fill material requiring NHBC approval
The following types of fill should not be used unless written permission has been obtained from NHBC:
Colliery shale and any other residue from mineral extraction.
On wet sites, or sites with a high water table, crushed
Slags.
or broken bricks which have no limit on their soluble salt
Furnace ashes and other products of combustion.
content (as defined in BS EN 771).
Material obtained from demolition.
Sitework 4.5.10
When using vibratory ground improvement techniques, the builder shall ensure that the engineer visits the
site and provides competent supervision throughout the ground treatment process. Issues to be taken into
account include:
a) engineer checks
b) location, depth and alignment of columns
c) managing unforeseen circumstances.
Engineer checks
The engineer should provide competent site supervision throughout the ground treatment process and at critical stages, including:
the inspection of setting out
where installation data differs from design assumptions
the installation of columns during the early stage of the work
where changes in treatment layout are required.
checking of materials
Some aspects of sitework may be the responsibility of the engineer or their representative, or of the specialist contractor, rather than
of the builder.
2m max.
centres
4.5
Suitable testing
Tests should be carried out to establish thedegree of ground improvement, the load-bearing characteristics and
settlement potential.
The specialist contractor should:
predict the results from his experience of work on the type of
agree results and tolerance with the engineer with
ground prior to the test taking place actual results.
agree results and tolerance with the engineer prior to testing
4.5
Where the results are vastly different, a further investigation may be necessary.
Where a threefold improvement were predicted and only a twofold improvement achieved, this could indicate that the ground was
different to that identified in the investigation, or that the treatment carried out differed from the specified treatment.
Tests on ground containing clay soils may need to be conducted several days after completion to allow excess pore pressures
to dissipate. The engineer may choose any appropriate combination of the tests detailed in Table 4, with the agreement of NHBC.
Table 4: Test methods
Test Comments
600mm diameter plate tests Plate tests will not determine the design butwill allow for an assessment to be made ofthe
workmanship on the stone columns.
The tests should be carried out on stonecolumns or treated ground at a frequency of at least
one test per day per rig.
Dummy footing test/mini A mini zone test can be used as a limited
zone test substitute for zone tests. The test should be
applied to at least two stone columns and the
area of foundation which they support.
The load may be applied through a rigid beam
or stiffened plate using skips or other known
loads, arranged to give a uniform distribution
of the load.
Mini zone tests should be continued for a sufficient time to allow creep behaviour to
be quantified. Allowances for this time should be made in the overall project programme.
In-situ test Where vibration will improve the ground itself, e.g. granular materials, then in-situ testing
is appropriate.
4.5
Improvement can be assessed when the in-situ test results are compared with the
pretreatment investigation.
Trial pits Trial pits can be excavated around trialstone columns to prove that they are fully formed and to
the required depth and diameter.
This is a destructive test, and allowance should be made accordingly.
Recording of work
A comprehensive record of all works should be madeavailable to NHBC, including:
information concerning the treatment
on-site changes
depth of fill
any other relevant information.
volume of stone used
5.1.1 Compliance 01
5.1.2 Provision of information 01
5.1.3 Transfer of loads 01
5.1.4 Ground conditions 01
5.1.5 Services and drainage 02
5.1.6 Ground below fill 03
5.1.7 Fill below floors 03
5.1.8 Fill up to 600mm deep 04
5.1.9 Materials used for fill 04
5.1.10 Harmful or toxic materials 04
5.1.11 Regulatory solutions 05
5.1.12 Walls below the DPC 05
5.1.13 Durability 06
5.1.14 Mortar 07
5.1.15 Wall ties 07
5.1.16 Blinding 07
5.1.17 Ground floor slab and concrete 07
5.1.18 Laying the ground-bearing floor slab 08
5.1.19 Damp proof course 08
5.1.20 Damp proofing concrete floors 09
5.1.21 Thermal insulation 09
5.1.22 Installation of insulation 10
5.1.23 Further information 10
Transfer of loads 5.1.3 Also see: Chapters 4.1, 4.3, 5.2 and 6.1
5.1
Substructures and ground-bearing floors shall ensure that loads are supported and transferred to the
foundations, or ground, without undue movement.
The design of the substructure should take account of findings from the site investigation. Where infill deeper than 600mm is
needed, a suspended floor should be used.
Load-bearing partitions should have proper foundations and not be supported off ground-bearing floors. In Scotland, sleeper walls
should not be built on ground-bearing floors.
Ground conditions 5.1.4 Also see: Chapters 4.1, 4.2, 5.2 and BRE Report 211
Substructure and ground-bearing floors shall not be adversely affected by ground conditions, and take
account of:
a) ground hazards d) e
ffect of sloping ground on depth of infill and
b) bearing capacity of the ground wall construction
c) nature of the ground e) site works and construction.
Ground hazards
Hazards likely to affect substructure and ground-bearing floors include contaminated materials, waterlogged ground and chemicals,
particularly sulfates.
Where it is necessary to reduce the entry of radon gas, which should be identified in the site investigation, such precautions should
be acceptable to NHBC.
Bearing capacity
Ground-bearing floors may not be suitable where the bearing capacity and nature of the ground varies, even where the depth of infill
is less than 600mm. Special measures may be needed to restrict settlement, such as the use of suspended floor construction.
T
T
t1 t2
H greater
H than 4 x T
suspended floor
where the infill is
more than 600mm
where cavity
fill is omitted
T = t1 + t2
5.1
Site works and construction
Special precautions may be needed to prevent damage to the substructure from site operations on adjoining ground such as
ground treatment, or surcharging due to infill.
Services and drainage 5.1.5 Also see: Chapters 5.3, 5.4, 6.2 and 8.1
Substructure and ground-bearing floors shall be installed to:
a) adequately protect existing services and ground water drainage
b) have suitable surface and subsoil drainage
c) make allowance for drainage and other services.
150mm
max.
150mm
max. 3D
600mm 600mm
max. max. minimum
50mm space
around pipe
opening masked
on both sides
flexible joint flexible joint
Services should be sleeved where they pass through a structural element. Where required, they should be arranged so that future
access can be obtained without affecting structural stability.
5.1
When unidentified services, ducts, cables or pipes are exposed, advice should be sought from local offices of statutory undertakings
and service supply companies.
properly compacted
infill and backfill
Materials used for fill 5.1.9 Also see: BRE DG 522 Hardcore for supporting ground floors of buildings
Materials used for fill shall be suitable for the intended use and, unless appropriate precautions are taken,
free from hazardous materials. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) sources of fill materials
b) hazardous materials.
Fill should be:
well graded
able to pass a 150mm x 150mm screen in all directions.
inert and contain no hazardous materials
Fill containing either expansive materials or chemicals is not acceptable for the support of ground-bearing slabs.
The following types of fill should not be used unless written permission has been obtained from NHBC:
material obtained from demolition
on wet sites, or sites with a high water table, crushed
5.1
furnace ashes and other products of combustion
or broken bricks which have S1 designation according
colliery shale and any other residue from mineral extraction
to BS EN 771.
slags
Hazardous materials
The following fill materials require testing to ensure their suitability for use with ground-bearing slabs or as backfill to
associated trenches:
reactive materials
materials that cause noxious fumes, rot, undue settlement or
organic materials
damage to surrounding materials
toxic materials
acid wastes.
materials that include sulfates, e.g. gypsum
Harmful or toxic materials 5.1.10 Also see: BRE DG 522 Hardcore for supporting ground floors of buildings
Harmful or toxic materials present in the fill or in the ground shall be identified to the satisfaction of NHBC and
not affect the performance of the substructure and ground-bearing slab.
Precautions should be taken by either:
ensuring that made ground and fill materials are free from
designing the construction to contain, resist and prevent
harmful or toxic substances, or the adverse effects of such materials, using means
acceptable to NHBC.
Tests for sulfate content should comply with the recommendations of BRE Special Digest 1 Third Edition by a suitably qualified
person who has a detailed knowledge of the:
material being tested proposed conditions of use.
The samples tested must be representative of the material, so it may be necessary to collect multiple samples to
identify characteristics.
Where there are likely to be harmful levels of sulfate:
the floor slab should be of an appropriate mix to resist
the concrete blocks in substructure walls should be sulfate
sulfate attack or be protected by an impervious layer of 1200 resistant and suitable for the fill and ground conditions
gauge (0.3mm) polyethylene sheet, or 1000 gauge (0.25mm) the mortar should be sulfate resisting to comply with of
where it complies with Technical Requirement R3. This may BS EN 1996-1-1.
also serve as a DPM
Fill containing expansive materials or chemicals is no acceptable for use as infill or backfill.
Table 1: Regulatory solution for fill, including recycled and secondary materials
Location Materials used on: Regulatory solution
England and Wales Site of origin CL:AIRE Code of Practice.
Other sites and less than 5000t Registration under a U1 exemption with the EA is required at the
receiving site.
Other sites and over 5000t Ensure that the supplier has followed the WRAP protocol.
Northern Ireland Any site Registration under a paragraph 19 exemption with the SEPA/NIEA is
and Scotland required at the receiving site.
5.1
Walls below the DPC 5.1.12 Also see: Chapters 6.1 and 6.2
Substructure and walls below the DPC shall be suitably constructed. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) construction of walls acting as temporary retaining walls
b) concrete cavity fill.
t1 t2 T
D D
where cavity
fill is omitted backfill placed after
T = t1 + t2 concrete cavity fill
fill compacted equally
on both sides
This guidance is only applicable to the temporary condition and where problems such as hydrostatic pressure are not present.
5.1
Masonry walls below the DPC should be designed and constructed as described in Chapter 6.1 External Masonry Walls.
Recommendations for the design strength of bricks, masonry blocks and mortars are given in BS EN 1996-1-1.
Brickwork
Bricks should be of suitable durability, especially in the outer leaf below the DPC, or where they could be frozen when saturated.
Bricks used in retaining walls should be suitable for the exposure and climate, as recommended by the manufacturer.
Clay bricks should comply with BS EN 771, which classifies bricks according to their durability designation (F) and to the content of
active soluble salts (S).
F0 Not freeze/thaw resistant and should not be used externally
F1 Moderately freeze/thaw resistant
F2 Freeze/thaw resistant
S1 Normal active soluble salts
S2 Low active soluble salts
Generally, bricks are designated to F1,S2 or F1,S1. If in doubt as to suitability, bricks of F2,S2 or F2,S1 should be specified, or the
manufacturer consulted and written confirmation obtained in relation to:
geographical location
location in the structure.
Calcium silicate bricks for use below DPC should be at least compressive strength class 20.
Blockwork
Concrete blocks for use below the DPC should meet BS EN 771 and one of the following:
Minimum density of 1500kg/m3
assessed in accordance with Technical Requirement R3.
Minimum compressive strength of 7.3N/mm2
Where it is necessary to resist sulfate attack and ensure adequate durability, blocks made with sulfate-resisting cement and/or a
higher than normal cement content should be used.
Where there is doubt regarding the suitability of the block, particularly where acids or sulfates occur, written confirmation of its
suitability should be obtained from the manufacturer in relation to:
geographical location
location in the structure.
Mortar mix
Mortar should comply with the design and should take account of the strength, type and location of the masonry. The selection of
mortar for use below the DPC should follow the recommendations given in BS EN 1996-1-1.
The use of proprietary mortars and admixtures should:
account for the type of masonry unit and its location
only be used in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
For non-clay bricks or blocks, mortar should be used in accordance with the brick manufacturers recommendations.
Sulfate resistance
Sulfate-resisting cement should be used where:
sulfates are present in the ground, ground water or masonry
recommended by the brick manufacturer.
In such cases, sulfate-resisting cement to BS 4027 should be used.
Substructure and walls below the DPC shall use wall ties suitable for their intended use.
Wall ties should comply with BS EN 845 or be assessed in accordance with Technical Requirement R3.
Where cavity insulation batts or slabs start below DPC level, the vertical and horizontal spacing of wall ties should be compatible
with the spacing to be used above DPC level.
Blinding 5.1.16
Blinding shall provide a suitable surface for the materials above.
Infill should be sufficiently blinded to receive the concrete, and DPM where required, using the minimum thickness necessary to give
a suitable surface.
Concrete blinding may be needed where voids in the fill could result in loss of fines from the blinding. Where hardcore fill is used,
smooth blinding, e.g. sand or other suitable fine material, is essential to avoid puncturing a sheet DPM.
Where the ground floor is to be reinforced, blinding should be firm and even, to give good support for the reinforcement and to
maintain the design cover using reinforcement stools, where appropriate.
Ground floor slab and concrete 5.1.17 Also see: Chapter 3.1
Ground-bearing floors shall be of adequate strength and durability, and use concrete mixed and reinforced as
necessary to support floor loads safely and resist chemical and frost action.
Ground-bearing concrete floor slabs should be at least 100mm thick, including monolithic screed where appropriate.
Laying the ground-bearing floor slab 5.1.18 Also see: Chapters 3.1 and 9.3
Ground-bearing floors shall be reasonably level and effectively impervious to moisture.
All underfloor services and ducts should be installed and tested
DPM protected
before concreting, where appropriate. by a board
Damp proof course 5.1.19 Also see: Chapters 5.4 and 6.1
Damp proof courses shall adequately resist moisture from reaching the inside of the building. Issues to be
taken into account include:
a) positioning of DPCs
b) DPC materials.
Positioning of DPCs
5.1
DPCs should be:
positioned a minimum of 150mm above finished ground or
of the correct width and fully bedded
paving level either welded or lapped by 100mm minimum
linked with any DPM
impermeable.
membrane linked
with a stepped DPC
floor level
DPC level
150mm
DPC level
150mm
ground level min.
Where homes are stepped on a sloping site, care should be taken to link DPCs and DPMs so that all parts of each home
are protected.
DPC materials
Acceptable materials for DPCs include:
Bitumen based materials BS 6398
Polyethylene, (should not be used below BS 6515
copings,in parapets or for tanking) 0.5mm minimum
Proprietary materials Technical Requirement R3
DPCs and flexible cavity trays should be of the correct dimensions. At complicated junctions, preformed cavity trays of the correct
type and shape should be used.
Brick DPCs are only suitable to resist the upward movement of moisture and should:
consist of two courses of engineering bricks,
be bedded and jointed in a 1::3, cement:lime:sand,
laid broken bond or equivalent, mortar.
Care should be taken not to trap moisture when a combination of damp proofing and vapour control layers are used.
When the membrane is located below the slab, a blinding layer DPC laps DPM
of sand should be provided to fill voids in the hardcore and to
minimise the risk of puncturing the membrane.
A clear cavity of at least 225mm below the DPC should be
maintained. When specialised foundations are used, including
those for timber framed buildings, this depth may be reduced 225mm
min.
to 150mm below the DPC where weep holes are provided and
other necessary measures are taken to ensure that the cavity
can drain freely.
Where homes are stepped down a sloping site, the DPCs and
DPMs should be linked so that all parts of each home
are protected. The guidance in Chapter 5.4 Waterproofing concrete cavity fill
5.1
Thermal insulation 5.1.21 Also see: Chapters 6.1, 9.3 and BRE Report Thermal insulation: avoiding risks
Ground-bearing floors and walls below the DPC shall be thermally insulated to comply with building
regulations and be suitable for the intended use. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) floor insulation
b) wall insulation
c) cold bridging.
Floor insulation
Thermal insulation materials for use below ground-bearing slabs should have:
appropriate density for the location
low water absorption.
Insulation to be positioned below both the slab and DPM should be resistant to ground contaminants. The following materials are
acceptable for use as insulation:
expanded polystyrene boards (grade EPS 70)
a proprietary material that complies with
to BS EN 13163 Technical Requirement R3.
Wall insulation
Cavity insulation materials, super lightweight blocks, blocks with face bonded insulation or integral insulation should be:
manufactured and used to comply with a British Standard
used in compliance with Technical Requirement R3.
and relevant code of practice, or
The thickness of materials should be suitable for the required level of performance:
England and Wales BS 6232 Thermal insulation of cavity walls by filling with blown man-made mineral fibre
BS 6676 Thermal insulation of cavity walls using man-made mineral fibre batts (slabs)
BS 5617 for UF foam when permitted and installed by a specialist company registered by BSI in
accordance with BS 5618.
Scotland Not permitted to fill the full width of the cavity with any thermal insulants at the time of construction.
Northern Ireland and the Not permitted to fill cavities with pumped thermal insulants at the time of construction.
Isle of Man
Cold bridging
The design should ensure that any risk of cold bridging is minimised, especially at junctions between floors and external walls.
Precautions include:
extending cavity insulation below floor slab level
facing supporting substructure with insulation
linking floor and wall insulation
where homes are stepped or staggered, the wall forming
providing perimeter insulation to floors
the step or stagger may require insulation.
5.1
DPM trimmed to
avoid bridging
cavity
5.2.1 Compliance 01
5.2.2 Provision of information 01
5.2.3 Contaminants 01
5.2.4 Proprietary systems 01
5.2.5 Transfer of loads: concrete floors 01
5.2.6 Reinforced concrete 02
5.2.7 Construction of suspended
concrete ground floors 02
5.2.8 Transfer of loads: timber floors 02
5.2.9 Thermal insulation and cold bridging 03
5.2.10 Damp-proofing and ventilation 03
5.2.11 Floor finishes 04
5.2.12 Floor decking 04
Compliance 5.2.1 Also see: Chapters 2.1, 4.1, 4.2, 4.5 and 5.1
Suspended ground floors shall comply with the Technical Requirements.
Suspended ground floors that comply with the guidance in this chapter will generally be acceptable.
Ground floors should be constructed as suspended floors where:
the depth of fill exceeds 600mm
the ground has been subject to vibratory improvement
there is shrinkable soil that could be subject to movement
ground or fill is not suitable to support ground-bearing slabs.
(See Chapter 4.2 Building near trees), expansive materials
or other unstable soils
Precast:
Loads should be calculated in accordance with BS EN 1991-1-1.
Precast concrete suspended ground floors should be:
designed by an engineer in accordance with
chosen from the manufacturers details which are based on
Technical Requirement R5 recognised standards and codes of practice.
proprietary systems which have been assessed in
End bearings
In-situ:
Bearings on supporting walls should be designed either:
by an engineer in accordance with in accordance with BS 8103-1.
Technical Requirement R5, or
Precast:
Bearings on supporting walls should be as recommended by the manufacturer, and in no case less than 90mm.
5.2
Concrete and its reinforcement.
Construction of suspended concrete ground floors 5.2.7 Also see: Chapter 6.4
Suspended ground floors shall be designed and constructed to ensure the safe support of the intended loads
and be reasonably level.
In-situ:
Concreting should be carried out in accordance with:
the design information
relevant parts of NHBC guidance for concrete,
including Chapter 3.1 Concrete and its reinforcement.
Precast:
Care should be taken to ensure that DPCs are not damaged or displaced. All sitework for precast concrete floors should be carried
out in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
Transfer of loads: timber floors 5.2.8 Also see: Chapters 4.3 and 6.4
Timber suspended ground floors, including the decking material, shall be designed and constructed to be
suitable for their intended use. Issues to be taken into account include the:
a) support of self-weight, dead and imposed loads and b) safe transmission of loads to the supporting structure
limited deflection c) adverse effects of shrinkage and movement.
Damp-proofing and ventilation 5.2.10 Also see: Chapters 4.2, 5.1, 5.4, 6.1 and 9.3
Suspended ground floors shall be designed and constructed to resist the passage of moisture into the
building. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) damp-proofing
b) ventilation.
5.2
Damp-proofing
Where DPMs are required, they should be linked with any DPCs in the supporting structure, in order to provide continuous
protection from moisture from the ground or through the supporting structure.
DPMs should be properly lapped in accordance with Chapter 5.1 Substructure and ground-bearing floors.
In-situ concrete:
Dampness from the ground and supportingstructure should be prevented from reaching the floor by using linked DPMs and DPCs
to provide continuous protection.
Where there is a risk of sulfate attack, in-situ or oversite concrete should be protected with polyethylene sheet that is a minimum:
1200 gauge (0.3mm), or
1000 gauge (0.25mm) if assessed in accordance with
Technical Requirement R3.
Precast concrete:
Additional damp-proofing may not be necessary where:
the underfloor void is ventilated and DPCs are provided
ground below the floor is effectively drained, if excavated
under bearings of precast floors in accordance with CP 102 below the level of the surrounding ground.
Where proprietary floor systems are used, adequate moisture-resistant membranes should be installed in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
Vapour control layers may be necessary to protect floor finishes, and where used, should be positioned in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
Timber ground floors:
Timber used for suspended ground floors should be treated or naturally durable, in accordance with Chapter 3.3
Timber preservation (natural solid timber), and the ground below the floor covered with:
50mm concrete or fine aggregate on a polyethylene
100mm concrete.
membrane laid on 50mm sand blinding, or
In Scotland, the deemed-to-satisfy specification of the building regulations should be followed.
Ventilation
Ventilation should be provided to precast and timber suspended floors. This is generally provided by ventilators on at least two
opposite external walls, with air bricks properly ducted in accordance with Chapter 6.1 External masonry walls. Where this is
not possible, suitable cross ventilation should be provided by a combination of openings and air ducts. Ventilation should not be
obtained through a garage.
Sleeper walls and partitions should be constructed with sufficient openings to ensure adequate through ventilation. If necessary,
pipe ducts should be incorporated in adjoining solid floors, separating walls or other obstructions.Where underfloor voids adjoin
ground bearing floors, ventilation ducts should be installed.
Void ventilation should be provided to whichever gives the greater opening area:
1500mm2 per metre run of external wall
500mm2 per m2 of floor area.
In the case of timber floors, ventilators should be spaced at no more that 2m centres and within 450mm of the end of any wall.
A minimum ventilation void of 150mm should be provided below the underside of precast concrete and timber suspended floors.
On shrinkable soil where heave could take place, a larger void is required to allow for movement according to the volume
change potential.
high volume change potential 150mm (300mm total void)
low volume change potential 50mm (200mm total void).
medium volume change potential 100mm
5.2
condensation or spillage.
Guidance for suitable floor finishes is given in Chapter 9.3 Floor finishes. Care should be taken to prevent trapping any water
spillage below timber floors.
Other floor decking should be assessed in accordance with Technical Requirement R3 and should be installed in accordance with
manufacturers recommendations.
5.3.1 Compliance 01
5.3.2 Provision of information 01
5.3.3 Preliminary work 01
5.3.4 Foul and surface water disposal 02
5.3.5 Drainage system performance 03
5.3.6 Ground water drainage 03
5.3.7 Design to avoid damage and blockages 03
5.3.8 Durability 07
5.3.9 Septic tanks and cesspools 08
5.3.10 Septic tanks 09
5.3.11 Surface watersoakaways 11
5.3.12 Component requirements 13
5.3.13 Excavation 13
5.3.14 Protection of pipework 14
5.3.15 Laying pipework 15
5.3.16 Protection of work 16
5.3.17 Testing 16
Foul and surface water disposal 5.3.4 Also see: BS EN 752, Clause 5.3.11 and BRE Digest 365
Drainage systems shall be designed in accordance with relevant codes and standards to convey foul effluents
and surface water satisfactorily to an appropriate outfall. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) connections to sewers d) compatibility with other systems
b) connections to surface water disposal systems e) capacity of private sewers
c) rights of connection to disposal systems f) treatment plants for more than one home.
Connections to sewers
Connections to public sewers require the agreement of the responsible authority, which should be consulted as to the type and
position of the connection.
Connections to private sewers require the agreement of the owners of the sewer. This should be obtained as part of the
design process. Where the private sewer subsequently discharges into a public sewer, the local sewerage undertaker should be
notified of the proposal.
For large or complicated homes, the volume of surface water to be disposed should be calculated in accordance with BS 6367.
5.3
Rights of connection to disposal systems
A legal right must exist when connecting drains to an outfall.
Drainage system performance 5.3.5 Also see: Chapter 4.1, 8.1, BRE Report 211 and BRE Report 212
Drainage shall be suitably located and prevent health hazards. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) ventilation of drainage systems c) siting of septic tanks and cesspools
b) prevention of gases entering thehome d) pumped systems.
Pumped systems
5.3
Where a gravity system is not possible, pumped systems may have to be used and should be designed in accordance with
BS EN 752 and BS 6297. The installation should include:
a holding tank of sufficient volume to contain 24 hours of
suitable equipment housing.
domestic effluent based on 120L/150L per head per day
a suitable warning system providing visual and/or audible
signals to indicate malfunction
Layout of pipes
Where ground water drainage is required, depending on the site contours and groundconditions, it may be designed as:
a natural system
a fan-shaped system
a herringbone system
a moat system.
a grid system
Pipe construction
Pipe perforations should be holes or slotsto suit the nature of the ground.
Ground water drain systems connected to foul, surface water or combined drains should discharge into the drain through a catchpit.
Where suitable, ground water drainage may discharge into a soakaway, preferably through a catchpit or into a watercourse.
Design to avoid damage and blockages 5.3.7 Also see: Chapter 4.2
Drainage systems shall minimise the risk of damage and blockage. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) ground stability e) access and connections
b) pipe runs f) drainage covers and gully grids
c) pipe sizes g) ground water
d) gradients h) flooding.
Ground stability
Proper allowance should be made for ground movement.
Pipes should have flexible joints and additional precautions taken to prevent leakage where required. Where ground movement
could be significant, for example in made-up ground or clay soils, the following issues should be taken into account:
the use of flexible pipes and flexible joints
a support system designed by an engineer in accordance
design gradients that are steeper than the minimum
with Technical Requirement R5
requirements for flow rate and pipe size conditions where ground movement is likely to adversely
affect the drain.
In non-uniform or saturated soils where movement at the trench bottom can be expected, soft spots should be removed and
replaced with suitable material. Immediately after excavation, the protective blinding should be placed in the trench bottom.
Pipe runs
Pipe runs should be designed to maintain a self-cleansing velocity (0.7 m/s). Theyshould be as straight as practicable with minimal
changes of direction. Bends should only occur in, or next to, inspection chambers and manhole covers. Curves should be slight so
that blocked pipes can be cleared.
Pipe sizes
Pipe sizes should be designed for the maximum peak load in accordance with BS EN 752.
Ground water drains and soakaways should be designed with sufficient capacity for normal weatherconditions.
Gradients
5.3
Design gradients should:
be as even as practicable
where peak flows exceed 1.0L/second, the gradients in
where flows are less than 1.0L/second, gradients for 100mm
Table 2 may be used:
diameter pipes should not be flatter than 1:40
Table 2: Minimum gradients
Pipe diameter (mm) Minimum gradient
100 1:80
150 1:150
Where peak flows are greater than 1.0L/second, 100mm pipes should serve a minimum of one WC and 150mm pipes should serve
a minimum of five.
access chambers
inspection chambers
manholes.
access chamber
inspection chamber
manhole
All access points should be located asshown in the design information and should:
be accessible for rodding and cleaning
not cross boundaries or kerb lines.
Inspection chambers and manholes should:
be of sufficient size for the depth of invert, and
the invert depth for the fitting or chamber should not
exceeded those given in Table 3.
Table 3: Minimum dimensions for access fittings and chambers
Type Depth to invert Internal sizes Cover sizes
from cover Length x width Circular Length x width Circular (mm)
level (m) (mm x mm) (mm) (mm x mm)
Rodding eye As drain but Same size as pipework(1)
min. 100
Small access fitting 150 dia. 0.6 or less, except 150 x 100 150 150 x 100(1) Same size as access fitting
150 x 100 where situated in a
Large access fitting 225 x 100 chamber 225 x 100 225 225 x 100(1) Same size as access fitting
Shallow inspection chamber 0.6 or less 225 x 100 190(2) 190(1)
1.2 or less 450 x 450 450 Min. 430 x 430 430
Deep inspection chamber Greater than 1.2 450 x 450 450 Max. 300 x 300(3) Access restricted to max. 350(3)
Notes
1 The clear opening may be reduced by 20mm in order to provide further support for the cover and frame.
2 Drains up to 150mm.
3 A larger clear opening cover may be used in conjunction with restricted access. The size is restricted for health and safety reasons to deter entry.
Type Size of largest pipe (DN) (mm) Minimum internal dimensions(1) Min. clear opening size(1)
Rectangular Circular diameter (mm) Rectangular Circular
length and length and diameter
width (mm) width (mm) (mm)
Manhole up to Equal to or less than 150 750 x 675(7) 1000(7) 750 x 675(2) NA(3)
1.5m deep to 225 1200 x 675 1200 1200 x 675(2)
soffit 300 1200 x 750 1200
Greater than 300 1800 x (DN+450) The larger of 1800 or (DN+450)
Manhole greater Equal to or less than 225 1200 x 1000 1200 600 x 600 600
than 1.5m deep 300 1200 x 1075 1200
to soffit 375-450 1350 x 1225 1200
Greater than 450 1800 x (DN+775) The larger of 1800 or (DN+775)
Manhole shaft(4) Steps(5) 1050 x 800 1050 600 x 600 600
greater than 3.0m Winch(6) 900 x 800 900 600 x 600 600
deep to soffit pipe
Ladder(5) 1200 x 800 1200
Notes
1 Larger sizes may be required for manholes on bends or where there are junctions.
2 May be reduced to 600 x 600 where required by highway loading restrictions and subject to a safe system of work being specified.
3 Not applicable due to working space needed.
4 Minimum height of chamber in shafted manhole 2m from benching to underside of reducing slab.
5 Minimum clear space between ladder or steps and the opposite face of the shaft should be approximately 900mm.
6 Winch only; no steps or ladders, permanent or removable.
7 The minimum size of any manhole serving a sewer, i.e. any drain serving more than one home, should be 1200mm x 675mm rectangular or 1200mm diameter.
8 Tables 3 & 4 have been reproduced from Tables 11 and 12 of Approved Document H by permission of HMSO.
Traditional construction
The minimum specification for traditionalmanholes and inspection chambers is asfollows:
Base Minimum 100mm concrete.
Walls Brick, blockwork or concrete shouldbe appropriate for the ground conditions.
100mm minimum thickness issuitable for depths up to 0.9m where no vehicular traffic loads are encountered and
there is no ground water pressure.
Elsewhere, 200mm minimum thicknessshould be provided.
Rendering Where required, rendering should be applied tothe external faces of the wall.
Benching Benching should be steel trowelled toprovide:
a smooth finish
rounded corners
5.3
a fall of not less than 1:12.
Manholes should be constructed or installedat the correct level so that the covers willalign with the adjacent ground.
Gullies should be adequately:
bedded
square and kerbed.
set level
Table 5: Type of covering and grid required for inspection and manhole covers andframes
Group 1 Areas which can only be usedby pedestrians and cyclists.
Group 2 Footways, pedestrian areasand comparable areas, car parks or carparking decks.
Group 3 For gully tops installed in thearea of kerbside channels of roads which when measured from the kerb edge,
extend a maximum of 0.5m into thecarriageway and a maximum of 0.2minto the footway.
Group 4 Carriageways of roads, including pedestrian streets, hardshoulders and parking areas, and suitable for all
types of road vehicles.
Proprietary items, e.g. covers toplastic manholes, should be in accordancewith manufacturers recommendations.
Table 5a: Gully grids in carriageways
Grade B For use in carriageways of roads with cars and slow-moving normal commercial vehicles.
Grade A class 2 For use in carriageways of roads.
Grade A class 1 For use in carriageways of roads (gully grids of permanent non-rock design).
Ground water
Foul and surface water drainage systems should prevent the ingress of ground water.
Flooding
5.3
Where there is a risk of flooding, the advice of the relevant river authority should be followed.
B is within A-150mm B
from the bottom of foundation
Bedding of pipes
Bedding should be in accordance with Clause 5.3.15.
Where drains are located beneath raft foundations or where ground movement is likely, the design of the pipework and support
system should be carried out by a suitably qualified engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
See Clause 4.3.14 for Pipework passing through substructure walls.
5.3
Septic tank and cesspools 5.3.9
Septic tanks and cesspools shall be correctly installed and be suitable for their intended use. Issues to be
taken into account include:
a) capacity c) permeability of septic tanks and cesspools
b) access and ventilation d) connections to septic tanks and cesspools.
A septic tank is a form of treatment plant and requires a suitable outfall for treated effluent discharge, which is agreed with the
relevant authority.
A cesspool is a tank which stores effluent and has to be emptied periodically.
Capacity
The capacity of the septic tank should be based on the number of people it willserve, using the formula: C = 180P + 2000
C = Capacity of tank in litres. Minimum 2700L.
P = Design population/potential occupancy. Minimum four occupants.
Cesspools are required to be at least 18m3 capacity. A 45-day holding capacity calculated at 150 litres/head/day should be provided.
Outfall
The designer should ensure at an early stage that consent for discharge will be given, or select an alternative method ofdrainage.
Certain locations and ground conditions may preclude the use of septic tanks. Septic tank sewage systems should have:
satisfactory outfall disposal
placement that accounts for topography and ensures that
water is drained away from the building.
Where a septic tank drainage system is to be installed, NHBC requires:
evidence of a satisfactory percolation test
copies of relevant consents and approvals before
work commences.
Flow velocity
5.3
The results of the percolation test should be used in accordance with Table 6 to determine a suitable method of drainage.
5.3
210
200 8 persons
190
180
Field drain trench area (m2)
7 persons
170
160
150 6 persons
140
130
120 5 persons
110
100 4 persons
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100
Percolation value
500
450
400 600 wide
350 750 wide
300 900 wide
250
200
150
100
50
0
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160 180 200 220 240
Drain trench floor (m2)
Field drains
Field drains should be:
sited according to topography, ensuring that water is drained
laid on a 150mm bed of clinker, clean gravel or broken stone
away from the building (20mm50mm grade) and trenches filled to a level 50mm
formed with perforated pipe, laid at least 500mm below
above the pipe and covered with strips of plastic material to
the surface prevent entry of silt
laid in trenches with a uniform gradient less than 1:200 with
backfilled with as dug material.
undisturbed ground 2m wide between trenches and at least
8m from any building and 10m from any water course
Wherethe level of the water table isexpected to rise in the winter months towithin 1m of the field drain invert, it is not acceptable to
use subsurface irrigation.
Underdrains
Where underdrains are necessary, drainage trenches should be
constructed a minimum of600mm deeper than the pipe level soil, gravel or 300-600mm
specified in the design. other topping
tar paper
The lower part of the drainage trenches should be filled with
300mm
peagravel. A second system of drainage pipes should be laid broken tile as
cover to joint
on the bottom of the trenches to conveysurplus drainage to an
outfall in a surface ditch or watercourse.
sand and
gravel
600mm
5.3
drain
600mm
Soakaway location
Soakaways should be:
built on land lower than, or sloping away from, buildings
in soil of low permeability, only be provided where no
sited at least 5m from the foundations of a building
alternative system is available.
sited to take account of topography, ensuring that water is
drained away from the building
Soakaway design
NHBC may require a percolation test fora soakaway, PVC sheet or
concrete blinding
especially where there is:
doubt about theground,
a large quantity of run-off into the soakaway which may
swamp the ground.
Where the ground is free drainingand granular, a test may not
be necessary.
In soil, chalk and fill material subject tomodification or instability, effective depth
the advice of a specialist geotechnologist should be sought D
diameter D
Small soakaways
Small soakaways are holes filled withgranular material, e.g. broken brick, crushedrock or gravel, with particle size 10mm to150mm.
PVC sheet or concrete blindingshould be laid over the fill to preventtopsoil being washed down into thesoakaway.
Large soakaways
Large soakaways consist of a pit lined with dryjointed or honeycomb brickwork.
Alternatively, precast perforated concreterings or segments may be laid dry andsurrounded with granular material.
The volume of large soakaways should becalculated to ensure suitablecapacity.
Percolation test procedure for surface water soakaway
The rate at which water will disperse into the ground depends on the permeability of the ground, which varies with soil type.
The percolation test provides an assessment of how the ground drains.
As the test hole can be used as part of a soakaway, it should be:
dug in a place that could be used as asoakaway
to the same depth as the proposed drain.
at least 5m from the foundations of a building
5.3
Step 5 A second group of tests are carried out after the hole has been bored out to a depth of two metres, still using a
300mm depth of water.
Step 6 Where the soil appears to become more permeable with depth, it may be useful to deepen andretest the bore in
one-metre stages.
Design of soakaway
The relationship between the diameter or effective depth required for a soakaway, to suit a given collection area, e.g. roof or paved
surface, and the average time (T) resulting from the test is shown in the graph below.
The diameter and effective depth belowinvert level are assumed to be the same dimension (D).
Example
Test time (T) = 900 minutes
Plan area to drain = 150m2
From the graph below, the diameter and effective depth of the soakaway (D) are both 2.8m.
400
300
200 D
=
3.5
m
D = 2.8
150
D
=3
.0m
100 D=
2.5
m
D= D=
1.5 2.0m
m
D=
1.0m
0
0 400 800 1200 1600 2000 2400 2800 3200 3600 4000 4400
900 Time (T) in minutes
Where the ground is of low permeability; dig separate soakaways to drain smaller but distinctparts, for example:
one side of a roof to one soakaway
the driveway or yard to a third soakaway.
the other side to a second soakaway
Where the permeability of the ground increases with depth; tests in the deepened trialholes will give shorter percolation times.
It may be more cost effective to build a smaller soakawayat a greater depth below the surface.
BS EN 124 Gully tops and manhole tops for vehicular and pedestrian areas.
BS EN 295 Vitrified clay pipes, fittings and pipe joints for drains and sewers.
BS EN 1401-1 Plastics piping systems for non-pressure underground drainage and sewerage
Unplasticised poly (vinyl chloride) (PVC-U).
Excavation 5.3.13
Excavations shall ensure that the invert levels and gradients requiredby the design are achieved. Issues to be
taken into account include:
a) setting out dimensions
b) depth of trenches
c) width of trenches.
Width of trenches
Trenches should be as narrow as possiblewithin working limits and allow a minimum 150mm working space on each side of
the pipe.
150mm 150mm
max. max.
opening masked
on both sides
5.3
flexible joint
100mm
Movement joints
Where rigid pipes are to be encased inconcrete,
movement joints should be:
provided around the spigot next to the socket either at
5m maximum intervals or at each joint
13mm thick compressible board.
Bedding
Pipes should be firmly supported throughout their length and bedded as specified in the design to resist loads from overlying fill
and traffic.
Where pipework is installed under a suspended floor and is supported onground or fill where movement is likely to occur,
additional provisions may be required. See Clause 5.3.8.
5.3
Bricks, blocks or other hard material should not be used as temporary supportsto achieve the correct gradients, as they may create
hard spots which can distort the completed pipe run.
Pipes should be either:
bedded on granular material, minimum 100mm deep, or
laid directly on the trench bottom, where the trench bottom
can be accurately hand trimmed with a shovel but is not so
soft that it puddles when walked on.
For 150mm diameter and 100mm diameter drains, a bed and surround pea gravel in accordance with Table 8 (to a thickness of
100mm all round the drain) will be acceptable for drains under gardens, paths and drives.
Proprietary systems should be assessedin accordance with Technical Requirement R3 and supported in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations. Some proprietarysystems permit a minimum of 50mm depth of bedding in certain circumstances.
Depressions should be formed wherenecessary in the trench bottom toaccommodate pipe joints.
Pipe bedding, including the bedding material, should be in
accordance with:
BS EN 13242
BS 5955
BS EN 752.
Bedding material and specification should be in accordance with Table 8. Backfill and bedding that includes recycledor secondary
pipe supported on pipe supported on a
materials should conform tothe appropriate regulatory requirementsfor waste, trench
as defined
bottom in the WasteFramework Directive 2008.
bed of granular material
Backfill should be wellcompacted and placed in layers nodeeper than 300mm. Mechanical compacting shouldonly be used when
compacted backfill is over 450mm above the crown of the pipe.
5.3
Protection of work 5.3.16
Drainage systems shall besuitably protected from damage byconstruction work.
Damaged drainage will not be accepted, and itis
recommended that:
no heavy loading orunderground work is permitted above,
Testing 5.3.17
All foul and surface water drainage systems shall be adequately watertight, and tested where appropriate.
Inspection and testing should be arrangedwhen required by:
the local authority
NHBC.
thesewerage undertaker
Before backfilling, visual inspections arerequired and the builder is advised to test.When the home is handed over, the system must
be in full working order andfree from obstruction.
5.4.1 Compliance 02
5.4.2 Provision of information 02
5.4.3 Waterproofing 02
5.4.4 Ground conditions 03
5.4.5 Structural stability 04
5.4.6 Design considerations 04
5.4.7 Waterproofing systems 06
5.4.8 Handling, storage and protection 08
Introduction
This chapter includes guidance for walls, floors and foundations below, or near to, ground level that are intended to
prevent the passage of water form the ground (including from sources such as run-off, burst pipes etc.) entering the
building near to or below ground level.
Guidance for the following types of waterproofing systems is included in this chapter:
Type A waterproofing barriers Type C drained cavity construction.
Type B structurally integral construction
Constructions that are at risk of coming into contact with water and generally require waterproofing include:
basements
storage or plant rooms
semi-basements
service ducts, or similar, that are connected to the
below ground parking areas
below ground structure
lift pits
stepped floor slabs where the retained ground is greater
cellars
than 150mm.
Types of construction that, depending on the findings of a risk assessment, may require waterproofing include:
external walls where the lowest finished floor level is
voids caused by split levels.
less than 150mm higher than the external ground level
Waterproofing should be provided where due to the construction details and the
ground conditions, there is a risk of contact with ground water (see Table 1)
Waterproofing is required
Stairs adjacent to the structure Stepped floor slabs where the retained Raised external ground levels
ground is greater than 150mm
5.4
specialist below ground structures.
Waterproofing system A fully assessed and certified system of compatible materials and components used to provide waterproofing. These
are normally considered to be Type A, B or C as defined above.
Retained ground In this chapter retained ground levels are taken from the top of the retained ground to the lowest finished floor level.
Compliance 5.4.1 Also see: Chapter 2.1, BS 8102 and Basements for dwellings; guidance document
Basements and other below ground structures shall comply with the Technical Requirements.
Waterproofing of basements and other below ground structures,including foundations, walls and floors that complies with the
guidance in this chapter will generally be acceptable.
Design and specification information should be issued to site supervisors, relevant specialist subcontractors and/or suppliers
and include the following information:
A full set of current drawings.
An installation method statement detailing the
Details of joints, junctions and service penetrations.
sequence of works.
The manufacturers information, including relevant parts of
A ground condition report.
the system design manual. Third-party certifications.
Details of the waterproofing design specialist.
Design and specification information should be provided to NHBC at least eight weeks in advance of the works starting on site,
in accordance with NHBC Rules.
Waterproofing design
Waterproofing systems should be designed by a waterproofing design specialist. Designers who have successfully completed the
Certified Surveyor in Structural Waterproofing (CSSW) qualification available from the Property Care Association (PCA) are generally
acceptable to NHBC. An alternative demonstration of competence may be acceptable, subject to successful review.
The waterproofing design specialist should be appointed in the early design stages to co-ordinate with other designers, including the
engineer, and to ensure satisfactory integration of the waterproofing system.
Risk-based design
Waterproofing should be appropriate to the risk, and generally assume exposure to a full height of water during the design life of
the building.
Combined systems should be used where:
a Grade 3 environment is needed, and
the wall retains more than 600mm.
Alternatively, where the builder has demonstrated that the water table is permanently below the underside of the lowest floor slab,
a Type B structurally integral concrete system is acceptable without further protection from a combined system.
The following Types of waterproofing are acceptable where a Grade 2 environment is needed and more than 600mm of ground is
retained:
Type A fully bonded barrier
Type C
Type B
a combined system.
waterproofing system.
NHBC may request investigation and a report of the ground conditions where the below groundwaterproofed structure:
retains more than 600mm of ground, measured from the top
comprises more than 15% of the perimeter of an individual
of the retained ground to the lowest finished floor level building (e.g. terraced homes, apartment blocks and
detached garages), measured on plan.
The ground conditions report should takeinto account appropriate investigations, as described in Table 1.
Table 1: Investigation of ground conditions
Further investigation Guidance and information
Desk study, including review of: www.environment-agency.gov.uk/homeandleisure/floods
ground water and flooding issues www.bgs.ac.uk/research/groundwater/datainfo/levels/home.html
flood potential of the site www.metoffice.gov.uk/climate/uk/stationdata
available ground water data
SuDS impact assessment
flood risk assessment
topography of the site
effects of adjacent surface finishes.
Contaminated or aggressive ground and/or Testing required where there is the potential for chemically
ground water conditions. aggressive ground and/or ground water.
Water level change, including potential for flash flooding Identifying likely fluctuations and short-term flooding events.
and waterlogging.
Impact assessment of ground water flow where the Interpretative report by a qualified engineer, hydrologist or
construction is likely to have a damming effect. hydrogeologist to include:
assessment of the direction of ground water flow
damming effects on the ground water regime
damming effect of adjacent structures.
Where it is necessary to establish the water table, a detailedhydrogeological assessment should beundertaken by a suitably
qualified engineer, and include:
long-term water level monitoring over at least one year to
information based on a suitable number of boreholes
capture seasonal fluctuations monitored at a minimum of three-month intervals.
short-term flooding events that typicallyoccur during
autumn and spring
Structural stability 5.4.5 Also see: Chapters 4.1, 4.2 and 5.1
Elements forming a waterproofing structure below ground including: foundations, walls and floors,
shall adequately resist movement and be suitable for their intended purpose. Issues to be taken into
account include:
a) site conditions d) movement
b) structural design e) design co-ordination.
c) durability
Site conditions
Parts of the building constructed below ground level that form the structural elements of usable spaces should be designed by an
engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5 where they are retaining more than 600mm. Issues that should be taken into
account include:
characteristics of the site
hazards.
ground conditions
Structural design
The structure should be designed totake account of allimposed loads and actions, including:
ground movement
buoyancy
lateral forces from ground water, retained ground and
loading from other parts of the building
ground surcharge loads temporary loading conditions.
Durability
5.4
The structure should be designed tobe sufficiently durable against sitehazards, including:
chemicals
cyclical wet-dry conditions.
frost action
Movement
Movement within the structure should be limited to the capacity of the waterproofing systems resistance to such movement,
ensuring that the designed level of watertightness is achieved. Detailed guidance for the limitation of movement should be provided
where appropriate.
Movement joints in below ground waterproofed structures should be avoided. Where it is necessary to provide movement joints,
the design should ensure satisfactory in-service performance, including watertightness. Such joints should be accessible for
maintenance, and not permanently concealed by other structural elements of the building.
Design co-ordination
Structural design should be co-ordinatedwith the design of the waterproofing.
Where there is doubt about potential use,minimum Grade 3 protection should be considered in the waterproofing design.
Penetrations through the waterproofing should be avoided where possible. Where penetrations cannot be avoided,
the design should detail the method of waterproofing to ensure that it is watertight and durable.
Penetrations, including those for wall ties, services and drainage systems, should:
be suitably separated to allow for proprietary seals to be
account for differential settlement and movement between
correctly installed the structure/finishes and services.
5.4
liquid-applied membranes
cementitious systems
The manufacturers recommendations for climatic conditions at the time of installation should be followed.
The concrete mix should be agreed betweenthe engineer and the waterproofing design specialist, and:
achieve the necessary robustness,
be suitable for the environmental exposure and
durability and waterproofing ground conditions.
Type B waterproofing shouldbe installed:
5.4
Joints between components, includingday work joints, should be durable and made watertight with appropriate waterstops or
hydrophilic strips. Kickers, generally cast as part of the slab, should be used to form the joint between floorsand walls.
Concrete with admixtures
Where the design of in-situ concretewaterproofing includes admixtures:
the ratio of admixture to concretespecified in the design
suitable quality management systems and quality
should take account of the recommendations of the audits should be used to record and monitor the
admixture supplier batching of admixture.
the reinforcement should limit crack widths to 0.3mm for
flexural cracks and 0.2mm for cracks that pass through
the section
5.4
manufacturer or supplier
who are fully aware of the design and the manufacturers
Ancillary components
Ancillary components should be assessed as part of the waterproofing system. Alternatively, an assessment of compatibility and
satisfactory performance should be provided for materials and products that are interchangeable between different systems.
Ancillary components include:
preformed junctions and corners
waterstops
reinforcement
hydrophilic strips.
6.1.1 Compliance 01
6.1.2 Provision of information 01
6.1.3 Structural design 01
6.1.4 Fire resistance 03
6.1.5 Acoustic resistance 03
6.1.6 Exposure 03
6.1.7 Thermal insulation 06
6.1.8 Concrete blocks 09
6.1.9 Bricks 09
6.1.10 Stone masonry 10
6.1.11 Construction of masonry walls 11
6.1.12 Lintels 14
6.1.13 Materials suitable for mortar 15
6.1.14 Mortar 15
6.1.15 Render 17
6.1.16 Cladding 17
6.1.17 DPCs and cavity trays 18
6.1.18 Wall ties 22
6.1.19 Handling materials 23
6.1.20 Cold weather working 23
Lateral restraint
Lateral restraint provided by concrete floors:
Concrete floors, with a minimum bearing of 90mm onto the wall, can provide adequate restraint. Concrete floors running parallel to,
and not built into, walls require restraint straps to provide restraint to the wall.
Lateral restraint provided by timber floors:
Timber joisted floors can provide adequate restraint when joists are carried by ordinary hangers to BS EN 845, and connected to the
wall with restraint straps. In buildings up to two storeys, timber joisted floors can provide adequaterestraint without strapping when:
the minimum bearing onto masonry is 90mm
joists are carried by BS EN 845-1 restraint-type hangers
(or 75mm onto a timber wallplate), or with performance equivalent to arestraint strap spaced at a
maximum of 2m centres.
Point loads
Where padstones and spreaders are required, they should be located beneath areas of concentratedloads.
Bonding
Where partition walls abut an external wall constructed of similar materials, fully bonded or tied joints are acceptable. To reduce the
risk of cracking, a tied joint is preferable where:
materials have dissimilar shrinkage or expansion
there is a connection between a load-bearing wall on
characteristics, e.g. dense concrete and aerated concrete foundations and a non load-bearing wall supported on a
ground-bearing slab.
Tied joints should be formed usingexpanded metal, wire wall ties or aproprietary equivalent, spaced at maximum 300mm intervals.
Movement joints
Movement joints should be included in long lengths of walling to reduce unsightly cracking, and detailed so that stability
is maintained. Where possible, joints should be hidden in corners, or behind rainwater pipes, and:
run the full heightof the superstructure masonry wall
continue from those provided in the substructure to the
superstructure (movement joints may be needed in the
superstructure and not in the substructure, providing suitable
allowance is made for relative movement).
Vertical movement joints should be provided in the outer leaf, in accordance with Table 1.
Table 1: Suitable dimensions for movement joints
Material Joint width (mm) Normal spacing (m)
Clay brick 16 12 (15 maximum)
Calcium silicate brick 10 7.5 9
Lightweight concrete block and brick 10 6
(autoclaved or using lightweight aggregates)(2)
Dense concrete block and brick (using dense aggregate)(2) 10 7.5 9
Any masonry in a parapet wall 10 Half the above spacings and 1.5 from corners
(double frequency)
Notes
1 Manufacturers guidance for the provision of movement joints and bed joint reinforcement should be considered.
2 Lightweight concrete masonry units are generally made of aggregates that have a gross density not exceeding 1,500 kg/m. Dense concrete masonry units are
6.1
generally made of aggregate that have a gross density exceeding 1,500 kg/m.
The spacing of the first movement joint from a return should not easily compressible filler
wall over 6m
bed joint reinforcement as an alternative to movement joints
Wall ties should be provided on either side of movement joints, in accordance with Clause 6.1.18.
Where masonry walls form panels in a framed structure, movement joints should be provided in accordance with BS EN 1996-2.
Movement joints should be formed using the correct materials, and account taken of:
joint width and depth
surface preparation and backing materials
anticipated movement and capability of the material
likely design life of the joint.
Clay bricks expand and require movement joints formed from easily compressiblematerials, such as:
flexible cellular polyethylene
foam rubber.
cellular polyurethane
The following materials are acceptable for use in contraction joints in concrete brickwork:
Hemp.
Cork.
Fibreboard.
Where movement joints are provided tocontrol shrinkage in concrete blockwork, they may be made as simple vertical joints filled
with mortar, and sealed.
Sealant should be a minimum of 10mm deepto ensure a good bond. Where the joint is in a freestanding wall, the filler will require
sealant at:
both exposed edges
the top, where the joint is carried through anycoping.
Durability
Masonry can become saturated, and may remain so for long periods. Therefore, precautions should be taken to resist frost damage
and sulfate attack affecting:
6.1
Rain penetration
In prolonged periods of driving rain, water will penetrate the outer leaf ofa masonry wall. The following should be taken into account:
Site-specific exposure to wind-driven rain.
Design detailing for the local exposure, and the likely quality
Suitability of the wall construction andinsulation method.
of workmanship on site.
Exposed parts of the building should be given particular attention whenselecting a suitable construction method, as this may affect
the choice for the whole building.
Complete resistance can onlybe achieved with an impervious cladding. However, the following approaches can reduce the risk of
rain penetration:
Providing cladding to the wall.
Designing protective features to keep the wall dry,
Increasing the clear cavity width (minimum 50mm) or the
e.g. projecting sills and deep overhanging eaves and verges.
width of full-fill cavity insulation (increasing the cavity width Ensuring mortar joints are fully filled. Where full cavity
for full-fill cavity insulation greatly reduces the risk of rain insulation is proposed, recessed joints should not beused.
passing through the cavity). Following the recommendations of any assessment of the
Rendering the wall and specifying crack-resistant
insulation and the manufacturers recommendations.
backing material. Ensuring that cavities arenot bridged.
Variations to the exposure shown on the map can only be made Inverness
6.1
Adapted from BRE report Thermal Insulation: avoiding risks. Dundee
Perth
Stirling
Dunbar
Glasgow Edinburgh
Exposure zones Exposure to wind-driven rain (litres/m per spell) Variations to the exposure shown on Ayr
the map can only be made by site-specific
Very severe 100 or more calculations using BS 8104 Assessing
Londonderry
exposure of walls to wind driven rain
Severe 56.5 to less than 100 and the table above. Newcastle
Carlisle
Moderate 33 to less than 56.5 Adapted from the mapBelfast
Enniskillen in the Stranraer Alston
BRE report Dungannon
Thermal Insulation: Workington Middlesborough
Sheltered Less than 33 avoiding risks Darlington Whitby
Ripon
York
Hebden Bridge
Hull
Skelmersdale
Colwyn Bay Doncaster
Manchester Grimsby
Bangor Sheffield
Chester Macclesfield Lincoln
Skegness
Bala Nottingham
Stafford
Shrewsbury Leicester
Norwich
Llanidloes Birmingham Peterborough
Llandrindod Wells Northampton
Hay-on-Wye Cambridge
Brecon Colchester
Gloucester Luton
Swansea Swindon Welwyn Garden City
Bristol Newbury London
Cardiff Weston-super-Mare Staines
Watchet Aldershot
Barnstable Taunton Gatwick Dover
Southampton
Exeter Brighton
Poole
Eastbourne
Sidmouth
Frost attack
Common factors which increase the level of frost attack include:
degree of exposure (incidence of frost)
localised protection of the masonryby roof overhangs,
saturation of the masonry
trees and otherbuildings.
frost resistance of the masonry
Good brickwork detailing can limitpersistent wetting and reducethe risk of frost attack, for example:
Paths should drain away from walls toavoid saturating bricks
A coping or capping should be provided forall parapet walls,
near the ground. chimneys andfreestanding walls unless clay bricks ofF2,S1
Sills, copings and similar features should have aweathered
or F2,S2 classification to BS EN771 are used.
upper surface.
Copings shouldhave:
a generous overhang
acontinuous supported DPCwhich projects beyond the line
throatings a minimum of 40mm clear of the wall
of thewall.
NE
or other detrimental effects. They should not be applied to S1 CA
DH SR
designation bricks without written agreement from the
brick manufacturer. DL TS
LA
HG YO
BD
In Scotland, all clay bricks used as facingsshould be FY PR
HX
BB
LS
HU
BL OL WF
frost-resistant, F2,S2 or F2,S1 to BS EN 771. L WN M
HD
DN
WA S
SK
This applies particularly to bricks such as fletton facings which CH
CW LN
LL
are moderately freeze-/thaw-resistant (F1,S2 or F1,S1). ST DE
NG
are acceptable:
Clay facing bricks which are frost-resistant F2,S2 or
Concrete bricks with a minimum strength of 20N/mm2.
F2,S1 to BS EN 771. Concrete blocks with a minimum density of 1,500kg/m3 or
Clay bricks which are classifiedin the manufacturers
more than 7.3N/mm2 strength classification.
published recommendations as satisfactory for theexposure. Most types of aerated concrete blocks with render.
Calcium silicate bricks of at least compressive strength Class
30 and declared as freeze/thaw resistant to BS EN 771.
6.1
OL 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
PA 23 24 25 26 27 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 40 41
PH 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
PH 22 23 25 26 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41
S 6 10 11 30
SA 9 10 11 13 19 20 32 33 39 40 44 48
SK 6 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
ST 10 13
SY 10 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
TD 1 2 5 8 11 71
TS 9
YO 6 18 21 22
Notes
1 Reproduced by permission of the London Brick Company Ltd.
2 Shaded boxes indicate areas which are wholly within areas of severe frost exposure. Other areas are partly within.
The insulation value of the wall must meetthe requirements of the relevant Building Regulations. Cold bridging should be avoided.
Particular care is needed:
at openings
between external walls and roofs, internal walls and floors.
Installation
Workmanship should be maintained to minimise the risk of damp penetration to the inside of the home. Gaps provide routes for
dampness, and condensation can form on the cold spots where insulation is missing. Insulation should be:
close butted with no gaps
installed in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
reveal
blocks
All retro-fill insulation materials, including UFfoam, blown mineral fibre and expandedpolystyrene beads should be:
installed by a member of asurveillance scheme
installed by operatives trained by the assessment holder,
acceptable to NHBC and approved by the assessmentholder and the
assessing organisation.
6.1
Insulation materials
Insulation should be:
UF foam to BS 5617 and installed in accordance
assessed in accordance with Technical Requirement R3.
with BS 5618, or
Construction type
The following are recommendations and guidance according to construction type:
Partial cavity insulation
Where partial cavity insulation is installed:
it should only be fixed against the cavity face of the innerleaf
wall ties long enough to allow a 50mm embedment in each
a 50mm clear cavity between the partialcavity insulation and
masonry leaf should be used.
the outer leaf should be maintained
In areas of very severe exposure in England and Wales, aresidual cavity of 75mm is required wherethe outer leaf is
fairfaced masonry.
Full cavity insulation
Where the cavity is to be fully filled with insulation:
the type of insulation, its thickness and the wall construction
mortar joints should not be recessed
should be suitable forthe exposure of the home. painted finishes on bricks or render are not acceptable
(see Table 2) where they are likely to cause damage (including frost
render on an external leaf of clay bricks (F2,S1 or F1,S1
damage or sulfate attack).
designation bricks to BS EN 771) is not permitted In areas of
severe or very severe exposure to wind-driven rain
Table 2: Suitable wall constructions for use with full-fill cavity insulation
Exposure Suitable wall construction Minimum insulation thickness (mm)
category Built-in insulation Retro-fill (other than UF foam) UF foam
Very severe Any wall with impervious cladding 50 50 50
Fairfaced masonry with impervious cladding 100 100 N/A
to all walls above ground storey
Any wall fully rendered(2) 75 75 N/A
Fairfaced masonry(1) N/A N/A N/A
Severe Any wall with impervious cladding or render (2)
50 50 50
Fairfaced masonry with impervious cladding 50 75 50
or render(2) to all walls above ground storey
Fairfaced masonry 75 75 N/A
Moderate Any wall with impervious cladding or render 50 50 50
Fairfaced masonry with impervious cladding 50 50 50
or render to all walls above ground storey
Fairfaced masonry 50 75 75
Sheltered Any wall with impervious cladding or render 50 50 50
Fairfaced masonry with impervious cladding 50 50 50
or render to all walls above ground storey
Fairfaced masonry 50 50 50
Notes
1 In very severe exposure locations, fairfaced masonry with full cavity insulation is not permitted.
2 Render on an external leaf of clay bricks (F2,S1 or F1,S1 designation bricks to BS EN 771) in severe or very severe exposures is not permitted where the cavity is to
be fully filled with insulation.
3 This table covers walls where the external leaf does not exceed 12m in height.
4 The exposure category of the home is determined by its location on the map showing categories of exposure to wind-driven rain.
5 Fairfaced masonry includes clay, calcium silicate and concrete bricks and blocks and dressed natural stone laid in an appropriate mortar preferably with struck,
weathered or bucket handle joints. Cavity walls of random rubble or random natural stone should not be fully filled.
6 Recessed mortar joints should not be used.
7 In Scotland, it is not permissible to fill the full width of the cavity with any thermal insulation at the time of construction.
6.1
8 In Northern Ireland and the Isle of Man, it is not permissible to fill the cavity with pumped thermal insulants (for example, UF foam) at the time of construction.
The thickness of materials should be asrequired in the design, and in accordance with Building Regulations.
Guidance for retro-filling cavities:
Northern Ireland and the Isle of Man Not permitted to fill cavities withpumped thermal insulants at the time ofconstruction.
Scotland Not permitted to fill the cavity fully with any thermalinsulants at the time of construction.
England and Wales In accordance with the guidance in this chapter.
Dual insulation
Where partial cavity insulation is used in addition to an insulated block innerleaf, the composite construction should be assessed in
accordancewith Technical Requirement R3.
Intended loads
Blocks should:
comply with BS EN 771 and be used in accordance
be used in accordance with the
with BS EN 1996-2 manufacturers recommendations.
not be used where they do not support the required
load-bearing capacity of the wall
The maximum load-bearing capacity of the wall should not exceed the manufacturers recommendations. Other factors may dictate
the strength ofblocks required in certain circumstances, e.g. sulfate resistance may require blocks of greater strength.
For one and two storey homes, blocks with a minimum compressive strength of 2.9N/mm2 should be adequate.
For three storey homes or those with storey heights over 2.7m, 7.3N/mm2 blocks are required for certain parts of thestructure,
unless structural design shows that strengths lower than 7.3N/mm2 are adequate.
Thermal resistance
6.1
Concrete blocks may have been specified according to thermal performance and strength. Alternative concrete blocks should not
beused without the designers acceptance.
Bricks 6.1.9
Bricks shall be capable of supporting intendedloads and have appropriate resistance to the adverse effects of
freeze/thaw and sulfate attack.
The design strength of bricks should comply with:
BS EN 1996-1
the design.
Table 3: Classification of clay bricks according to their freeze/thaw resistance and active soluble salt content in accordance
with BS EN 771-1
Durability Freeze/thaw resistance Active soluble salt content
F2,S2 Freeze-/thaw-resistant (F2), durable inall building situations (S2) low
F2,S1 Freeze-/thaw-resistant (F2), durable inall building situations (S1) normal
F1,S2 Moderately freeze-/thaw-resistant(F1), durable except when saturatedand (S2) low
subject to repeated freezing andthawing
F1,S1 Moderately freeze-/thaw-resistant(F1), durable except when saturatedand (S1)normal
subject to repeated freezing andthawing
F0,S2 Not freeze-/thaw-resistant (F0),liable to be damaged by freezing andthawing (S2) low
F0,S1 Not freeze-/thaw-resistant (F0),liable to be damaged by freezing andthawing (S1) normal
Calcium silicate and concrete bricks contain no significant active soluble salts. Information on their durability is given in this chapter.
Clay bricks
Bricks that are freeze-/thaw-resistant(F2,S2 or F2,S1 to BS EN 771) shouldbe used where there is a high risk ofprolonged wetting
and freezing including:
external facing work in Scotland
areas of the country subject to exceptionally severe freeze/
exposed parts, including copings, sills, parapets and
thaw exposure. See Clause 6.1.6.
chimneys which haveno overhang to provide protection.
In areas of severe freeze/thaw exposure outside Scotland, bricks that are moderately freeze-/thaw-resistant (F1,S1 or F1,S2 to
BS EN 771) may be used for general wall areas, provided they are classified in the manufacturers published recommendations as
satisfactory for the exposure.
Bricks that are not freeze-/thaw-resistant (F0,S2 or F0,S1 to BS EN 771) are not acceptable for use externally, unless completely
protected by a cladding which can satisfactorily resist the passage of water.
Where brickwork may become saturated, moderately freeze-/thaw-resistant bricks (F1,S1 or F1,S2 to BS EN 771) are not
appropriate where there is a risk of vulnerability to frost. In saturated conditions, sulfate-resisting cement mortar is required for
S1 designation bricks.
For one and two storey homes, clay bricks to BS EN 771, with a minimum compressive strength of 9N/mm2 should be adequate.
For three storey homes; clay bricks to BS EN 771 with a minimum compressive strength of 13N/mm2 are acceptable.
Concrete bricks
Concrete bricks have a direct relationship between strength and durability, including freeze/thaw resistance. Most concrete bricks
have a strength of 20N/mm2 and are durable in most situations. For copings and sills, bricks with a compressive strength of
36N/mm2 should be used.
Calcium silicate bricks
Calcium silicate bricks do not contain significant amounts of soluble sulfates and may be suitable where sulfate-bearing soil
and ground water conditions exist. Where calcium silicate bricks are used, it should be in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
Bricks of compressive strength Class 20 (BS EN 771-2) are suitable for most applications.
Bricks of strength Class 30 and declared as freeze-/thaw-resistant toBS EN 771-2 are recommended in the following areas:
6.1
severe freeze/thaw exposure where bricks may be persistently wet, e.g. parapets,
chimneys, sills and below the DPC.
Reclaimed bricks
Reclaimed bricks:
should be used in accordance with
may be unsuitable for external work because of a high salt
Technical Requirement R3 content or a lack of freeze/thaw resistance
should be considered as F1,S1 or F1,S2 to BS EN 771 and
which have previously been used internally or which were
used accordingly fully protected may be unsuitable in external situations.
may require independent certification ofsuitability
It is advisable to know where reclaimed bricks came from, and if they were used internally or externally.
Special shaped bricks
Special shaped bricks should conform to BS 4729.
Construction of masonry walls 6.1.11 Also see: Chapter 7.1, 9.1 and PD 6697:2010
Construction shall ensure a satisfactory standard of brickwork and blockwork. Issues to be taken into
account include:
a) finished appearance e) corbelling
b) bonding f) chasing for services
c) construction g) protection of ancillary components.
d) openings
Finished appearance
The appearance of a masonry wall dependsupon the:
materials used
setting out
workmanship.
When setting out masonry, avoid:
cutting bricks or blocks, except when it is essential
irregular or broken bonds,particularly at openings.
All work should be reasonably level andtrue, and:
the bond detailed in the design used
perpendicular joints kept in line and plumb
courses kept level by using lines andspirit levels.
To keep courses to the correct height, use a gauge rod marked with the height of windows, doors and floors.
6.1
Where a number of openings of similar width are being formed, use a rod cut tothe required size to check the width of openings as
the work rises.
Brickwork and blockwork should not be subjected to vibration until the mortar hasset.
Bonding
A regular bonding pattern should bemaintained. External walls should bebonded to partitions and party walls asrequired by
the design. Either:
tooth every alternate course, or
tie with wall ties, expanded metal orequivalent at maximum
300mm vertical centres.
1/2
3/4 3/4
1/2
3/4 3/4
Where joist hangers are not used, joistfilling should be brickwork or blockwork and without excessive mortar joints.
Joist filling should be:
12mm below the top of flat roof joists to allow for timber
checked to ensure the cold roofventilation is not blocked.
shrinkage, and
Clay bricks and concrete blocks should not be mixed. Where a different size of masonry unit is needed to ensure correct coursing,
smallunits of the same material should be used to reduce cracking and problems due to different thermal insulation properties.
Where the inner leaf of a cavity wall isbeing used for thermal insulation, and where a different size of masonry unit is used to ensure
correct coursing, the unit should have similar thermal insulation properties to the masonry used for the rest of the wall.
different masonry types
used to adjust coursing
12mm max.
Construction
The difference in heights between the two leaves of a cavity wall under construction can be up to six block courses, provided the
ties are sufficiently flexible to ensure coursing is achieved without breaking the bond. To keep the wall plumb, do not over-reach at
changes of lift; wait for the next scaffolding lift.
Cavities should be constructed so that:
they are uniform and in accordance with the design,
where cavity insulation is used, mortar droppings are
including wall tie specification and cavity width removed from the top edge
mortar is struck from all joints aswork proceeds
where partial cavity insulation is used, it is against the inner
cavity trays and wall ties are clear of droppings anddebris
leaf of the cavity.
mortar droppings are removed
board used to
keep cavity clean
6.1
Openings
Masonry may be built around either:
the frame in-situ, or
thejamb.
Corbelling
Where reinforcing is used, corbels shouldbe designed by an T
Components in contact with, or embedded in, an innerleaf which is damp or exposed to periodic wetting (e.g. below the DPC)
should be protected in the same way as components in contact with, or embedded in, an outer leaf.
Lintels 6.1.12 Also see: Chapter 6.5 and BRE Report Thermal insulation: avoiding risks
Lintels, and supporting beams, shall be installed correctly, safely support the applied loads and be of the type
and dimensions appropriate to their position within the structure. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) thermal insulation and condensation c) placing lintels.
b) durability and resistance to water entering the home
6.1
Over 1.2 150 150
Separate cavity tray protection should beprovided when corrosion protection to the lintel isinadequate, or the shape of the lintel
is unsuitable, such as when:
the profile of the lintel does not form a cavity tray
steel lintels in external walls have material/coating in
accordance with L11, L14 and L16.1, see Table 4.
In Scotland, Northern Ireland, the Isle ofMan and areas of severe or very severe exposure to driving rain, a separate cavity tray
should be provided overall lintels.
Lintels should be:
austeniticstainless steel where used in aggressive located and sized so that the external edge of thelintel
environments, e.g. coastal sites projects beyond, and therefore offersprotection to,
the window head.
Placing lintels
The design should be checked and lintels should:
be an appropriate size for the opening and the end bearings
(at each end) lintel
have padstones where required, e.g. for long spans
be installed level on asolid bed of mortar (not soft or
full block for
lintel bearing
non-durable packing)
correct bonding
be set out to ensure that lintelsbear on a full block
below supporting
block
not have brickwork or masonry which overhangs more
than 25mm.
Concrete floor units or other heavy components which bear on lintels should be positioned carefully to avoid damage or shock load.
Unless recommended otherwise by the brick manufacturer, the mixes in Table 6 should be used for clay bricks.In the case of
concrete or calcium silicate bricks, particular attention should be paid to the manufacturers recommendations.
Table 6: Mortar mixes using ordinary Portland or sulfate-resisting cements
Location Recommended Recommended Recommended Mortar
cement:lime: cement:sand mix masonry designation
sand mix with air entraining cement: to
plasticiser sand mix BS EN 1996-1-1
General wall area In areas of severe or very 1::4 1:3 1:3 (ii)
above the DPC severe exposure high durability
Other exposure categories 1:1:5 1:5 1:4 (iii)
general use
Air-entraining plasticiser can be incorporated in the following general use and high durabilitymortars:
1:1:5, cement:lime:sand, or
1:1:4, cement:lime:sand.
Retarded mortar
Retarded mortar and most premixed mortars can be used over a longer period of time than site-mixed, cement:lime:sand mortars.
When using retarded mortar:
follow manufacturers recommendations and timescales temporary bracing of larger walls, e.g. at gable peaks and
do not use it beyond the time for which it is effective long walls, may be necessary due to delayed setting times.
protect it against freezing prior to use
Sources of sulfate
Mortar is vulnerable to deterioration by sulfates, especially when masonry is saturated for long periods of time. Clay bricks contain
soluble sulfate (S1 designations have no limit on their sulfate content) and so a suitable mortar should be used.
To reduce risk, sulfate-resistingPortland cement to BS 4027 should beused:
below the DPC level when sulfates arepresent in the ground
when there is a highsaturation risk (examples below).
when clay bricks (F2,S1 and F1,S1 to BSEN 771) are used
6.1
retaining walls
Mortars containing an air-entrainingplasticiser are more resistant to freeze and thaw damage when set, but do not prevent freezing
before the mortar is cured.
White cement to BS EN 197 and pigments to BS EN 12878 may be used, but pigmentsshould not exceed 10% of the
cement weight, or 3% where carbon black is used.
Preparing mortar
When preparing mortar:
ensure the mix is appropriate for the use and location
Joints
Jointing is preferable to pointing because it leaves the mortar undisturbed. Struck (or weathered) and bucket handlejoints are
preferable for external walls. Unless the design states otherwise, only bucket handle or weathered joints should be used.
Recessed joints should not be used where:
bricks are not frost-resistant, e.g. clay F1,S1 or F1,S2 to
bricks are perforated closer than 15mm to the face
BS EN 771, unless the brick manufacturer has confirmed there is no reasonable shelter from driving rain, e.g.
their use for that particular location in writing from buildings or groups of trees within 50m and of
the home is built on steep sloping ground, facing open
similar height to the home
countryside or within 8km of a coast or large estuary the cavity is to be fully filled with cavityinsulation.
underside of each horizontal support member. The inner leaf should be adequately tied to the
The masonry outer leaf should have a minimum two-thirds
structural frame.
of its width supported securely by the concrete frame or a
metal angle.
Joints
Joints between claddings and adjacent materials should:
be detailed to be watertight under the particular exposure have provision for differential movement, where necessary.
conditions of the site
Moisture barriers
Moisture barriersshould be:
provided between walls of solidmasonry and any boarding,
roofing underfelt orequivalent.
slating, tilingor other similar claddings (unless specifically
not required for aproprietary cladding)
Vapour control layers, such as polyethylenesheet, are not an acceptable moisturebarrier.
Timber cladding should be in accordance with Chapter 3.3 Timber preservation (natural solid timber).
6.1
a) provision of DPCs and cavity trays c) parapet details.
b) stepped cavity trays
Table 9: Positions where DPCs and cavity trays are generally required
Location Provision of DPCs and cavity trays
Base of walls, piers,etc. A DPC should be provided a minimum 150mm above adjoining surfaces and linked with the
DPM in solid floors.
Base of partitions built off oversite The DPC should be the full width of the partition.
where there is no integral DPM
Base of wall built off beam, slab, etc. Detail to prevent entry of damp by driving rain.
Parapets Beneath coping, and 150mm above adjoining roof surface to link with the roof upstand.
In cavity walls overopenings, A cavity tray should be provided to direct any water that entersthe cavity to the outside.
air bricks, etc. The cavity tray should fully protect the opening.
At the horizontal abutment of all A cavity tray should be provided 150mm above any adjoining roof or balcony surface.
roofs over enclosed areas and The tray should be lapped over any roof upstand or flashing to ensurewater penetrating into
balconies to walls the cavity does not enter the enclosed area.
At sloping abutments of all roofs Preformed stepped cavity trays should be provided above the roof surface and linked to the
over enclosed areas to cavity walls roof upstand or flashing to ensure any water penetrating into the cavity does not enter the
enclosed area.
Doorsteps A DPC should be provided behind a doorstep where it is higher than a wall DPC.
Table 9 (continued): Positions where DPCs and cavity trays are generally required
Location Provision of DPCs and cavity trays
Sills Where precast concrete or similar sills incorporate joints or are of a permeable material,
a DPC should be provided beneath them for the full length and be turned up at the back and
the end of the sill.
Jambs in cavity The reveal should be protected throughout its width by a continuous DPC. The width of the
DPC should be sufficient to be fixed to, or overlap, the frame and fully protect the reveal.
For severe and very severe exposure conditions, rebated reveal construction or a
proprietary closer, suitable for the conditions, should be used.
DPC level
150mm
min.
ground
level
DPC turned up at
back and ends of sills
level of
wall DPC
DPM behind
doorstep links
with DPC
doorstep
6.1
Cavity trays
Cavity trays should be provided at all interruptions to the cavity (e.g. window and door openings and air bricks) unless otherwise
protected (e.g. by overhanging eaves). Cavity trays should:
provide an impervious barrier and ensure that water
be shaped to provide 100mm minimum vertical protection
drains outwards above points where mortar droppings could collect
project at least 25mm beyond the outer face of the cavity
be provided where the cavity is bridged by air bricks,
closer or, where a combined cavity tray and lintel is etc. and the DPC should extend 150mm beyond each
acceptable, give complete protection to the top of the reveal side of the bridge
and vertical DPC where not otherwise protected (e.g. by a roof at an
provide drip protection to door and window heads
appropriate level), be provided over meter boxes
have a 140mm minimum upstand from the inside face of the
be in one continuous piece or have sealed or welded joints.
outer leaf to the outside of the inner leaf
3D 25mm
min.
stop end
100mm
140mm min.
min.
at least two weep holes
per opening, not combined
more than 450mm lintel or
combined lintel projects cavity tray
groove in window at least 25mm beyond the
head prevents outer face of cavity closure
DPC oversails lintel to rain penetration
protect timber door and
window head
The upstand part of the cavity tray should be returned into the inner leaf unless it is stiff enough to stand against the inner leaf
without support. In Scotland, Northern Ireland, the Isle of Man and areas of very severe exposure to driving rain, the upstand part of
the damp proof protection should be returned into the inner leaf of masonry (this does not apply at sloping abutments).
Where fairfaced masonry is supported bylintels:
weep holes should be provided at a maximum of
eachopening should have at least two weepholes
450mm intervals cavity trays or combined lintels shouldhave stop ends.
Where the lintel does not require a DPC, it should:
have a suitableprofile and durability
give complete protection to the top of the reveal and vertical
DPC, where provided.
Where the cavity has full-fill insulation, a cavity tray should be used above the highest insulation level, unless theinsulation is taken
to the top of the wall and is in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
Horizontal DPCs
DPCs should:
be the correct width
at ground level, generally be a minimum of 150mm above
lap the DPM where appropriate
finished groundor paving level
be laid on a surface free from projections which could
where intended to prevent rising damp, jointsshould have
puncture or adversely affect the DPC material 100mm lapping, or be sealed or welded
be fully bedded on mortar whererequired by the design,
be used in accordance with the
or where the building is over three storeys in height manufacturers recommendations.
The concrete fill in a cavity wall should stop at least 225mm below the base DPC. This may be reduced to 150mm where special
foundations, such as rafts, are used.
6.1
225mm
minimum 150mm min.
150mm min.
25mm 25mm
Stage 1 Stage 2 Stage 1 Stage 2
Parapet details
Parapet walls should have:
6.1
throating clear
a DPC under the coping, anda DPC tray starting 150mm
DPC supported of brickwork
over cavity tray
minimumabove the roof
coping throating which is clear of thebrickwork.
3D
DPCs in parapet walls should be:
supported over the cavity to preventsagging below copings
min.
open perpend 150 mm
fully bedded in mortar
weep holes.
1m max.
specified toachieve a good key with the mortar
spacing
sealed to prevent water seeping through the joints.
Position
Table 10: Spacing of wall ties
Maximum horizontal spacing (mm) Maximum vertical spacing (mm)
General wall area 900 450
Jamb openings, movement joints, etc. Within 225 of opening Not more than 300(1)
Top of gable walls 225 (parallel to the top of the wall) Not more than 300
Notes
1 The cavity insulation may need cutting to insert the tie.
Water should be prevented from crossing the cavity. Care should be taken to avoid:
ties sloping down to the inner leaf
ties having mortardroppings on them.
drips being off-centre
Cavity walls should be coursed so thatthe wall tie is level or slopes outwards.
additional ties
6.1
at movement joints
50mm 50mm
225mm min. min.
900mm
they can have a minimum 50mm bed into the unbuilt leaf
6.2.1 Compliance 01
6.2.2 Provision of information 01
6.2.3 Design and certification 01
6.2.4 Load-bearing walls 01
6.2.5 Fixing the frame 04
6.2.6 Nails and staples 04
6.2.7 Sheathing 04
6.2.8 Differential movement 05
6.2.9 Fire resistance 09
6.2.10 Protection from moisture 09
6.2.11 Timber preservation 11
6.2.12 Vapour control layers 11
6.2.13 Breather membranes 11
6.2.14 Wall ties and fixings 12
6.2.15 Insulation 12
The fixing schedule should detail every connection which is to be made on site, including those for structural connections,
framing, wall ties, breathermembranes, sheathing and vapour controllayers, and should show as appropriate:
number and spacing of fixings
method of fixing, e.g. skew nailing.
size and type of fixing, including material and
corrosion protection
Where wall design relies onplasterboard to take racking forces, the design should:
clearly define those walls
include thetype and spacing of fixings required.
Homes with a timber frame superstructure require certification confirming that the design has been checked by an NHBC approved
timber frame certifier. In addition, the design should be submitted to NHBC when proposed buildings are four storeys or more and
the floor joists are solid timber.
The timber frame certifier should:
be listed on NHBCs list of timber frame certifiers
complete and sign a certificateconfirming assessment of
be a suitably qualified civilor structural engineer
structural adequacy for each specific project
with a minimum of three years experience in timber provide the registered builder with the completed and
frameconstruction signed certificate.
not be the designer of the timber frame
The registered builder should ensure thatthe completed timber frame certificate isavailable on site for inspection by NHBC.
Contact NHBCStandards and Technical department:
if you require contact details of frame certifiers, or
to apply to become a timber framecertifier.
Timber elements
Load-bearing timberframed walls should be in accordance withBS EN 1995-1-1, and take into account:
wind loads
floor loads.
roof loads
load-bearing lintel
Sheathing and associated fixings should be structurally supported by
cripple studs
adequate, and resist racking due to wind and other forces.
Where masonry cladding is used, additional studs may be
required at openings to fix wall ties.
Multiple studs should be included tosupport multiple joists and
other point loads, unless otherwise specified by the designer.
Where head binders are not provided, joists and roof trusses,
including girder trusses and other similar loads, should bear
directly over studs.
6.2
At joints between wall panels, sole plates and head binders should be provided tobind panels together. Joints in sole platesand
head binders should:
occur over a stud not coincide with joints between panels.
12mm 12mm
The upper sole plate should then be fixed on top andlevelled temporary
spacer
with temporary spacers inserted between the sole plates.
When the first lift construction has been erected, permanent permanent packing
under each stud
packing should be inserted under each load point, e.g. stud sole plate
or post. As this method uses anadditional sole plate, the extra
shrinkage should be taken into account.
Fixing panels
The wall panels should be adequately fixedto the sole plate so that the frame can resistboth lateral and vertical forces.
When fixing panels:
fixings, including nailed joints and sheathing, should be as sole plates and head binders should beprovided to bind the
scheduled in the design panels together.
they should be securely fixed together, to the floor and to the
roof framing
Shotfiring
Where shotfiring:
into masonry, solid concreteblocks should be specified as
the blocks in beam and block floors should be grouted
BS EN 771 with a minimum crushing strengthof 7.3N/mm2 care should be taken notto spall edges of masonry or slabs.
and positioned toreceive fixings
Anchoring
When anchoring the frame:
the sole plate should be adequately anchored to the
careshould be taken to avoid splitting timberplates or
substructure so that the frame can resistboth lateral and damaging the substructure.
vertical forces
DPC
Fixing to plate
Fixing to stud
Holding-down devices should be durable, asdetailed in the design and manufactured from:
6.2
austenitic stainless steel to BS EN10088-1,
galvanised mild steel with zinc coatingto BS EN ISO 1461,
minimum grade 1.4301 minimum coating 940g/m2 on each side.
Sole plate anchors within the internalenvelope should be galvanised mild steel,minimum coating Z275.
Sheathing 6.2.7
Sheathing shall be durableand capable of providing structuralresistance to racking
The following materials are acceptable:
Plywood BS EN 636 and BS EN 13986 Table 7
Oriented strand board BS EN 300 type OSB/3 or 4
Moisture-resistant chipboard BS EN 312 type P5 or P7
Medium board BS EN 622-3 type MBH.HLS1 or MBH.HLS2
Impregnated soft board BS EN 622-4 type SB.HLS
Proprietary sheathing materials Technical Requirement R3 and used in accordancewith the assessment.
Also see: Institution of Gas Engineers and Managers (www.igem.org.uk) and Guidance on
Differential movement 6.2.8 detailing to accommodate differential movement in timber frame buildings (www.uktfa.com)
Timber structures shall account for differential movement between the timber frame wall and other
building elements.
As the timber frame dries out, it will shrink and the overall height will reduce. The extent of the differential movement
increases with the number of storeys, and will typically occur between the timber frame and other parts of the construction, including:
door and window openings
staircases and lift shaft enclosures
eaves and verges
(where they are not timber framed)
balconies (including Juliet balconies)
the interface of the timber frame withany other
service entries
construction at each floor level where cladding is fixed to
openings for drive-throughs
the timber frame.
Movement joints should be provided to accommodate theexpected movement. Joints should be detailed to:
accommodate the expected amount of shrinkage or
be protected by a cover strip where the movement gap/joint
expansion safely is expected tobe more than 35mm.
provide a weather resistant anddurable joint
In the absence of project-specific calculations, gaps in accordance with Table 1 should be provided.
Table 1: Gap sizes to accommodate differential movement
Gap location Opening and closing gaps (mm)
Floor joists
Solid timber (mm) Engineered I-joist (mm)
Eaves/verge Add 5mm to gap dimension at level below
Sixth storey Specialist calculations to be submitted to NHBC(2) 61
Fifth storey 53
Fourth storey 45
Third storey 45 35
Second storey 35 25
First storey 20 15
6.2
The table allows for a 2mm thickness of compressible bottom rail of panel
Common details
The following sketches consider downward movement of the
timber frame and upward brick expansion, taken as 2.5mm per
storey of clay masonry. Cavity trays are omitted for clarity. closing
gap
allow for
movement
sill not built
into masonry
allow for
movement
allow for
movement allow for
movement
6.2
Window head and sill with lightweight cladding
no differential movement
no differential movement
allow for
movement
75mm min.
timber frame
movement
Timber frame interface with concrete or masonry stairs and common areas
transition piece timber frame
movement
(transition piece
removed)
after movement
allow for
movement
allow for
movement
A
service passing B
through wall
allow for
movement A
Drive through
timber frame
movement
timber floor
construction
allow for
movement
ceiling
lintel/beam ceiling
drive
Section A-A through
Section B-B
Lightweight wall cladding joint at each floor level (with and without insulation in cavity)
15mm*
15mm*
movement across
floor zone
15mm*
15mm*
cavity
vertical batten
*10mm for
I-joist
allow for
movement
allow for
allow for movement
movement decking
balcony structure
independent of
timber frame
opening gap
gap
6.2
Balcony abutment masonry cladding
allow for
slotted holes movement
after
movement
fix to masonry
cladding subject
to engineers
design
sliding joint
breather membrane
fire stop between lapped over
batten and above DPC tray
underlay
fire stop
below underlay
DPC
cavity closed
6.2
at eaves
DPC
cavity barrier of mineral wool
or fire-resisting board in boxed eaves
Services
Only the services shown in the design should be installed in separating walls and:
service outlets should not impair the fireresistance of floors
service mains should not pass throughseparating
and walls wall cavities.
Notching or drilling of structural timbermembers should be carried out as detailedin the design. If these details are notavailable,
the designer should be consultedbefore such operations are begun.
In Scotland, services are not permittedwithin a timber framed separating wall.
Protection from moisture 6.2.10 Also see: Chapter 6.1 and 6.9
Timber structures and panels shall be adequately protectedfrom the effects of moisture. Issues to be taken in
to account include:
a) Cavity construction
b) DPCs.
Cavity construction
A drained and vented cavity should beprovided to reduce the risk of rain penetrating the frame. Cavity widths, measured between
the cladding andsheathing, should be in accordance with Table 2.
In areas of very severe exposure to wind driven rain, wall construction should include a50mm cavity between the sheathing andthe
cladding and:
a high performance breather membrane, or
masonry cladding which is rendered or clad with an
impervious material.
Cavities should be:
vented to allow some limited, but not necessarily through,
kept clean, free of obstructions and capable of
movement of air draining freely.
Where wall areas aredivided by horizontal cavity barriers,openings should be provided to eachsection:
equivalent to open brick perpends every1.2m
below the lowest timber.
located to prevent the ingress of rain, and
DPCs
6.2
DPCs and trays should be:
fitted at openings to prevent rain penetration
installed below the sole plates of ground floor walls and
internal partitions.
In Northern Ireland, Scotland and the Isle of Man, and in areas of severe or very severe exposure to driving rain, masonry should
form a rebate at thereveals of openings to avoid a straight through joint where the frame abuts the masonry.
3D
rain
sealant
DPC DPC
weepholes drain
any moisture
sealant to resist
driving rain
Cavities should:
extend below DPC to allow drainage
be suitably drained to prevent water build-up.
be kept clear and be vented to allowlimited, but not
The lowest timber should be a minimum of 75mm or 150mm above ground level, depending on the drainage arrangements.
3D 3D weep vents
DPC turned up
to lap with VCL
lowest
timber seal between
150mm min. wall and floor lowest timber
above barriers or 75mm min.
ground between skirting above ground level 225
level board and floor mm
drainage holes min.
weep holes
drainage next to This detail is only acceptable in
masonry cladding situations where the site is not subject
to a high water table or where the
cavity will not have standing water
(framing timbers should have a moisturecontent of less lapped with the DPC
than 20%) made good where damage has occured.
Joints in vapour control membranesshould:
have 100mm minimum laps
be located on studs ornoggings.
Where vapour control plasterboard is used, joints should be:
positioned on studs or noggings
cut with care to avoid displacing the vapour control material.
filled, taped and finished
When bitumen impregnated fibre building board is used and a breather membraneis not specified, the joints of the boardsshould be
closely butted and horizontal joints sealed to prevent water ingress.
When a breather membrane is not required, the bottom frame members should beprotected from water in the cavity.
150mm
100mm
membrane detailed
to protect the sole plate
staggered joints
membrane
protects lowest
timber
6.2
and 450mm vertically
against noggings
6.3.1 Compliance 01
6.3.2 Provision of information 01
6.3.3 Supporting load-bearing internal walls 01
6.3.4 Masonry walls 01
6.3.5 Load-bearing timber walls 03
6.3.6 Fire resistance 04
6.3.7 Sound insulation 05
6.3.8 Partitions: internal non load-bearing 07
6.3.9 Construction of timber partitions 07
6.3.10 Plasterboard 08
6.3.11 Construction of proprietary systems 09
6.3.12 Damp proof courses 09
6.3.13 Components 09
Masonry walls 6.3.4 Also see: Chapters 6.1, 6.4 and 9.2
6.3
Internal masonry walls shall be designed to support and transfer loads to foundations safely and without
undue movement. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) structural elements e) lateral restraint
b) mortar mix and jointing f) masonry separating walls
c) workmanship g) lintels and beams.
d) bonding and tying
Structural elements
Structural design of masonry walls should be in accordance with BS EN 1996-1-1.
Bricks and blocks should be selected in accordance with their intended use and as recommended in Table 1.
Table 1: Bricks and blocks in buildings up to three storeys high
Height of wall Unit Minimum compressive strength
One or two storey Blocks 2.9 N/mm2
Bricks 9.0 N/mm2
Lowest storey of a three storey wall, or Blocks 7.3 N/mm2
where individual storeys exceed 2.7m Bricks 13.0 N/mm2
Upper storeys of a three storey wall Blocks 2.9 N/mm2
Bricks 9.0 N/mm2
Where buildings are more than three storeys high, masonry should be designed in accordance with Technical Requirement R5 and
the block strength specified in the design.
Precast concrete blocks
Concrete blocks should comply with BS EN 771. The maximum load-bearing capacity of the wall should not exceed the
recommendations of the manufacturer.
Flue blocks should be in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
Bricks
Bricks should comply with the relevant British Standards:
Clay bricks BS EN 771-1
Calcium silicate bricks BS EN 771-2
Concrete bricks BS EN 771-3
Workmanship
Internal masonry walls and associated works should be:
constructed in lifts/stages to prevent the distortion of wall
6.3
accurately set out
Lateral restraint
Load-bearing masonry walls, including separating walls, should be provided with lateral restraint at:
each floor level
ceiling level below a roof.
Restraint straps should be provided to separating walls on each level, at a maximum of 2m centres, when the floor:
is not on, or near, the same level
does not provide adequate restraint.
Lateral restraint should be provided in accordance with Chapter 6.4 Timber and concrete upper floors.
Timber floors
Adequate restraint can be provided by timber floors where joists have a minimum 90mm bearing. Alternatively, restraint should be
provided by:
restraint straps with a minimum 30mm x 5mm
restraint type joist hangers to BS EN 845-1 with a
cross-section, or performance equivalent to restraint straps.
Concrete floors
450mm min.
Adequate restraint can be provided by concrete floors that have
a minimum 90mm bearing on to the wall. Alternatively, restraint restraint straps
at 2m centres
should be provided by: to each floor
Structural elements
Structural design of load-bearing timber walls should be in accordance with BS EN 1995-1-1.
cripple studs
lintel and cripple stud should be provided to each opening,
support
loadbearing lintels
except when the stud spacing is unaffected
multiple joists should be supported by multiple studs
per joint
where internal walls are made up from panels, structural
Timber quality
Timber should be of the appropriate grade, moisture content and size to support the imposed loads.
Structural timber should be of a suitable grade and specified according to the strength classes in BS EN 338, e.g. C16 or C24.
When graded to BS 4978:
the species should be included in accordance with
BS EN 338 can be used to determine strength class.
BS EN 1912 or the class strength specified
6.3
Timber should have a maximum moisture content of 20%.
Structural softwood for internal use should be:
dry graded to BS 4978
marked DRY or KD.
Timber for walls which are to be dry-lined should be regularised and comply with BS 8212. Finger joints should comply
with BS EN 385.
The guidance below does not apply to Scotland, and reference should be made to the Technical Handbooks.
Fire resistance
Internal walls should provide fire resistance in accordance with building regulations.
Typical construction
Internal walls of hollow or cavity construction (fire-resisting or otherwise) should have cavity barriers installed at:
the perimeter
junctions with fire-resistingfloors and walls.
Fire-resisting walls should be fire stopped or constructed to resist fire spread at:
their perimeter
openings for doors and pipes, etc.
junctions with other fire-resisting walls, floors and roofs
Services
Where services such as pipes, cables and ducting pass through fire-resisting walls, penetrations should be fire stopped.
Services should not penetrate plasterboard layers of separating walls.
Fire stopping should be:
in accordance with building regulations and the
completed neatly.
6.3
design information
Materials
Suitable fire stopping materials include:
mineral wool
intumescent mastic or preformed strip
cement mortar
proprietary sealing systems assessed in accordance with
gypsum plaster
Technical Requirement R3.
Sound-resisting construction
Masonry separating walls
In England and Wales, separating walls may be built in accordance with Robust Details Resistance to the passage of sound.
To maintain sound insulation:
the correct blocks should be used
where external cavity walls have blown or pumped
fully fill joints, mortar beds and perpends
insulation, separating walls should be constructed with
use only approved wall ties
flexible cavity stops so that insulation cannot enter the cavity
space wall ties 900mm minimum horizontally and 450mm
care should be taken when specifying dry lining, as the
minimum vertically thickness of plasterboard layers, and the methods of sealing
avoid any reduction in the thickness of masonry
and fixing, can affect the transmission of sound
ensure spaces around joists are fully filled with masonry
holes, voids and hairline cracks should be avoided or made
and pointed good, as they can significantly reduce the effectiveness of a
sound-insulating wall.
In masonry separating cavity walls and where the cavity is up to separating wall taken through
75mm, flexible wall ties should be: and tied to inner leaf
of damage
not exceed 1/6 of the thickness of thesingle leaf
where horizontal
horizontal chase
not exceed 1/3 the thickness of the single leaf
no deeper than
1/6 block thickness
where vertical
not be chased where hollow blocks are used, unless
vertical chase
specifically permitted by the manufacturer no deeper than
1/3 block thickness
be fully filled with mortar
Flanking walls
The construction of the flanking wall and the position of openings should comply with building regulations.
6.3
Rooms containing a WC
The guidance below applies in Northern Ireland, Scotland and the Isle of Man. In England and Wales, the construction should
comply with building regulations.
A minimum sound reduction of 38dB (100-3150Hz) when tested in accordance with BS EN ISO 140-4 is required between rooms
that include a WC and:
living rooms
studies
dining rooms
bedrooms, except where the WC is ensuite.
Timber studwork
Timber studwork should be used with one of the following on
each side:
two layers of 12.5mm plasterboard
one layer
of 12.5mm
one layer of 12.5mm plasterboard and 25mm mineral wool
plasterboard
on each side
between the studs and 25mm
wool quilt
one layer of 9.5mm plasterboard, 5mm skim coat and 25mm
Other forms of studwork construction may be acceptable where the sound reduction is achieved and independent evidence of
performance is available.
Where mineral wool quilt is used for acoustic insulation in partitions, it should be of a suitable thickness and density. Where two
layers of plasterboard are used, joints should be staggered and properly filled.
Blockwork partitions
Masonry partitions provide adequate sound insulation without additional treatment where:
blocks have a minimum density of 600kg/m3 and are finished
blocks are tied at every course to adjoining walls, with joints
on both sides with 13mm of plaster, and fully filled.
Proprietary partitions
Independent test evidence of the systems performance is required in accordance with Technical Requirement R3.
Fixing
Partitions should:
be firmly fixed to each other and to abutting walls;
be fixed to noggings when parallel to structural elements
noggings or extra studs should be used where necessary not be over-wedged at floor level
be fixed to the structure where possible
not be wedged against ceiling joists or roof trusses.
extra stud
6.3
nogging
supports
radiator
Noggings should be provided to support fittings, such as radiators, wall mounted boilers, sanitary fittings and kitchen units.
screed on
DPM DPC below
above slab stud partition
partition on
DPC above
polyethylene
DPM DPM below
slab
6.3
Components 6.3.13
Walls ties and related items shall be of the appropriate type and strength and shall have adequate durability.
Joist hangers, restraint straps, bond ties, etc. should be protected against corrosion. Ferrous metals with the following levels of
protection are acceptable:
Post-galvanizing to BS 729, or
Pre-galvanizing to BS 2989.
6.4.1 Compliance 01
6.4.2 Provision of information 01
6.4.3 Upper floor design 01
6.4.4 Fire spread 02
6.4.5 Sound insulation 02
6.4.6 In-situ concrete floors and concreting 03
6.4.7 Precast concrete 03
6.4.8 Timber joist spans 04
6.4.9 Timber joists 06
6.4.10 Construction of timber floors 06
6.4.11 Joists supported by intermediate walls 08
6.4.12 Joists connected to steel 08
6.4.13 Joists into hangers 09
6.4.14 Timber joist and restraint straps 10
6.4.15 Strutting 12
6.4.16 Joists and openings 12
6.4.17 Multiple joists 13
6.4.18 Notching and drilling 13
6.4.19 Floor decking 14
6.4.20 Floating floors or floors between homes 16
Steelwork
Steelwork should be:
designed by an engineer in accordance with Technical
sized to allow an adequate joist bearing.
Requirement R5 and comply with Chapter 6.4 Steelwork
Structural continuity of the floor should beprovided by the use of continuous decking fixed to joists on both sides of a transverse
steel joist.
Steel beams should be protected by asuitably durable paint coating as detailedin Chapter 6.5 Steelwork.
6.4
40mm
be in accordance with the design
min.
min.
Timber
To counteract fire spread:
combustible material should be kept away from heat sources
structural timber should be separated from sources of heat
in accordance with Chapter 6.8 Fireplaces, chimneys
and flues.
should be filled)
6.4
Table 1: Permissible clear spans for domestic floor joists. Table 2: Permissible clear spans for domestic floor joists.
Strength class C16 Strength class C24
Imposed load not exceeding 1.5 kN/m . 2
Imposed load not exceeding qk = 1.5 kN/m2 or qk = 0.90 kN.
Service class 1 or 2. Service class 1 or 2.
Dead load gk (kN/m2) excluding self-weight of joist Dead load gk (kN/m2) excluding self-weight of joist
Size of joist gk not more gk not more gk not more Size of joist gk not more gk not more gk not more
than 0.25 than 0.50 than 1.25 than 0.25 than 0.50 than 1.25
Joist spacing (mm) Joist spacing (mm)
400 450 600 400 450 600 400 450 600 400 450 600 400 450 600 400 450 600
Breadth Depth Maximum clear span (m) Breadth Depth Maximum clear span (m)
(mm) (mm) (mm) (mm)
38 97 1.76* 1.66* 1.43 1.64* 1.55* 1.35 1.43 1.35 0.71 38 97 2.05* 1.94* 1.68 1.91* 1.80* 1.57 1.64 1.56 1.37
38 120 2.36* 2.23* 1.94 2.18* 2.07* 1.80 1.86 1.77 1.55 38 120 2.63* 2.53* 2.26 2.48* 2.38* 2.09 2.13 2.02 1.78
38 145 2.85* 2.74* 2.48 2.68* 2.58* 2.32 2.33 2.22 1.96 38 145 3.17* 3.05* 2.77 2.99* 2.87* 2.60 2.61 2.51 2.25
38 170 3.33* 3.20* 2.90 3.14* 3.02* 2.73 2.74 2.63 2.37 38 170 3.71* 3.57* 3.24 3.50* 3.36* 3.05 3.06 2.94 2.65
38 195 3.81* 3.67* 3.32 3.59* 3.45* 3.12 3.14 3.01 2.71 38 195 4.25* 4.08* 3.71 4.00* 3.85* 3.49 3.50 3.36 3.04
38 220 4.29* 4.13* 3.74 4.05* 3.89* 3.52 3.53 3.39 3.06 38 220 4.78* 4.60* 4.17 4.51* 4.33* 3.93 3.95 3.79 3.42
44 97 1.89* 1.78* 1.54 1.76* 1.67* 1.45 1.53 1.45 1.27 44 97 2.19* 2.07* 1.81 2.04* 1.93* 1.69 1.75 1.66 1.46
44 120 2.48* 2.39* 2.08 2.33* 2.21* 1.94 1.98 1.88 1.66 44 120 2.77* 2.66* 2.41 2.61* 2.50* 2.24 2.26 2.15 1.90
44 145 2.99* 2.88* 2.61 2.82* 2.71* 2.45 2.46 2.36 2.09 44 145 3.33* 3.20* 2.91 3.14* 3.02* 2.74 2.75 2.64 2.38
44 170 3.50* 3.37* 3.05 3.30* 3.17* 2.87 2.88 2.77 2.50 44 170 3.90* 3.75* 3.40 3.67* 3.53* 3.20 3.22 3.09 2.79
44 195 4.00* 3.85* 3.49 3.78* 3.63* 3.29 3.30 3.17 2.86 44 195 4.46* 4.29* 3.90 4.21* 4.04* 3.67 3.68 3.54 3.20
44 220 4.51* 4.33* 3.94 4.25* 4.09* 3.71 3.72 3.57 3.23 44 220 5.01* 4.82* 4.39 4.73* 4.55* 4.13 4.15 3.98 3.61
47 97 1.95* 1.84* 1.60 1.81* 1.72* 1.50 1.57 1.49 1.31 47 97 2.26* 2.14* 1.87 2.10* 1.99* 1.74 1.80 1.71 1.51
47 120 2.54* 2.44* 2.15 2.39* 2.27* 2.00 2.04 1.94 1.71 47 120 2.83* 2.72* 2.47 2.67* 2.56* 2.31 2.32 2.21 1.96
47 145 3.06* 2.94* 2.67 2.88* 2.77* 2.51 2.52 2.42 2.15 47 145 3.40* 3.27* 2.97 3.21* 3.09* 2.80 2.81 2.70 2.44
47 170 3.58* 3.44* 3.12 3.37* 3.24* 2.94 2.95 2.83 2.56 47 170 3.98* 3.83* 3.48 3.76* 3.61* 3.28 3.29 3.16 2.86
47 195 4.09* 3.94* 3.57 3.86* 3.71* 3.36 3.38 3.24 2.93 47 195 4.55* 4.38* 3.98 4.30* 4.13* 3.75 3.77 3.62 3.27
47 220 4.60* 4.43* 4.02 4.34* 4.18* 3.79 3.80 3.65 3.30 47 220 5.12* 4.93* 4.48 4.83* 4.65* 4.23 4.24 4.08 3.69
6.4
50 97 2.00* 1.89* 1.65 1.87* 1.77* 1.54 1.61 1.53 1.34 50 97 2.32* 2.20* 1.92 2.15* 2.04* 1.79 1.85 1.76 1.55
50 120 2.59* 2.49* 2.22 2.44* 2.34* 2.05 2.09 1.99 1.75 50 120 2.88* 2.77* 2.52 2.72* 2.62* 2.37 2.38 2.27 2.01
50 145 3.12* 3.00* 2.72 2.94* 2.83* 2.56 2.57 2.47 2.21 50 145 3.48* 3.34* 3.04 3.28* 3.15* 2.86 2.87 2.76 2.50
50 170 3.65* 3.51* 3.19 3.44* 3.31* 3.00 3.01 2.89 2.61 50 170 4.06* 3.91* 3.55 3.83* 3.69* 3.35 3.36 3.23 2.92
50 195 4.17* 4.02* 3.65 3.94* 3.79* 3.44 3.45 3.31 3.00 50 195 4.64* 4.47* 4.07 4.38* 4.22* 3.38 3.85 3.69 3.35
50 220 4.70* 4.52* 4.11 4.43* 4.26* 3.87 3.88 3.73 3.38 50 220 5.22* 5.03* 4.58 4.93* 4.75* 4.32 4.33 4.16 3.77
63 97 2.23* 2.11* 1.84 2.07* 1.97* 1.72 1.78 1.70 1.50 63 97 2.52* 2.43* 2.14 2.38* 2.26* 1.99 2.03 1.94 1.72
63 120 2.80* 2.69* 2.44 2.64* 2.54* 2.28 2.30 2.19 1.94 63 120 3.11* 2.99* 2.72 2.94* 2.83* 2.57 2.57 2.47 2.22
63 145 3.37* 3.24* 2.95 3.18* 3.06* 2.78 2.79 2.68 2.42 63 145 3.74* 3.60* 3.28 3.54* 3.40* 3.09 3.10 2.98 2.70
63 170 3.94* 3.79* 3.45 3.72* 3.58* 3.25 3.26 3.13 2.84 63 170 4.37* 4.21* 3.84 4.13* 3.98* 3.62 3.63 3.49 3.17
63 195 4.50* 4.33* 3.94 4.25* 4.09* 3.72 3.73 3.58 3.25 63 195 5.00* 4.81* 4.39 4.72* 4.55* 4.14 4.15 4.00 3.62
63 220 5.06* 4.87* 4.44 4.78* 4.60* 4.18 4.20 4.04 3.66 63 220 5.61* 5.41* 4.94 5.31* 5.12* 4.66 4.68 4.50 4.08
75 120 2.96* 2.85* 2.59 2.79* 2.69* 2.44 2.45 2.35 2.09 75 120 3.29* 3.17* 2.88 3.11* 2.99* 2.72 2.73 2.62 2.38
75 145 3.56* 3.43* 3.12 3.37* 3.24* 2.94 2.95 2.84 2.57 75 145 3.96* 3.81* 3.48 3.74* 3.60* 3.28 3.29 3.16 2.87
75 170 4.16* 4.01* 3.65 3.93* 3.79* 3.44 3.45 3.32 3.01 75 170 4.62* 4.45* 4.06 4.37* 4.21* 3.83 3.85 3.70 3.36
75 195 4.75* 4.58* 4.17 4.49* 4.33* 3.94 3.95 3.80 3.45 75 195 5.27* 5.08* 4.64 4.99* 4.81* 4.38 4.40 4.23 3.85
75 220 5.34* 5.15* 4.70 5.05* 4.87* 4.43 4.45 4.28 3.88 75 220 5.92* 5.71* 5.22 5.61* 5.41* 4.93 4.95 4.76 4.33
ALS/CLS ALS/CLS
38 140 2.75* 2.64* 2.39 2.59* 2.49* 2.21 2.24 2.13 1.88 38 140 3.07* 2.95* 2.67 2.89* 2.77* 2.51 2.52 2.42 2.15
38 184 3.60* 3.46* 3.14 3.39* 3.26* 2.95 2.96 2.84 2.56 38 184 4.01* 3.86* 3.50 3.78* 3.63* 3.29 3.31 3.17 2.87
38 235 4.58* 4.40* 3.99 4.32* 4.15* 3.76 3.77 3.62 3.27 38 235 5.10* 4.90* 4.46 4.81* 4.62* 4.20 4.21 4.04 3.65
89 184 4.74* 4.57* 4.17 4.48* 4.32* 3.94 3.95 3.80 3.45 89 184 5.25* 5.07* 4.63 4.98* 4.80* 4.38 4.39 4.23 3.85
89 235 5.99* 5.78* 5.29 5.68* 5.48* 5.00 5.01 4.83 4.39 89 235 6.64* 6.41* 5.87 6.30* 6.08* 5.56 5.57 5.37 4.89
6.4
it is excessively bowed, twisted orcambered
Levelling
Bearings for joists should be level. The floor should be levelled: staircase
trimmer
from the staircase trimmer and trimming joist
be used.
Support
The floor should have an adequate bearing on the supportingstructure.
Timber joists should normallyhave a minimum bearing as shown in Table 3.
The figures in brackets should only be usedwhen the joist is not providing restraint tothe wall.
Joists may be:
supported on joist hangersor on internal load-bearing walls
built into the innerleaf of an external cavity wall, with care
taken to ensure air-tightness.
Where joists are built into separating walls, fire-and sound-resisting performance, in accordance with building regulations, should be
taken into account.
Solid timber joists
Where built into solid external walls, joists should be treated with preservative.
6.4
uprights at uprights at
intermediate bearing end bearing
Where joists are supported on walls, noggings may be required at the top flange along the wall to support the floor decking,
and at the bottom flange to support the plasterboard ceiling. Where joists are not built into brickwork or blockwork, blocking should
be provided at the joist bearing. The blocking may be used for fixing plasterboard and floor decking.
6.4
overlapping joists intermediate intermediate support
nailed together support for I-joist for metal web joist
100mm max.
overhang
timber shrinkage
be provided with strutting to prevent rotation.
I-joists
Where connected to steel beams, I-joists should not be notched at the flange, and should:
bear directly into the steel beam where the bearing is more
have blocking fixedto the steel beam to enable the I-joists
than 45mm. Strutting, (noggings 38mm x thickness of flange) to be face fixed using joist hangers. Struttingis not required
should be provided at the top and bottom flanges, or when hangers the full depth of the joist areused to face fix
joists to the blocking.
Masonry supporting joist hangers should be checked for level and height. The top flange loading on the joist hanger should not be
greater than the strength of the supporting masonry. Where joist hangers are supported on lightweight blockwork, the suitability of
the hanger should be checked. Joist hangers which meet BS EN 845 have a stamp indicating the minimum compressive strength of
block for which they are suitable.
Hangers should:
be detailed in the design, including the type of support to be
used for joists, trimmers and trimming joists
have a 75mm minimum bearing on masonry
comply with BS EN 845-1 or comply with
Technical Requirement R3
have performance equivalent to restraint straps at 2m centres
timber to timber to heavy duty
where required to provide restraint timber hanger masonry hanger hanger
be the correct size for the joist or trimmer
be nailed through each circular hole in the vertical sides
gap between joist and
hanger is 6mm max.
bear on level beds and be tight to the wall
not be cut into the walling.
Joists should be accurately cut to length. Where joists are not
built into brickwork or blockwork, blocking should be provided
at the joist bearing. The blocking may be used for fixing
plasterboard and floor decking.
Solid joists
Where connected to hangers, solid timber joists should:
have a minimum bearing of 75mm onto the hanger
be notched into the hanger to keep the ceilingline level
notched to
be the full depth of the hanger.
keep ceiling
line level
I-joists
Where connected to hangers, I-joists should not be notched at the flange, and should have:
a minimum bearing of 45mm onto the hanger
the tabs of the hanger bent andnailed to the bottom flange.
Hangers should be:
the full depth of the joist and restrain the top flange, or
at least 0.6 x the depth of the joistand have stiffeners
(full depth) fixed to both sides of the web.
joist hanger
tabs bent over
and nailed to flange
Timber joist and restraint straps 6.4.14 Also see: Chapter 6.1 and BS 8103-1
Upper floors shall provide adequate lateral restraint.
6.4
Restraint straps and joist hangerssuitable for taking tensile forces may berequired to tie walls and upper floorstogether or when the
external wall is stabilisedby a connection to the floor. Straps should:
be detailed in the design, including the size, position
bear on the centre of bricksor blocks and not on
and fixings mortar joints
be galvanised steel with a 30mm x 5mm cross-section or be
be fixed on the side, top or bottom, as appropriate to the
in accordance with Technical Requirement R3 joist type.
have adequate packing between the wall and the first joist
restraint strap held tight top fixed strap strap centered on block
against blockwork and tight to wall
side fixed
strap
Restraint straps should be provided along the direction of thejoists and spaced at a maximum of 2m centres. They are not generally
required at the ends of joists in buildings up to, and including, two storeys where:
restraint type joist hangers in accordance with
joists are built into a wall and bear at least90mm on the wall.
Technical Requirement R3 are used, or
Where joists run parallel to thewall, straps should be fitted along the joists with a maximum spacing of 2m, and:
be supported on noggings and extend over at least
have noggings provided to receive two additional nails
three joists (for solid joists, two 4.76mm diameter x 50mm long wood
be fixed with two screws or nails into each joist
screws (No.10) or 4mm diameter x 75mm round nails
(8 SWG) can be used in each joist).
I-joist with
restraint strap max. 2m centres nogging
packing
I-joists
I-joists should not be notched and have:
6.4
Strutting 6.4.15
Strutting shall be provided where required to distribute loads and ensure adequaterigidity of the
floor structure.
Strutting should: herringbone strutting blocking
I-joists bracing
Strutting to I-joists should be: strongback
6.4
Table 5: Strutting for metal web joists
Joist span (m) Rows of strutting
4-8 1 (at centre of span)
over 8 2 (at equal spacing)
backer
blocks
nails spaced
at approx.
450mm centres
the manufacturer
restraint straps can be slotted into webs immediately below
metal webs
maximum duct sizes should be in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations
large service ducts may have to be inserted before fixing
6.4
Table 7: Floor decking requirements
Floor decking 400mm joist centres 450mm joist centres 600mm joist centres Standard
Softwood boarding 16 16 19 BS EN 13353
Moisture resistant chipboard 18 18 22 BS EN 312 type P5
Plywood 15 15 18/19 BS EN 636
Oriented strand board 15 15 18/19 BS EN 300 type OSB3
min. 10mm
expansion gap
nogging
joist or nogging
When fixing:
fixings should have a maximum spacing of 300mm along
where boards abut a rigidupstand, a minimum 10mm
continuously supported edges andintermediate supports expansion gap should be provided; for large areas of
6.4
Plywood flooring
When fixing plywood flooring:
boards should be laid with the face grainat right angles to
fixings should have a maximum spacing of 150mm around
the supports the perimeter and a maximum spacing of 300mm on
end joints should occur over joists or noggings
intermediate supports
an expansion gap of at least 1.5mm-2mmshould be allowed
between each panel.
Nails for fixing plywood should be in accordance with Table 8.
Proprietary flooring
Proprietary flooring should be:
in accordance with Technical Requirement R3
installed inaccordance with certification requirements.
Protection against damage
Floor decking should be stored:
on a hard base
indoors where possible.
under cover
Where timber decking is to be installed before thehome is watertight, themanufacturer should confirm suitability.
Floors should not be overloaded, especiallywith materials during construction, and be protected againstdamp, plaster splashesand
other damage.
6.4
6.5.1 Compliance 01
6.5.2 Design guidance 01
6.5.3 Steel grade and coatings 03
6.5.4 Installation and support 05
6.5.5 Padstones 05
6.5.6 Connections 06
6.5.7 Examples 07
Design guidance 6.5.2 Also see: Chapters 6.1, 6.3 and 6.4
Steelwork shall be designed to support and transmit loads to the supporting structure without undue
movement or deflection. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) support of masonry partitions
b) support of timber floors, including trimmed openings.
Where any of the conditions are not met, steelwork should be designed in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
Method of applying tables:
Ensure that all conditions apply.
Check the span of the beam(s).
Identify the masonry partition construction and thickness.
Use Table 2 to determine a suitable steel section size.
Use Table 1 to establish the load per metre run.
Use Table 6 to determine if padstones are required.
An example is provided at the end of this chapter.
Table 1: Load of partition to be supported
Type of masonry for supported partition Maximum masonry Structural thickness (mm)
(not more than 2.7m high density (kg/m3) 100 90 75
and plastered both sides)
Load (kN/m run)
Dense masonry 2000 6.8 6.2 5.4
Medium masonry 1400 5.1 4.8 4.2
Lightweight masonry 800 3.5 3.3 2.9
3 to 5 Up to 3 127 x 76 x 13
3 to 3.5 152 x 89 x 16
3.5 to 4 178 x 102 x 19
Over 4 (2)
5 to 7 Up to 2.5 127 x 76 x 13
2.5 to 3 152 x 89 x 16
3 to 4 178 x 102 x 19
Over 4 (2)
Notes
1
For spans up to 4m, universal column 152mm x 152mm x 23kg/m (smallest size available) may be used.
2 For spans over 4m, beams should be designed by an engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
6.5
and the ceiling is plasterboard with a plaster skim coat or a Padstones are provided where required in accordance
plastic finish (Artex or similar). with Table 6.
Allowance has been made of 0.5kN/m2 for self-weight
Clear span of beam does not exceed 4.4m.
(floor and ceiling load). Connections between steelwork beams are in accordance
The floor does not support masonry partitions.
with clause 6.5.6, or are designed by an engineer.
The floor support is one of the methods shown in Figure 1.
Where any of the conditions are not met, steelwork should be designed by an engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
Method of applying tables:
Use Figure 1 to determine the area supported by
Use Table 7 to determine if padstones are required.
the beam(s). Where steel beam-to-steel connections are required,
Check the span of the beam(s).
refer to the connections in Clause 6.5.6.
Use Table 3 to determine a suitable steelsection size.
A A
wall wall
under B under A A
A A B
void
B
B C B C
A A
B A A A A
void void void
B B C B C
Where any area shown as void contains a staircase, add 2m2 to theeffective area supported by any beam which fully or partially
supports that staircase.
Table 3: Size of steel beam supporting timber floor
Effective area Effective trimmer span Smallest suitable steel section size (mm x mm x kg/m)
supported (m2) = clear span + 100mm (m) Universal beam Universal column
0 to 20 0 to 2.0 127 x 76 x 13 152 x 152 x 23
0 to 20 2 to 2.5 127 x 76 x 13 152 x 152 x 23
20 to 30 152 x 89 x 16 152 x 152 x 23
0 to 10 2.5 to 3 127 x 76 x 13 152 x 152 x 23
10 to 20 152 x 89 x 16 152 x 152 x 23
20 to 30 178 x 102 x 19 152 x 152 x 23
0 to 10 3 to 3.5 127 x 76 x 13 152 x 152 x 23
10 to 30 178 x 102 x 19 152 x 152 x 23
30 to 40 203 x 133 x 25 152 x 152 x 30
0 to 10 3.5 to 4 152 x 89 x 16 152 x 152 x 23
10 to 20 178 x 102 x 19 152 x 152 x 23
20 to 30 203 x 102 x 23 152 x 152 x 23
30 to 40 203 x 102 x 30 152 x 152 x 30
6.5
40 to 50 * 152 x 152 x 37
0 to 10 4 to 4.5 203 x 102 x 23 152 x 152 x 23
10 to 20 203 x 133 x 25 152 x 152 x 23
20 to 30 203 x 133 x 30 152 x 152 x 30
30 to 40 * 152 x 152 x 37
40 to 50 * 203 x 203 x 46
*Beams should be designed by an engineer in accordance withTechnical Requirement R5.
Table 4: Environment categories for component groups in different locations and exposure conditions
Component group Location Description of exposure condition Environment categories
External Outside a home Above splash zone C4 or C5(1)
At ground level within splash zone C5(2)
(up to 150mm above ground)
Outside or basement Below ground level C5(2)
Internal Sub-floor void(3) Unventilated C3
Ventilated C2
Internal Kitchen/bathroom, etc. Moist humid conditions protected against condensation C2
Kitchen/bathroom, etc. Moist humid conditions exposed to condensation C2
Rooms other than Warm dry C2
kitchen/bathroom, etc.
In roof void Unheated dry C2
Internal/external Faade Embedded or partially embedded in building envelope C5(4)
Notes
1
For construction located within 500m of coastal shoreline.
2 Alternatively, steelwork may be encased in concrete.
3 For steelwork not in contact with the ground.
4 For steelwork in contact with, or embedded in an external masonry wall, for at the contact / embedment length.
Alternatively, guidance on suitable atmospheric corrosivity categories (C1 C5) and appropriate protective coatings for domestic
construction may be based on the recommendations given on the website www.steelconstruction.info. A site specific assessment
is required in order to determine an appropriate classification level for the steelwork. A suitable protective coating specification is to
be determined by the designer in accordance with the coating manufacturers recommendations.
Table 5: Protective coatings for hot rolled structural steelwork for atmospheric corrosivity category (recommended for housing
applications only)
Atmospheric Surface Protective coating(1, 2, 3) Site or Making good of
corrosivity preparation(4) Material Minimum coating thickness Number factory damaged areas of
and risk (d.f.t.)(5) / weight(6) of coats applied protective coating
C1 N/A None required. N/A N/A N/A N/A
6.5
Very low
C2 Thoroughly clean High build zinc 80 m(8) 1 or 2 Factory Thoroughly wire brush
Low surface prior to phosphate epoxy damaged areas and
abrasive blast primer(7) build up coats using the
cleaning to Sa 2. same materials and to
the same d.f.t.
C3 Thoroughly clean High build zinc 80 m(8) 1 or 2 Factory Thoroughly wire brush
Medium surface prior to phosphate epoxy damaged areas and
abrasive blast (7)
primer, followed build up coats using the
cleaning to by high build 120 m 1 same materials and to
Sa 2. recoatable epoxy the same d.f.t.
micaceous iron
oxide (MIO) (200 m in total)
C4(9) Hot dip 460 gms/m 1 Factory To be determined by the
High galvanize to designer in accordance
BS EN ISO 1461 with the manufacturers
recommendations.
C5(9) Hot dip 710 gms/m 1 Factory To be determined by the
Very high galvanize to designer in accordance
BS EN ISO 1461 with the manufacturers
recommendations.
Notes
here steelwork is to be given a decorative finish, the protective coat is to be compatible with the decorative finish.
1 W
Manufacturers recommendations should be followed.
2 Where steelwork is to be protected by intumescent paint for fire purposes, manufacturers recommendations should be followed.
3 All fixings and fittings to the structural steel elements are to be protected against corrosion in a manner that is both commensurate and compatible with the
protective coatings.
4 Surface preparation to BS EN ISO 12944-4.
5 Coating thicknesses given represent nominal dry film thickness (d.f.t.).
6 Thicknesses and weights shown represent the coating to be applied to each face of a steel section.
7 Epoxy primers have a limited time for over-coating. Manufacturers recommendations should be followed.
8 80 m can be in one coat or as 20 m pre-fabrication primer plus 60 m post-fabrication primer.
9 Alternatively, use products manufactured from austenitic stainless steel in accordance with the recommendations of BS EN 1993-1-4:2006.
Where shop-applied protective coatings have been damaged, the coatings should be made good on site prior to being built into the
works, as indicated in Table 5 Making good of damaged areas.
Where steelwork is to be welded, the protective coatingsystem specified by the designer should be used.
Where steelwork is to be protected byintumescent paint for fire purposes, this should be in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
Steelwork support
Beam supports should not occur above window or door openings. Bearings for steelwork supported on masonry should be:
100mm minimum
clean, dry and level.
Padstones 6.5.5
Steelwork shall be supported by padstones where required to distribute point loads safely to the supporting
structure without undue movement or deflection.
Where a steel beam is supported by masonry, a padstone may be required to spread the load over a larger areato
prevent overstressing. Padstones should be in accordance with:
the engineers design, or
the guidance given in this chapter.
6.5
Where the inner leaf of the cavity wall contributes to the overall thermal performance of the wall, padstones should:
have similar thermal properties to themasonry used for the
not create a cold bridge.
rest of the inner leaf, or
Padstones should be formed in one unit with a minimum compressive strength of 10 N/mm2 from:
in-situ concrete
clay bricks, or
precast concrete
engineering bricks (when less than 215mm x 100mm).
concrete blocks
Connections 6.5.6
Connections shall be chosen and installed to achieve the required structural performance.
Steelwork connections should:
be in accordance with the guidance in this chapter, or
where other forms of connection (e.g. high strength friction
grip bolts) are required, be designed by an engineer in
6.5
accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
Only weld, cut or drill steelwork where it isrequired by the design.
Bolts for connections should comply with the design information and relevant British Standards, including:
BS 4190 Specification for ISO metric black hexagon bolts, screws and nuts.
BS 4395 Specification for high strength friction grip bolts and associated nuts and washers for structural engineering.
BS 4604 Specification for use of high strength friction grip bolts in structural steelwork.
BS 5135 Specification for arc welding of carbon and carbon-manganese steels.
The connection methods detailed in this chapter are suitable for connecting steelbeams used to support floor loads only, using black
bolts or welding.
25mm 25mm
10mm max.
Joints between beams of similar size
10mm max. (neither beam deeper than 170mm)
Examples 6.5.7
1 Using information about the supported wall and Table 1: Wall supported by steel beam:
75mm thick
load per metre run = 4.2kN/m medium density (1200kg/m3)
plastered both sides
2 Using the load per metre run, the span of the beam 2.6m high.
and Table 2:
suitable section size = 178 x 102 x 19 UB
52 x 152 x 23 UC is not suitable as it is too wide for the
1
inner padstone/wall.
3 Using information about the wall supporting the beam
(100mm thick), the walls supported by the beam outer
padstone
(medium density block) and Table 6: 100mm
inner
Steel beam: padstone
opening 3.8m 100mm
min 100mm bearing at each end.
6.6.1 Compliance 01
6.6.2 Provision of information 01
6.6.3 Fire precautions 01
6.6.4 Lighting 01
6.6.5 Safe transmission of loads 01
6.6.6 Headroom and width 02
6.6.7 Design of steps 02
6.6.8 Landings 04
6.6.9 Guarding 04
6.6.10 Handrails 05
6.6.11 Timber staircases 05
6.6.12 Timber and wood-based products 06
6.6.13 Finished joinery 06
6.6.14 Concrete staircases 06
6.6.15 Steel staircases 07
6.6.16 Staircase units 07
6.6.17 Fixings 07
6.6.18 Protection 07
two-way switching. In common areas, automatic light-sensitive controls may be used, provided lights can also be switched to
two-way manually.
Where staircases are lit by glazing, any glass below the minimum guarding height should be:
protected by a balustrade or railing
constructed of glass blocks.
glass (toughened or laminated), or
Staircase construction
Stairs and staircases should comply with BS 5395 : Parts 1 and 2 and Table 1.
Table 1: Standards for stair construction
Type of staircase Relevant standard
Timber staircases BS 585.
(straight flights, or landings) The method of fixing flights to the surrounding structure should be specified.
Reinforced concrete staircases BS EN 1992-1-1 and Chapter 3.1 Concrete and its reinforcement
Should be designed by an engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
Steel staircases BS EN 1993-1-1.
Proprietary staircases Technical Requirement R3.
Differential movement
When considering differential movement in relation to setting out, levels and finishes, allowances should be made for:
casting tolerances
creep and shrinkage
deflection under load
storey height.
foundation settlement
Headroom
Stairs should have a minimum 2m clear head room (H) over the
entire length and width of the stairway and landing, as measured
vertically from the pitch line.
The overall floor opening should be checked: H
for size to accept the stairs
landing
pitch line
6.6
In Northern Ireland and Scotland, stair widths should be in accordance with building regulations.
Where staircases form part of a means of escape, reference should be made to the relevant building regulations.
Pitch
The maximum angle of pitch of a stairway should not exceed:
42 for private stairs
Staircases should be accurately located and fixed with the string at the correct angle to ensure all treads are level.
Stairs should be dimensioned so that the rise (R) and the going (G) is between 550mm and 700mm when using the equation:
2R + G (see Chart 1).
210
200
198
243
190
187
180
170
Rise (mm)
160
150
140
130
120
110
100
220 230 240 250 260 270 280 290 300 310 320 330 340 350 360 370 380
Going (mm)
private stairs
Steps
In each flight:
the tread should be level
the rise and going should be consistent
the thicknesses of screeds and floor finishes should be
unequal rises
taken into account to ensure that all risers are equal do not comply
stair finish
all risers
equal
floor finish
Where stairs are open to the weather, or may otherwise become wet, one of the following should be specified:
A non-slip finish.
A non-slip insert to each tread.
centre line
6.6.8
Landings
Landings shall allow safe use of the staircase.
Landings should be: bottom landing
at least the same depth and width as the width of the stair.
400mm min.
Door swings should not obstruct landings. A door may open
across the bottom landing of private stairs where the:
home is not over two storeys high
Pivot windows should not obstruct the landing area or stair flight when they are opened.
Guarding 6.6.9
Staircases shall have guarding to prevent accidents by falling.
6.6
Guarding:
is required where the drop is more than 600mm at any point
may be required where a stair abuts anopening window,
along the open sides of stairs and landings to comply with relevant building regulations.
is not required where the rise is less than 600mm and the
Handrails 6.6.10
Handrails and balustrading shall be correctly located and fixed to provide a safe handhold, and constructed to
reduce the risk of being climbed or fallen through.
A handrail is required for flights of stairs that rise over 600mm.
The handrail (throughout the full length) should:
be securely fixed and located in accordance with
the design
be a vertical distance of 900mm-1000mm (or
840mm-1000mm in Scotland), above the pitch line
have a 25mm minimum clearance from any surface
ensure a firm handhold
25mm
min.
ensure that trapping or injuring is prevented
have ends shaped or returned to the wall
be continuous, smooth and unobstructed.
In Northern Ireland, where winders are used, building regulations require a handrail to be fitted on the side where tapered treads
have the longest going.
Fixings
Fixing methods for balustrading should allow for a degree of
tolerance. It may be preferable to take measurements from the
completed staircase before manufacture. This should ensure
that the fixings are positioned correctly and allow for variations in
the surrounding structure.
Design information on the spacing of bolt fixings for balustrades
6.6
6.6
Finished joinery should be free from splits, knocks and other damage which would impair its structural performance or finish.
Nails should be punched below the surface of the wood and stopped.
Handrails should:
have a smooth finish and be free from rough edges
not have any sharp edges, including brackets or
screw heads.
Precast construction
Account should be taken of:
workmanship, particularly at the top and bottom of eachflight
accurate locationand levelling of units.
In-situ construction
Guidance for in-situ concrete can be found in Chapter 3.1 Concrete and its reinforcement.
Shuttering for concrete elements or connections should be constructed to ensure a consistent rise and going.
Chairs or spacing blocks should be used to provide cover to reinforcement in accordance with Table 5.
Formwork should be struck in accordance with the design information. This is normally:
after 24 hours for side formwork
after 28 days for soffit and support formwork.
Floor Finishes
For both precast and in-situ staircases, allowance should be made for:
the thickness of finish at the top and bottom of flights
preformed nosings or non-slip finishes, where specified.
Fixings 6.6.17
6.6
Staircases shall have fixings of adequate strength and durability, and comply with the design.
Fixings should be in accordance with the design and the manufacturers reccomendations, including:
timber and steel staircases
handrails
newel posts
guarding and balustrading.
Protection 6.6.18
On completion, staircases shall be undamaged.
When storing staircases, they should be:
stacked on bearers
suitably protected from the weather.
Timber staircases should be fixed in place only when the
building is weathertight.
Staircases, stair treads, nosings, balustrades and handrails may
be protected with timber strips, plywood or building paper.
6.7.1 Compliance 01
6.7.2 Provision of information 01
6.7.3 In service performance 01
6.7.4 Installation 02
6.7.5 Non-timber windows and doors 03
6.7.6 Timber doors and windows 04
6.7.7 Glazing 05
6.7.8 Security 07
6.7.9 Ironmongery 08
6.7.10 Material storage and protection 09
6.7.11 Completed work 09
Weathertightness
Doors and windows should be installed correctly to ensure adequate in-service performance. Windows and external doors exposed
to wind-driven rain should be constructed and detailed to ensure they remain weathertight, including at interfaces with
the structure.
BS 6375 contains recommendations for the classification of window components according to their resistance under test to air and
water penetration, and wind pressure.
Joints between multiple door and window frame assemblies should be:
part of an engineered system
formed using suitable materials in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
6.7
Vertical and horizontal DPCs should be provided around the frame in accordance with Chapter 6.1 External masonry walls and
Chapter 6.2 External timber framed walls.
DPCs should:
be correctly installed
extend approximately25mm into the cavity
be continuous for the full height of the frame.
When placing frames for external elements in openings, ensure:
the headof the frame is protected by the lintel
water bar and weatherboard
throatings in sill members are notobstructed by the
provided for external doors
wall face.
Additional precautions include:
setting the frame back from the facade
throating clear
wall face sealant
throating clear
wall face sealant
building a projecting porch
providing a rain check groove to inward opening
external door frames
fixing weatherboards and water bars toexternal doors,
but ensuring the threshold isaccessible where appropriate.
sealant
sealant
25mm
rebated or check reveal in
areas of very severe exposure
Fire-resisting doors and positive self-closing devices should be fitted where they are required by building regulations.
Thermal break
Metal windows should incorporate a thermal break.
Strength
Door frames, windows and their fittings should be adequate to withstand operational loads.
Structural loads should be carried on lintels, beams or appropriate structural elements. Where frames are required to carry
structural loads, they should be designed accordingly.
Installation 6.7.4
6.7
Doors and windows shall be correctly located and securely fixed. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) workmanship and fixing d) door hinges
b) hanging doors and opening lights e) window boards
c) general ironmongery f) bay windows.
full architrave
Internal door frames and linings should:
match the thickness of the wall, partitions and finishes
be securely fixed, to prevent curling.
be blocked off walls wherever possible, to allow for
full architraves
Timber trim should be:
sufficiently wide to mask joints
fixed to minimise movement andshrinkage.
Architraves should be:
parallel to frames and linings
fixed with an equal margin to eachframe member
accurately mitred, or scribed, to fit neatly and tightly
fixed securely.
When fixing components:
nails should be punched below the surfaceof the timber with
damage should be avoided.
holes stopped
General ironmongery
Hinges and other ironmongery should be:
housed neatly andflush with the surface
supplied with a full set of matching screws.
Locks should:
turn easily
have keyholes which are properly aligned
not be fitted in mortises too tightly
Door hinges
To reduce twisting, doors should be hung on hinges in accordance with Table 1.
Table 1: Door hinges
Type of door Hinges
External 1 pairs x 100mm
Internal door 1 pair x 75mm
Fire door In accordance with the door manufacturers recommendations
Airing or cylinder cupboard 1 pairs x 75mm
Window boards
Window boards should:
have a flat and level top surface
be of a moisture resistant grade where MDF is used.
be fixed close to the frame and adequately secured against
6.7
Bay windows
Timber doors and windows 6.7.6 Also see: Chapter 3.3 and 9.5
Timber and wood-based materials shall be of suitable quality and be naturally durable or suitably treated.
Issues to be taken into account include:
a) classification and use
b) drying shrinkage
c) preparation and finish.
In England, Wales, Northern Ireland and the Isle of Man, planted stops are not permitted on frames to external doors.
External doors should be 42.5mm minimum (44mm nominal) in thickness.
Drying shrinkage
To minimise drying shrinkage, the moisture content of joinery, when fixed, should not exceed the value given in Table 2.
Table 2: Moisture content of joinery
Joinery items Moisture content (%)
Windows and frames 17
Internal joinery:
Intermittent heating.
15
Continuous heating.
12
6.7
In close proximity to a heat source.
9
On delivery, the moisture content should be within +/-2% of the values specified.
Glazing 6.7.7
Glass and the method of glazing shall be installed in accordance with the design and to ensure adequate
in-service performance. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) standards e) condition before installation
b) glazing compounds f) sizing
c) glazing systems g) rebates
d) insulating glass units h) bead glazing.
Standards
Where there is a high risk of accidental breakage, glazing should be designed and selected to comply with the relevant safety
recommendations as follows:
England, Wales and the Isle of Man Approved Document N
Northern Ireland Technical Booklet V
Scotland BS 6262
Where there is a particular risk (such as door side panels or low level glazing) and where fully glazed panels can be mistaken
for doors, toughened or laminated glass, or other materials such as acrylic or polycarbonate, may be required.
The glass supplier should provide documentation to confirm:
the properties of the glass used
compliance with the appropriate British Standards.
Glazed materials and units should be:
compatible withthe levels of safety and security that
identified as safety glass with a permanent marking
are required (includesglazed shower/bath screens).
Glazing should ensure adequate in-service performance. The quality and thickness of normal window glass should:
be specified to suit the design wind loads for the location
comply with BS 6262 and relevantdata sheets issued by the
Glass and Glazing Federation.
Glazing and materials should comply with appropriate British Standards, including:
6.7
Glazing compounds
Glazing compounds should:
be compatiblewith the frame finishes
be in accordance with the manufacturersrecommendations.
Linseed oil based putty should not be used in the installation of laminated glass or insulating glass units.
Glazing systems
Drained and vented systems
Drained and vented systems should be used for site fixed insulating glass units and where units greater than 1m2 are used, to allow
moisture that enters the glazing channel between the frame and the edge seal of the insulating glass unit to drain away and prevent
long-term moisture contact with the edge seal. Drained and vented systems should have:
a minimum 5mm gap between the frames lower rebate and
the edge seal of the insulating glass unit
the edge seal of the insulating glass unit adequately protected.
adequate drainage and ventilation through holes,
slots or channels
Beads
In external situations, the bottom beadshould:
project slightly over the rebateedge
be fixed to the rebate platform.
Insulating glass units
Insulating glass units should:
carry a CE mark to BS EN 1279 and have third-party
have a dual seal or a single seal of hot melt butyl and
certification, e.g. BSI Kitemark desiccant in at least one long and one short section of the
be checked to ensure they comply with the design, including
spacer bar.
glass type, gas filling, edge seal type anddimensions
6.7
internal surfaces to become marked
Insulating glass units should be adequately protected when stored prior to installation.
Sizing
To account for thermal expansion, the following gaps should be provided:
3mm gap between the glass edge and the frame
5mm gap at the bottom bead fordrained systems.
Insulating glass units should not be cut orpunctured on site.
Rebates
Rebates for glass should be:
the correct size for the glazing
rigid and true.
primed where timber
Bead glazing
Beads and linings should be used for:
internal glazing
locations where shock absorption is required.
Beads should be fixed at a maximum of 150mm centres.
Security 6.7.8
Doors, door frames, windows and locks shall be designed and specified to improve their resistance to
unauthorised entry. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) locking functionality of main entrance doors e) glazing
b) locking functionality of secondary access doors f) framed wall construction
c) opening limitation device g) door and frame connections
d) view outside h) windows.
Locking devices fitted to main entrance doors should permit emergency egress without the use of a key when the home
is occupied.
Homes with an alternative means of escape via a door
The door should be held closed on a latch. Enhanced security can be achieved by providing the facility
Deadlocking should be operated by a key externally and to deadlock the internal thumb turn when leaving the home
a handle or thumb turn internally (BS 8621 locks and unoccupied (BS 10621 locks and PAS 10621 multi point
PAS 8621 multi point locks meet these requirements). locks meet these requirements).
Homes opening directly to the outside without an alternative means of escapevia a door
The door should be held closed on a latch. Deadlocking should be operated by a key externally and
a handle or thumb turn internally (BS 8621 locks and
PAS 8621 multi point locks meet these requirements).
Homes opening onto a communalaccess without an alternative means ofescape
The door should be held closed with a roller bolt or a latch Deadlocking should be operated by a key externally and
6.7
operated by a handle internally and externally. a handle or thumb turn internally (BS 8621 locks and PAS
8621 multi point locks meet these requirements).
View outside
There should be a means of giving a wideangle view of the area immediately outside the main entrance door of individual homes.
Acceptable methods include:
a through-door viewer closed-circuit camera and displays (not connected to a TV).
clear glazing either to part of the door or a
convenient window
Glazing
Any glazing which, if broken, would permit release of the internal handle or thumb turn byhand or arm entry should be laminated.
Windows
Opening lights on ground floor windows and others which are readily accessible from the outside may be fitted with lockable devices
which cannot be released without a key.
Ironmongery 6.7.9
Ironmongery shall be suitable for the intended use.
Ironmongery should be provided in accordance with the design. Materials used for critical functions should comply with the
appropriate standards, including:
BS EN 1935 Building hardware. Single-axis hinges. Requirements and test methods.
BS 3621 Thief resistant lock assembly. Key egress.
6.7
BS 8621 Thief resistant lock assembly. Keyless egress.
BS 10621 Thief resistant dual-mode lock assembly.
BS 4951 Specification for builders hardware: lock and latch furniture(doors).
BS 5872 Specification for locks and latches for doors in buildings.
BS EN 1154 Building hardware. Controlled door closing devices. Requirements and test methods.
Where doors to rooms containing a bath or WC have a securing device, it should be of a type capable of being opened from the
outside in an emergency.
In sheltered accommodation, additional special provisions may be needed for all door locks, limiters and other fasteners, to enable
wardens to gain access when necessary.
Storage
Where joinery is stored on site, precautionsshould include:
avoiding wetting during unloading
stacking external joinery on bearersoff the ground and
covering withwaterproof material
storing internal joinery in a weather protectedcondition.
Cut ends
Where pretreated joinery is cut or adjusted on site, the affected
surfaces should be retreated with appropriate preservative in
accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
6.8.1 Compliance 01
6.8.2 Provision of information 02
6.8.3 Solid fuel fireplaces and hearths 02
6.8.4 Solid fuel combustion air 03
6.8.5 Solid fuel flue pipes 03
6.8.6 Solid fuel chimneys 04
6.8.7 Solid fuel terminals and outlets 05
6.8.8 Gas fireplaces and hearths 06
6.8.9 Gas combustion air 07
6.8.10 Gas flue pipes 07
6.8.11 Gas chimneys 08
6.8.12 Gas outlets and terminals 10
6.8.13 Oil fireplaces and hearths 11
6.8.14 Oil combustion air 12
6.8.15 Oil flue pipes 12
6.8.16 Oil chimneys 12
6.8.17 Oil outlets and terminals 13
6.8.18 All fireplaces and hearths 14
6.8.19 All fireplace surrounds 14
6.8.20 All flue pipes 15
6.8.21 All flue liners 15
6.8.22 All flues 16
6.8.23 All chimneys 17
6.8.24 Masonry 19
6.8.25 Mortar 19
6.8.26 DPC 19
6.8.27 Flashings 19
6.8.28 Terminals 20
6.8.29 Flue testing 21
6.8.30 Further information 21
Introduction
In this chapter, the following terms are used:
ridge terminal flue and chimney terminal flue and chimney terminal
flue lining
roof space
first floor
gas appliance
flue pipe
free standing
solid fuel open hearth
appliance
6.8
party wall
Good workmanship and effective supervision during construction areessential to ensure that fireplaces,chimneys and flues function
correctly in use.
Fireplaces, chimneys and flues should be designed and installed to minimise the risk of the building catching fire. The design of
timber frame construction should ensure that combustible material is:
suitably separated from heat sources,or
shielded, where permitted.
6.8
Constructional hearths should be: plan view
freestanding appliances
The adjacent diagram shows the minimum dimensions from
300mm
min.
1.2m
min
t
150mm 150mm
min. x
min.
hearth
appliance
75mm min. solid non-combustible material
t = thickness of solid non-combustible material as follows:
x less than 50mm = t (200mm min.)
x more than 50mm = t (75mm min.)
1.5xD
3xD
non-combustible
shield
non-combustible
shield
D
min.
D 4xD
flue pipe
flue pipe
requirement in Northern Ireland
requirement elsewhere
(D = external diameter of the flue pipe)
6.8
Factory-made insulated chimneys should:
be designed in accordance with BS 4543 and BS EN1859
be installed in accordance with BS 7566 or be assessed in
have a minimum operating life of 30 years
accordance with Technical Requirement R3.
Flue liners
Flue liners should:
have rebated or socketed joints installed with the socket or
be reasonably smooth on the inside
internal rebate facing uppermost be correctly jointed with mortar (the space between the
be installed in accordance with the
liners and the brickwork should be filled with weak insulating
manufacturers recommendations concrete unless the manufacturer recommends
be non-combustible
an alternative)
be properly jointed at their junctions with the starter block,
have any changes in direction formed using purpose-made
or lintel, and the outlet terminal bends (cut pipes are not acceptable).
Resistance to weather
In areas of severe or very severe exposure, cavities should be continuous up to roof level. This applies to:
cavities below roof level where the stack forms part of an
the complete chimney structure, including the
external cavity wall fireplace recess.
In areas of severe or very severe exposure, and where the chimney breast is gathered in, the lower projecting masonry should be
protected against damp penetration with a suitable capping and cavity trays (see Clause 6.8.28b).
Above the roof:
chimney DPCs should link with flashings; where the roof is
face brickwork should not have recessed joints
steeply pitched (where the difference in level between the where lead trays are in contact with mortar, they should be
lower and higher intersection of the chimney with the roof will protected with a thick coat of bitumen or bitumen paint
be more than 450mm) two DPCs should be used at where chimneys are to be rendered, render should be in
suitable levels accordance with Chapter 6.11 Render.
plastic DPCs are not suitable
Outlet position
The flue will generally functionmore effectively where the outlet A B C D
is in a low pressure zone, taking account of prevailing winds.
A low pressure zone generally occurs:
on the lee side and at the ridge of a pitchedroof
close to the windward side of a flat roof.
Terminals
Terminals should be:
purpose-made components
sealed to the flue liner.
built into the top of the masonry to a minimum of 125mm or
Chimney cappings
Chimney cappings should:
be weathered, monolithic slabs
6.8
min.
50mm
Back boilers
Hearths for back boilers should beconstructed of solid non-combustible materials, a minimum of:
125mm thick, or
25mm thick and placed on non-combustiblesupports which
are a minimum of 25mm high.
1.8m max.
6.8
Flues and flue liners
Flue blocks for use with gas appliancesshould comply with BS1289-1 (Concrete) or Part 2 (Clay).
Table 4: Gas flue sizes
Serving Minimum flue size
Non fan-assisted Gas fire Either:
individually flued gas acircular flue with a minimum 12000mm2 cross-sectional area
burning appliances up (125mm diameter), or
to 70kW input, excluding a rectangular flue with a minimum 16,500mm2 cross-sectional
balanced flue area and a minimum dimension of 90mm
Any other At least the cross-sectional area of the outlet from the appliance
Inset live or decorative Open fire within a fireplace Either a circular or rectangular flue with a minimum dimension
gas fuel effect appliances opening up to 500mm x 550mm of 175mm
Flue liners should comply with BS 715 or be as described in Clause 6.8.6. Flexible flue liners are notacceptable in a new build.
Chimneys
Chimneys for gas appliances must notincorporate an adjustable draught control.
Masonry chimneys
Flues within masonry chimneys should be in accordance with the requirements relevant to flues for solid fuel appliances
(see Clause 6.8.6b).
Brickwork or blockwork chimneys for gas appliances should, at minimum, have the same level of fireresistance as each
compartment wall or floor which it forms part of, or passes through. The compartment wall may form the chimney wall where it is a
masonry material.
Gas flue blocks are at least 140mm wide. Where this is wider
than the wall leaf: ridge tile adaptor
vertical DPM
with BS 6461, or
6.8
H From an internal or external corner, or to a 600 300 (3)
200
boundary alongside the terminal(2)
I Above ground, roof or balcony level 300 300 (3)
300
J From a surface or a boundary facing the 600 600 (3)
600
terminal(2)
K From a terminal facing the terminal 600 1200 (3)
1200
L From an opening in the car port into the 1200 1200 (3)
1200
building
M Vertically from a terminal on the same wall 1200 1500 (3)
1500
N Horizontally from a terminal on the same wall 300 300 (3)
300
P From a structure on the roof N/A N/A 1500 (for a ridge terminal) N/A
2000 (for any other terminal,
as given in BS 5440-1)
Q Above the highest point of intersection with N/A Site in accordance Site in accordance with 150
the roof with manufacturers BS 5440-1:2000
instructions
Notes
1 An opening here means an openable element, such as an openable window, or a fixed opening, such as an air vent. However, in addition, the 1 outlet should not be
nearer than 150mm (fanned draught) or 300mm (natural draught) to an opening into the building fabric formed for the purpose of accommodating a built-in element,
such as a window frame.
2 Boundary as defined in paragraph 0.4. of Approved Document J: smaller separations to the boundary may be acceptable for appliances that 2 have been shown to
operate safely with such separations from surfaces adjacent to, or opposite, the flue outlet.
3 Should not be used.
4 This dimension may be reduced to 75mm for appliances of up to 5kW input (net).
Where a flue outlet is not serving a balanced flue appliance, it should be:
situated at roof level, so that air canpass freely across it
fitted with a flue terminal where the flue diameter is less than
at all times 170mm (larger diameter flues should be fitted with a terminal
a minimum of 600mm from openings
where required by Building Regulations).
600mm P
600mm
Q
Q
Q 2000mm
D,E
N
B
I
M
C
boundary
F A
J H H
K
H L I
G
Precautions should be taken, where appropriate, to prevent damp penetration in accordance with the requirements for resistance to
frost attack and weathering for solid fuel appliances (see Clause 6.8.6).
Balanced flues which bridge the cavity of an external wall should have a means of preventing moisture crossing the cavity,
e.g. a moisture drip collar set in the centre of the cavity.
appliance appliance
6.8
have a free area which is at least the same size as the outlet
where possible, be vertical (where this cannot be achieved,
of the appliance there should be no more than two bends, which should not
be more than 45 from vertical).
Factory-made insulated chimneys should:
be designed in accordance with BS 4543 : Part 1 to
have a minimum operating life of 30 years
Part 3 and BS EN 1859 and installed in accordance with where they are part of a component system, comply with
BS 7566 : Part 2, or be assessed inaccordance with BS 715 and installed in accordance with BS 5440.
Technical Requirement R3
Flue liners
As for gas flue pipes where the flue gases are unlikely to exceed a temperature of 250C (see Clause 6.8.10). As for solid fuel flue
pipes where the flue gases are likely to exceed a temperature of 250C or the temperature is not known (see Clause 6.8.5).
Flexible flue liners are notacceptable for new build.
Resistance to weather
Resistance to weather as for solid fuel (see clause 6.8.6).
F From an external or internal corner, or from a surface or boundary alongside the terminal 300
G Above ground or balcony level 300
H From a surface or boundary facing the terminal 600
J From a terminal facing the terminal 1200
K Vertically from a terminal on the same wall 1500
L Horizontally from a terminal on the same wall 750
M Above the highest point of an intersection with the roof 600(6) 1000(5)
N From a vertical structure to the side of the terminal 750 (6)
2300
O Above a vertical structure which is less than 750mm (pressure jet burner) or 2,300mm 600(6) 1000(5)
(vaporising burner) horizontally from the side of the terminal
P From a ridge terminal to a vertical structure on the roof 1500 Should not be used
Notes
1 Terminals should only be positioned on walls where appliances have been approved for such configurations when tested in accordance with BS EN 303-1
or OFTEC standards OFS A100 or OFS A101.
2 An opening means an openable element, such as an openable window, or a permanently open air vent.
3 Not withstanding the dimensions above, a terminal should be at least 300mm from 3 combustible material, e.g. a window frame.
4 To provide protection to combustible material, fit a heat shield at least 4 750mm wide.
5 Where a terminal is used with a vaporising burner, the terminal should be at least 2.3m horizontally from the roof.
6 Outlets for vertical balanced flues in locations M, N and O should be in accordance with 6 manufacturers instructions.
at least 50mm.
with water).
100mm
min.
50mm min.
internal wall
external wall
6.8
vermiculite
concrete
approx.
1.1m
690mm-840mm 350mm
690mm-840mm 350mm
appliance recess with raft lintel: fire place recess for inset open fire (without boiler unit)
suitable for free-standing room heater
Fixings should be of durable material and be appropriate for the type of surround and the supporting wall or floor to which the
surround is to be fixed. Fixings should generally be of stainless steel to BS EN ISO 3506 Mechanical properties of
corrosion-resistant stainless steel fasteners and be specified to provide suitable strength and durability. Materials that
comply with recognised standards which provide equal or better performance are also acceptable.
Methods that rely solely on adhesive for fixing fireplace surrounds to the structure are not acceptable.
More information on the installation of all types of natural and artificial stone fireplace surrounds can be found in the Stone
Federation Great Britain Fireplace Surrounds data sheet (www.stonefed.org.uk).
reinforced concrete
raft lintel
non-combustible rope
fireplace surround
clamping ring
bend
Liners suitable for solid fuel appliances, and generally suitable for other fuels,include liners whose performance is at least equal to
the designation T450 N2 S D 3, as described in BS EN 1443: 1999, such as:
clay flue liners with rebates or sockets for jointing meeting
other products that are independently assessed in
the requirements for class A1 N2 or class A1 N1 as accordance with Technical Requirement R3.
described in BS EN 1457
concrete flue liners meeting the requirements for the
6.8
Flues shall besuitable for their purpose and adequately separated from combustible materials.
Flues should be:
suitable for the type and size of appliance which they serve
tested in accordance with this chapter.
constructed in accordance with the design and the
manufacturers recommendations
This does not apply to a floorboard, skirting, dado or picture rail, mantel shelfor architrave.
Twin wall flue systems should comply with:
BS 715, or
be assessed in accordance withTechnical Requirement R3.
Construction of chimneys
Masonry chimneys should be properlybonded to, or supported by, the adjoining wallsof the building.
Foundations to a chimney should:
bethe same depth as adjacent wall foundations
where the chimney forms part of the wall, be a minimum of
bedesigned to avoid uneven settlement
100mmwider than the chimney base.
W W
Chimneys which:
are of block, brick or stone shouldhave a minimum wall
form part of a compartment wall, and are not back to back
thickness of 100mm,excluding the lining thickness with an adjacent chimney, should have a minimum wall
are built in a cavity separating wallshould form two leaves,
thickness of 200mm separating it from the other building
each a minimum of 100mm, between the flue and or home.
adjoining building
Factory-made insulated chimneysshould be assembled, erected, anchoredand protected in accordance withthe
manufacturers instructions.
6.8
100mm
min. plan of chimney at upper floor level
plan of recess
Timber chimney frame construction External chimney breast with masonry inner leaf
40mm min. air space where
chimney is less than 200mm
cavity maintained
around chimney
with cavity wall hearth min.
ties as required 125mm thick
joists on hangers
In Scotland, joists, etc. should be min. 200mm from the inner surface
of the flue; brickwork or blockwork in chimney construction should
be min. 100mm thick with a min. density of 1 600 kg/m3; for brick capping see Detail B
aircrete blocks should be min. 150mm thick.
6.8
cavity
cavity tray
prefabricated
throating
see Detail A
Other alternatives may be suitable, provided they meet the appropriateperformance standards.
cover flashing
saddle overlapping back
flashing gutter flashing
stepped flashing
turned in at joints one-piece tray
(min. 25mm) turned down on
cover flashing tray turned four sides
overlapping back up at two sides stepped side
gutter flashing flashing
DPC at front
apron level
turned up apron
at three sides flashing
chimney stack at ridge
Masonry 6.8.24
Masonry shall be capable ofsupporting intended loads and haveappropriate resistance to the adverseeffects
of frost and sulfates.
Masonry, including bricks, blocks, stone for masonry and reconstructed stone, should:
be in accordancewith BS 6461 and BS EN 771
where blocks are used, have a minimum block density of
where clay bricks are used in external chimney stacks,
1500 kg/m3 unless designed by an engineer in accordance
be of durability rating F2,S1 (asdescribed in BS EN 771) or with Technical Requirement R5.
protected bya projecting capping
6.8
InScotland:
frost-resistant bricks should beused for all external
where 100mm blocks are used for chimney construction,
facing brickwork they should have aminimum density of 1,500 kg/m3.
DPC 6.8.26
Materials for damp-proofing shall adequately resist the passage ofmoisture into the building.
The following are acceptable for use as DPCs:
Bitumen to BS 6398.
Proprietary materials assessed in accordance with
Polyethylene to BS 6515 (not to be used in the chimney
Technical Requirement R3.
stack above roof level).
Flashings 6.8.27
Flashings and trays shall becapable of adequately resisting theentry of moisture into the building.
Suitable materials for flashings and trays include:
milled sheet lead (minimum code 4)to BS EN 12588
zinc alloy complying to BS 6561 and0.6mm thick.
aluminium and aluminium alloysto BS 1470
(0.6-0.9mm thick)
Terminals 6.8.28
Flue terminals shall be suitablefor their purpose and assist thefunctioning of the flue. Issues to be taken into
account include:
a) draught improvement
b) chimney capping.
Relevant standards for flue terminals
BS 1181 Terminals in clay flue pipes
BS EN 1858 Terminals in chimneys serving gas appliances
BS 715 Terminals in flue pipes for gas appliances
flaunching
purpose-made
chimney cappings
freeze-/thaw-
resistant
min. (F2,S1) bricks
50mm
chimney pot
chimney details with brick capping
6.8
The terminal of a masonry flue should be jointed to the flue lining with cementmortar to form a seal.
Draught improvement
Where downdraughts may occur, terminals designed to increase updraught should be fitted. However, a terminal will not
overcome problems caused by high pressure zones. Where relevant, the Solid Fuel Association or other authoritative body
should be consulted.
Chimney capping
Where a chimney is to be capped:
a single unjointed concrete or stone capping should be used
the slab should project 50mm beyond the sides of the
it should project andbe throated to cast water away from the
chimney, and the withes between flues should be carried to
face of the chimney the underside of the slab.
Decorative brick cappings should becarefully constructed to avoid rainpenetration and frost damage. The use of frost-resistant
bricks may be required.
In Scotland, bricks used for facing brickwork should be frost-resistant.
6.9.1 Compliance 03
6.9.2 Provision of information 03
6.9.3 Certification 03
6.9.4 Loads 03
6.9.5 Support and fixings 04
6.9.6 Durability 05
6.9.7 Interfaces 05
6.9.8 Insulation 05
6.9.9 Damp proofing and vapour control 06
6.9.10 Installation, and tolerances 07
6.9.11 Electrical continuity and earth bonding 07
6.9.12 Maintenance 07
6.9.13 Glazing, gaskets and sealants 08
6.9.14 Cavity barriers andfirestops 08
6.9.15 Ventilation screens 08
6.9.16 Handling and storage 08
6.9.17 Curtain walling 09
6.9.18 Rainscreen cladding 11
6.9.19 Insulated render and brick slip cladding 12
Introduction
This chapter gives guidance on the forms of curtain walling and cladding acceptable to NHBC. Curtain walling and
cladding systems that do not conform to the descriptions in this chapter will not generally be acceptable.
Conservatories are not covered by this chapter.
Guidance on the use of other types of cladding, including brickwork, rendered masonry, vertical tile and slate cladding and
timber cladding, is given in Chapter 6.1 External masonry walls and Chapter 6.2 External timber framed walls.
Curtain walling 3D
Comprising a prefabricated or site assembled support framework
with infill panels and/or wallsections with glazing systems
whichinclude:
structural silicone glazing
mechanically fixed structural glazing
slope glazing, excluding patent glazing
coupled door and window frame assemblies
(including spandrel panels) which are one storey or more
in height, or not contained between a floor and ceiling.
Rainscreen cladding 3D
Comprising:
an outer skin of panels which have unsealed, open, baffled or
labyrinth (rebated) joints
a minimum 50mm pressure equalised air gap between the
insulation and the panels
an insulated and airtight backing wall.
6.9
Insulated render 3D
Comprising insulated render systems fixed to a backing wall.
6.9
In-service performance The manner or quality of functioning of a material, product or system.
Insulated render A cladding system applied externally to an insulating layer which is fixed to a backing wall.
system
Interstitial Condensation caused by vapour from within the buildingcondensing on colder surfaces within the
condensation wall construction, often occurring due to a cold bridge.
Negative pressure Where the air pressure on the internal face of the system is greater than that on theexternal face.
Positive pressure Where the air pressure on the external face of the system is greater than that onthe internal face.
Primary components Componentsand parts of the system that are not easily replaceable. These may include:
claddingpanels insulation
fixings vapour controllayers
framing weathering components.
Pressure equalisation The creation of an air cushion within the cavity to reduce the amount of water passing through the
joints of a rainscreen. Compartmentation and adequately large joints are required to achieve
pressure equalisation.
Rainscreen The part of the assembly, generally the outermost, that prevents the majority ofrain from penetrating
the wall. Some water may pass through the jointsof a rainscreen, but this should be limited by
appropriate detailing of open joints or the provision of baffled orlabyrinth joints.
Rainscreen cladding A faade that provides a barrier to wind and rain and which typically includes a vapour control layer,
system air barrier, supporting framework and fixings, insulation, breather membrane, cavity/air gap
and cladding panels. Traditional tile hanging and timber cladding are not classed as rainscreen
claddingsystems under the definitions of this chapter.
Replaceable Those which are readily replaceable without compromising the design and durability of the building
components or the need for progressive dismantling of the envelope. Where this cannot be achieved, components
should be designed as primary components. A method statement should be provided to demonstrate
how components will be replaced with specific reference to accessibility as detailed in this chapter.
Secondary components Components and parts of the systemthat are easily replaceable. These may include:
cladding panels internal linings
external finishes seals and sealant
glazing and gaskets window and door furniture.
Separating floors Floors and walls designed to provide separation between homes.
and walls
Slope glazing A drained and ventilated sloped roofingsystem.
Systems For the purposes of this chapter, this term refers to acceptable forms of curtain walling,
rainscreen cladding, insulated render systems and brick slip cladding systems.
Spandrel panel A panel used in place of glazing units to hide the edges of floor slabs, ceiling details, insulation, and
other building elements.
Test pressure The pressure at which testing is conducted.
Vapour control layer A layer used to restrict the passage of water vapour into the construction to reduce the risk of
interstitial condensation.
Certification 6.9.3
6.9
Curtain walling and cladding systems shall be adequately tested, certified and designed in accordance with
appropriate standards.
Curtain walling and cladding systems should have certification confirming satisfactory assessment, undertaken by an independent
technical authority. Where applicable, certification should be in accordance with CWCT Standard for systemised building envelopes
(or a suitable alternative acceptable to NHBC). Independent technical approvals authorities acceptable to NHBC include:
British Board of Agrment (BBA)
certification bodies considered by NHBC to be a
Building Research Establishment (BRE), or
suitable alternative.
Loads 6.9.4
Curtain walling and cladding systems, including brackets and fixings, shall allow movement without causing
damage or deformation, and safely transfer loads to the building.
Dead loads and live loads should:
be transferredsafely to the buildings structure
be calculated in accordance with BS EN 1991-1-1 and
without undue permanent deformation or deflection of BS EN 1991-1-4, and take account of internal and external
any component pressures, the location, shape and size of the building.
The following should be accommodated without any reduction inperformance:
Thermal-induced loads due to differential stresses caused by
Stresses in componentsand materials (these should not
temperature gradients within materials or components. exceed the permissible values recommended by the
product manufacturer).
Movement within the curtain walling or cladding.
appropriate plastics
Mechanically fixed systems should be in accordance with themanufacturers recommendations, and fixings should:
have the correct embedding, spacing and edgedistances
have suitable locking nuts andwashers.
be installed to the correct torque settings
6.9
with BS EN ISO 12944 or BS EN ISO 14713
Materials that comply with recognisedstandards and which provide equal or betterperformance to those above will generally be
acceptable to NHBC.
Pull-out or destructive testing of anchorsand fixings should:
comply with BS 5080
be carried out inaccordance with the design
comply with the Construction Fixings AssociationGuidance
carried out at a frequency agreed withNHBC.
Note Procedure for Site TestingConstruction Fixings
Interfaces 6.9.7
Curtain walling and cladding systems shall have suitable interfaces and resist the penetration of water
and wind.
The design should indicate the contractor responsible for constructing interfaces.
Interfaces, including those between curtain walling and cladding systems, and those between curtain walling and cladding systems
and other elements of the building (e.g. walls, roof, doors and windows), should be carefully designed and detailed to be weather
resistant, and prevent moisture reaching parts of the wall that it could adversely affect.
The design should take account of:
differing profile characteristics
tolerances and deviation
movement
the erection sequence
continuity of insulation, vapour barriersand
planned maintenance.
breather membranes
Insulation 6.9.8
6.9
Reference should be made to BRE document BR135 2003 Fire performance of external thermal insulation for walls of multi-storey
buildings when specifying the type of insulation system to be installed.
Rainscreen cladding
The backing wall should be adequately insulated, particularly at exposed areas. Where open joints are used, a continuous and
durable breather membrane should be providedover the outer face of the insulation.
Where the insulation is fixed to the backing wall, a minimum of one non-combustible fixing per 1m2 or per insulation batt,
whichever is the lesser, should be provided in addition to the other fixings.
Insulated render
A minimum of one non-combustible fixing per 1m2 or per
insulation batt, whichever provides the greater number,
should be provided in addition to the other fixings.
Non-combustible fixings shouldbe fixed through the
each layer cut
mesh reinforcement. to fit neatly
around flue outlet
Insulation should be suitable to receive the
render finish, and keyed where appropriate.
6.9
Brick slip cladding
Where the insulation is fixed to the backing wall, a minimum
of one non-combustible fixing per 1m2 or per insulation batt,
whichever is the lesser, should be provided in addition to the
other fixings.
Flashings
The following materials are acceptable as flashings:
BS EN 12588 rolled lead sheet (minimum Code 4).
BS EN 988 zinc alloys.
BS EN 485 and BS EN 573 aluminium and aluminium alloys.
Stainless steel.
Breather membranes
Breather membranes should:
comply with BS 4016
be in accordance withTechnical Requirement R3.
(Type 1 in areas of very severe exposure), or
Installation
Systems should be installed by operativeswho:
are competent
hold a certificate confirming that theyhave been trained by
are familiar with the system beinginstalled
the systemmanufacturer, supplier or installer.
6.9
Tolerances
Systems should be completed, within reasonable tolerances, in accordance with the design, and allowing for the line, level, plumb
and plane of the completed wall to be within reasonable tolerances for the materials involved.
Maintenance 6.9.12
Curtain walling and cladding systems shall have appropriate access arrangements for the purposes
of cleaning, inspection, maintenance and repair.
Provision should be made for safe future access to the faade. Access should generally be provided from a safe working platform,
such as a cradle or mobile elevating platform.
Appropriate arrangements should be made for the replacement of failed insulating glass units without incurring excessive costs for
gaining access.
6.9
in accordance with the design
atpenetrations through the cladding.
at the topand bottom of the rainscreen
Acoustic performance
Noise from the curtain walling systemcaused by loads, movements and changesin the environmental conditions should be
accommodated without being intrusive.
The curtain walling system should be designed to resist the passage of airborneand impact sound within the building. To reduce
flanking transmission, precautions may be required at the:
edges of separating floors
outer ends of partition walls
outer ends of separating walls
junctions with roof constructionsand parapets.
Weather resistance
Curtain walling systems should have: Figure 1: Curtain walling to insulated render system:
external and internal air and water seals with a drained and
horizontal section
ventilated cavity at each interface
3D internal DPC/DPM
drained and ventilated glazing rebates including gaskets
and seals. internal seal
external seal
Figure 2: Curtain walling to balcony/terrace: vertical section Figure 3: Curtain walling to conventional brick and block wall:
horizontal section
internal seal
internal DPC/DPM
DPC/DPM external
DPC/DPM
linked to
roofing
membrane external
seal
roofing
membrane
Figure 4: Curtain walling to soffit: vertical section Figure 5: Curtain walling to roof, includingcoping detail:
vertical section
Air infiltration
Curtain walling systems should be sealed with preformed
factory-moulded pictureframe type vulcanised EPDM or
picture frame
siliconeinternal gaskets. Gaskets and sealants should: gasket
6.9
comply with BS 6213 and be used in accordance with
typical profile
manufacturersrecommendations.
Particular attention should be given to the interfaces between
the curtain walling system and the walls, roof, doors,
windows and cladding system.
Off-site testing
Air and water testing of the prototype curtain walling system should be carried out in accordance with, and pass, the CWCT
Standard (test sequence A or B), when tested at a test pressure of 600 pascals. Panels tested should be of a similar size and
configuration to those to be used on the building.
Where the maximum calculated design wind pressure is above 2400 pascals, the test pressure should be increased to 0.25 x the
design wind pressure.
The prototype should remain watertight during and after the test.
At a test pressure of 600 pascals, an air infiltration rate no higher than 1.5m3/hr/m2 for fixed glazed panels is permissible,
provided there is no evidence of concentrated leakage.
Wind resistance, serviceability and safety testing should be carried out in accordance with the CWCT Standard.
Site testing
Site testing should:
be conducted to determine resistance to water penetration,
ensure a minimum of 5% of the completed curtainwalling
including joints and interfaces which are intended to be system is tested, especially in vulnerable areas suchas
permanently closed andwatertight joints and interfaces.
ensure a representative sample of the finished installation is
hose tested in accordance with the current CWCT Standard
for curtain walling
Other testing may be acceptable where itis considered to be a suitablealternative by NHBC.
The results of the test should be made available to NHBC.
Acoustic performance
Noise from the rainscreen cladding systemcaused by rain striking the outer surface ofpanels should be accommodated without
being intrusive through the use of material that is:
noise absorbing, or anti-drumming.
Weather resistance
6.9
To ensure moisture is directed to the outside, DPC/DPM arrangements should be correctly formed with suitable upstands and stop
ends, including at the junction between the rainscreen cladding and any other component or system. External and internal air and
water seals and a drained cavity should be provided at all interfaces.
The air gap between the face of theinsulation and the back of the panels should be of sufficient width and have suitably sized
drainage, allowing any water passing the joints to:
rundown the back of the rainscreen panels
be discharged externally withoutwetting the insulation or the
backing wall.
Free drainage
Air gaps should be adequately ventilated and the following
minimum widthsmaintained behind all rainscreen panels:
10mm
50mm for panels with open joints, or
10mm min. 10mm
min. min.
38mm for panels with baffled or labyrinth(rebated) joints.
Open, baffled or labyrinth (rebated)joints should have a
minimum 10mm opening, unless specified otherwise.
open joint baffled joint labyrinth (rebated)
joint
Thermal bridging and condensation
The system should:
be designed to minimise the risk of thermalbridging,
generally include a vapour control layer fixed to the warm
surface and interstitial condensation side of the wall insulation.
be assessed using a BS 5250 condensation risk analysis
Air infiltration
Before installation of the system, the backing wall should be reasonably airtight with:
masonry walls jointed to a high standard, i.e. each joint filled
framed walls, including a rigid sheathing onthe cavity face,
with each joint taped or sealed.
Where reasonable airtightness cannot be achieved:
a separate continuous vapour permeable air barrier should
joints should be taped or sealed.
be provided on the outer face of the backing wall
Compartmentation
Rainscreen cladding systems that have open joints between the
1.5m max.
panels should be designed to be pressure equalised. The cavity
should be compartmented by: 6.0m max.
The NHBC Standard for compartmentation is in additionto building regulations (to controlthe spread of smoke and fire), but may be
used for the same purpose.
Cavity closers should:
be rigid and installed in accordance with the
enable ventilation and drainage to be maintained in
manufacturers recommendations accordance with the design.
Certification
Rainscreen cladding systems, including panels, should have current certification confirming satisfactory assessment by an
appropriate independent technical approvals authority accepted by NHBC.
6.9
Site testing
On-site hose or sparge bar testing shouldbe carried out with emphasison interfaces that are designed to bepermanently closed
and watertight.
The building should remain watertightduring and after the test.
Insulated render and brick slip cladding 6.9.19 Also see: Chapter 6.2
Insulated render and brick slip cladding shall be designed and installed to ensure adequate
in-service performance. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) weather resistance
b) thermal bridging and condensation
c) air infiltration
d) insulated render: reinforcement and render
e) brick slip cladding: slips, carriers and joints.
Weather resistance
Timber and steel framed backing walls should have a cavity 15mm min. drained 15mm min.
and vented cavity drained cavity
between the wall and the insulation which is:
a minimum of 15mm wide
drained and ventilated (for timber frame)
drained (for steel frame).
A cavity can increase the risk of damage from impact, especially
at low level, around balconies and where cradle systems etc.
can come into contact with the faade. Suitable precautions to
resist impact damageshould be provided e.g. by the provision of
a rigid board behind theinsulation whilst maintaining the cavity.
timber frame steel frame
The following illustrations show typical interfaces and general design principles:
Figure 6: Insulated render system to Figure 7: Penetration of gas flue through Figure 8: Brick slip cladding to
windows and doors: insulated render system on insulated render system:
horizontal section light gauge steel frame: horizontal section
horizontal section
internal seal
external
seal
DPC/DPM
external
seal
external
seal
6.9
external seal
Air infiltration
Before installation of the system, the backing wall should be reasonably airtight with:
masonry walls jointed to a high standard,i.e. each joint filled
each joint taped or sealed on framed walls, including a rigid
sheathing on the cavity face.
manufacturers recommendations
be formed with appropriate trim at openings, corners, angles,
reinforcement continuous
across face of insulation
Render should:
not be applied where the surface has contamination,
be mixed to ensure colour consistency where coloured
dust or loose particles pigments are specified
have the appropriate number and thickness ofcoats in
be specified and used with the appropriate trims to form
accordance with the manufacturersrecommendations corners, returns and features in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
6.9
brick slips is avoided, i.e. in the storey heights, at corners and
around openings
have coursing arranged to suit lintel heights.
Mortars, proprietary mortars and groutsshould be specified: insulation (carrier) neatly cut
around openings and positioned
to enable each joint to be adequately filled and
to avoid excess cutting of slips
appropriately struck
in accordance with the system
manufacturers recommendations.
6.10.1 Compliance 01
6.10.2 Provision of information 01
6.10.3 Certification 01
6.10.4 Load-bearing walls and floors 02
6.10.5 Control of fire 04
6.10.6 Acoustic performance 05
6.10.7 Steel and fixings 05
6.10.8 Detailing of steel joists 06
6.10.9 Restraint 08
6.10.10 Fixing floor decking and ceilings 08
6.10.11 Moisture control 08
6.10.12 Insulation 09
6.10.13 Vapour control layers 10
6.10.14 Breather membranes 10
6.10.15 Construction of load-bearing walls
and external infill walls 10
6.10.16 Construction of non load-bearing walls 11
6.10.17 Panels, cladding and boards 12
6.10.18 Wall tiles 13
6.10.19 Services 13
6.10.20 Further information 13
Where there are choices (e.g. types of claddings), the manufacturer will need to specify which options the SCI is to consider in
its assessment. Upon satisfactory completion, SCI will approve themanufacturers system manual and issue a numbered
system certificate which includes:
a detailed description of the system
information for reference by the designer and steel frame
details of usage limitations
project certifier.
6.10
Load-bearing walls and floors 6.10.4
Walls and floors shall be designed to support and transferloads safely and without undue movement.
Issues to be taken into account include:
a) structural walls c) structural floors.
b) resistance to racking forces
Structural walls
The structural design of the building should ensure adequate resistance toloadings including dead loads, imposed loads, wind loads
and snow loads, in accordance with:
BS EN 1991-1-1
BS EN 1991-1-4.
BS EN 1991-1-3
fully transferred.
At openings, additional studs may be required to provide support
or fixing points for cladding, and wall linings.
Multiple studs should be included tosupport multiple joists,
unless otherwisespecified by the designer.
Where panels are diagonally braced witha flat strip, the brace should be fixed to each stud atthe intersection to minimise bowing in
thebracing member.
Account should be taken of uplift forces, and proper holding-downdevices should be provided to resist uplift where necessary.
The anchorage for holding-down devices should have sufficient mass to resist theuplift forces (See Clause 6.10.15).
Timber wall plates should be:
fixed to thehead rail of wall panels onto which timberroof
sized (including the head rail), to permit singletimber trusses
trusses bear to be positioned at anypoint between studs.
Movement joints should:
preventload transfer onto a chimney or flue (a joint should
not be bridged by non load-bearing walls.
be constructed between the frame and any chimney or flue)
Floors should:
be designed to resist loading in accordance with
have a maximum joist spacing of 600mm centres
BS EN 1991-1-1 have suitably sized trimmers around floor openings.
Light steel joists should be fixed tosupporting walls by either:
web cleats
bearing onto the supporting structure (bearing stiffeners may
direct attachment to wall studs, or
be required).
The in-service performance of light steel joists should be controlled by the following fourserviceability criteria.
Static criteria for the maximum permissible deflection of a single joistdue to:
imposed load, limited to(span/450).
dead and imposed loads, limited to the lesser of (span/350)
or 15mm.
Dynamic criteria:
The natural frequency of the floorshould be limited to 8Hz
The deflection of the floor (i.e. a series of joists plus the floor
for dead load plus 0.2 x imposed load. This can be achieved decking) when subject to a 1kN point load should belimited
by limiting the deflection of asingle joist to 5mm for the to the values in Table 2.
given loading.
Table 2: Deflection with point loads of 1kN
Span (m) Maximum deflection (mm)
3.5 1.7
3.8 1.6
4.2 1.5
4.6 1.4
5.3 1.3
6.2 1.2
6.10
a) walls, floors and ceilings
b) cavity barriers and fire stops
c) materials suitable for fire stopping.
minimum upstand, or
Steel grade
Steel should be grade:
S280 to BS EN 10326
S390 steel with a nominal yield strength of 390N/mm2
S350 to BS EN 10326, or
(when compliant with BSEN 10326).
without the approval of the designer. Welded or flamecut edges should be cleaned and treated with a zinc-rich paint to
prevent corrosion.
The junction between the ground floor joists and their support should be designed to maintain the durability of the floor. Light steel
floor joists and ring beams in ground floors should be galvanised to 450g/m2. Alternatively, they can be galvanised to 275 g/m2
with additional protection of a two-coat bitumen based coating to BS 1070, BS 3416 or BS 6949, or have a two-coat liquid asphaltic
composition applied. Ring beams to ground floors should be totally protected, and joists protected for 300mm adjacent to an external
wall support or ring beam.
Holding-down devices
Holding-down devices should be suitable for the environment they will beexposed to, and manufactured from:
mild steel with zinccoating to BS 729 or BS 706
stainless steel to BS EN 10095
(suitable for most environments).
6.10
Steel joists, fixings and connections shall be suitably detailed and provide satisfactory performance. Issues to
be taken into account include:
a) installation details c) prevention of roll.
b) support cleats
Installation details
Joists should be:
spaced as shown in the design
joined with thecorrect type, size and number of fixings.
accurately cut to lengthin the factory to ensure a tight fit
Where light steel joists are supported bysteel joists, cleats or web stiffeners shouldbe used in accordance with the design.
Joists may be doubled up to supportpartitions or to form trimmers.
Ends of floor joists directly supported on walls should be stiffened. Continuous joists on load-bearing intermediate walls should be
reinforced as required by the design.
Support cleats
Joist support cleats should:
be of the correct type
use fixings as specified in the design.
be fitted in the specifiedlocation
Where required, web stiffeners should beproperly fitted.
Where joists are fitted directly to light steel wall studs, pre drilled holes should be correctly aligned before making the
final connection.
Fixing holes should not be enlarged, and additional holes should not be cut withoutpriorapproval of the designer.
Prevention of roll
Bridging and blocking should be provided in accordance with the
design to prevent roll.
Floors constructed using joists with an asymmetric web,
e.g. of C or Sigma profile, can cause the floor to roll. To avoid
roll, unless otherwise specified in the design, one of the following
alternatives should be used where the span exceeds 3.5m for
C joists, or 4.2m for Sigma joists:
A continuous line, or lines, of proprietary steel herringbone
struts provided between the joists. The pairs of strutsshould
have a physical gap between them so that they do not rub
against each other at the cross-over point and create noise.
Solid blocking provided to every third pair of joists with ties
between them.
Joists alternately reversed and tied together in pairs.
Joists alternately reversed and continuous ties
(e.g. resilient bar) fixed to the joist flanges.
Where joists bear onto steelwork or are supported by cleats,
blocking is not necessary adjacent to the supports.
Restraint 6.10.9
Restraint strapping shall be provided in accordance with the design.
Where external walls, not constructed from light steel framing, are to be stabilised by a connection to the floor, straps may
be required. Straps will generally be fixed to the web of the joist, to suit the masonry courses.
Where joists run parallel to the wall, straps should be supported on noggings fixed between the joists. Straps should be placed at a
maximum of 2m apart and carried over three joists. Packing should be provided between the wall and the first joist.
Straps should be fixed with suitable bolts, screws or rivets and should bear on the centre of bricks or blocks, not across
mortar joints.
Fixing floor decking and ceilings 6.10.10 Also see: Chapter 6.4
Floor decking and ceilings shall be adequately fixed using a material of adequate strength and
moisture resistance.
Joist spacing and decking thickness should be compatible. Material standards and minimum board thicknesses for domestic loads
(imposed load of1.5kN/m2) are shown in Table 5.
Table 5: Joist spacing and decking type
Material Standard Thickness of decking (mm)
400mm joist centres 600mm joist centres
Chipboard BS EN 312 moisture-resistant type P5 18 22
Plywood BS EN 636 15 18/19
Oriented strand board type OSB3 BS EN 300 15 18/19
Decking materials not listed should comply with Technical Requirement R3.
Oriented strand board should be laid with the stronger axis at right angles to the supports.
In England and Wales, the thicknesses listed above may not achieve the 15 kg/m2 mass required to meet sound
insulation requirements.
6.10
Fixings and supports should be as recommended by the manufacturer.
Flooring should be fixed at maximum 300mm centres using the following:
Self-drilling or self-tapping screws.
Other approved fixings.
Ring shank nails, or
In England and Wales, account should be taken of Accredited Construction Details for Part L.
6.10
adequately strong when wet to resistsite damage
Preparation
The following should be in accordance with the design:
The setting out of the structure onto which the light steel
frame is to be erected.
The transfer of loads from the light steel frame.
Shims should:
be of pre-galvanised steel
not be of plastic or timber.
Wall frames should be checked to ensure that they are dimensionally accurate before erection commences.
Light steel framing should be correctlypositioned, square and nominal line line of
of frame frame
plumb, and within the following tolerances:
The vertical position of members should be within +/-5mm per
storey relative to the base.
The horizontal position of base rails should not vary in
5mm max.
alignment by more than 5mm in 10m.
10m
Anchoring
The frame should be anchored to resistboth lateral movement and uplift in accordance with the design.
anchor fixed
to studs
6.10
chemical anchor
20 from vertical
anchor fixed
to studs
Noggings or straps should be providedas required to support fittings, such asradiators, wall-mounted boilers, sanitary fittings,
kitchen units, etc. Non load-bearing partitions should not be wedged against floor joists, ceiling joists or roof trusses.
Allowance should be made for the floor joists, ceiling joists or roof trusses to deflect so that the partition does not become
load-bearing. They should be:
constructed in accordance with the design
fixed to the floor at the head, to each other and to
correctly positioned, square and plumb
abutting walls
supported on a structural floor, but not a floating floor that
provided with extra studs at openings where required
incorporates a compressible layer, unless specifically finished in accordance with Chapter 9.2
designed for that purpose Wall and ceiling finishes.
channel fixed to
structure over
6.10
is not fully maintained, e.g. at cavity barriers every 1.5m
be kept clean, free ofobstructions and capable of
have drainage openings placed to prevent the ingress
draining freely of rain.
Services 6.10.19
6.10
6.11.1 Compliance 01
6.11.2 Provision of information 01
6.11.3 Weather conditions 02
6.11.4 Backgrounds 03
6.11.5 Accommodation of movement 03
6.11.6 Mixes 05
6.11.7 Detailing 07
6.11.8 Render onto board backgrounds 09
6.11.9 Finishes 11
Introduction
This chapter is arranged in sections covering:
site and factory-made render
render onto board backgrounds
detailing.
setting.
Table 1: Process chart for the application of site - and factory-made render to masonry backgrounds
Process Steps See clause
Structure design Identify a suitable background material compatible with the intended render finish and 6.11.4
consider any preparation requirements
Consider how movement will be controlled, i.e. are movement joints or bed joint 6.11.5
reinforcement needed?
Render design
Select an appropriate render strength that is compatible with the background 6.11.6
Determine the exposure zone which will influence the render's thickness 6.11.6
Construction Protect the background from adverse weather conditions at the earliest opportunity during 6.11.3
and following construction
Assess the likely weather conditions prior to and after rendering 6.11.3
Assess the background, e.g. suction and surface preparation, and apply a preparation coat 6.11.4
where necessary
Where the air temperature is at, below or likely to fall below 5C, appropriate precautions such as covering with a hessian sheet
should be used to protect curing render.
Factory-made render should be installed in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations for weather conditions.
Acrylic renders have different curing requirements which should be taken into account.
Backgrounds 6.11.4
Backgrounds shall be appropriate for their intended purpose and suitably prepared to receive render.
Issues to be taken into account include:
a) preparation of masonry backgrounds
b) preparation of clay brick backgrounds
c) ribbed metal lath.
To provide an appropriate bond, clay brick backgrounds with a water absorption rate of between 9% and 15% should generally have
sufficient suction to provide a mechanical key. Alternatively, when rendering onto bricks, one or more of the following methods of
improving the key can be adopted:
Keyed bricks used.
Mortar joints raked out to a depth of 10-12mm (although this
A spatterdash coat applied.
may increase curing time).
Render on an external leaf of clay bricks (F2,S1 or F1,S1 designation bricks to BS EN 771) in severe or very severe exposures is
not permitted where the cavity is to be fully filled with insulation.
Areas of the building to be rendered should be identified prior to construction, and movement control considered as part of
the design.
Where length/height ratios are greater than 3:1, consideration should be given to providing suitably designed:
movement joints, or
bed joint reinforcement.
Where movement joints are provided, they should: compressible filler
horizontal beads)
be made weathertight with an appropriate sealant
weathertight seal
not align with openings such as windows, doors or meter boxes.
external render
Bed joint reinforcement should be provided in the first two courses
of the external masonry leaf above and below any opening. Where
possible, the reinforcement should project 600mm beyond the
opening.
6.11
Ultra lightweight aggregate 3.6-7.3N/mm 2
<950kg/m3
Lightweight aggregate 3.6-7.3N/mm2 950-1500 kg/m3
Dense aggregate 7.3N/mm + 2
1,500kg/m3+
Notes:
1 The guidance in this table is generally acceptable for render coats in accordance with Table 5 and factory-made one-coat render based on 1:1:6 mix = 3.5N/mm.
2 Specialist advice from the block and render manufacturer should be sought.
3 Specialist advice should be sought where clay brick backgrounds are used.
Dissimilar materials
Backgrounds should not be constructed from materials of different
densities. Where possible, render should not be continuous
across dissimilar materials. Where this cannot be avoided the
render should:
be stopped at appropriately formed movement joints, or
Where significant differential movement is likely to occur, such as the junction between masonry and board backgrounds, render
should be stopped either side of an appropriately formed joint.
Render coats should not be stronger than the background or any previous coat to which they are applied. Weaker coats can be
achieved by reducing the cement content of each coat or by using the same mix but decreasing the coat thickness.
Potable water should be used for mixing render.
Sand
Sand for render should be well-graded category 2, in accordance with BS EN 13139. Sand with excessive fine material, clay or silt
can shrink and crack so should be avoided.
A sharp gritty or coarse sand is required for strength in the backing coats, but finer sand should be used for the finishing coat.
Typical sand grades should be:
5mm down to 0.075mm undercoat(s)
1.18mm down to 0.075mm final coat.
Mix design
6.11
Designation ii, iii and iv (strength class M6, M4 and M2) mixes are generally used for rendering.
Stronger mixes are generally more moisture resistant; however, they are also more prone to shrinkage, which increases the
likelihood of the render cracking. Weaker mixes may be appropriate for weaker backgrounds in less exposed zones.
For exposure zone classification, see Clause 6.1.6.
Notes:
1 With fine or poorly graded sands, the lower volume of sand should be used.
2 Where soluble salts could be present in the background, mixes should have sulfate-resisting properties.
3 Where pigments are specified, batching should be undertaken with care to ensure colour consistency pigments to BS EN 12878 can be used but should not exceed
10% of the cement weight, or 3% where carbon black is used (white Portland cement may be used).
6.11
Ultra lightweight and lightweight aggregate blockwork
Undercoat 8-12mm designation iii (M4)
Final coat 6-8mm designation iv (M2)(1)
Dense aggregate blockwork
Undercoat 8-12mm designation ii (M6)
Final coat 6-8mm designation iii (M4)
Clay brick
Undercoat 8-12mm designation ii (M6)
Final coat 6-8mm designation iii (M4)
Ribbed metal lath
First coat 8-12mm designation i (M12)
Undercoat 10-12mm designation ii (M6)
Final coat 6-8mm designation ii (M4)
Notes:
1 Designation iii (M4) should be used for the final coat in severe or very severe exposure zones.
2 For block classifications, see Table 2.
3 Specialist advice should be sought for low density aircrete backgrounds.
Where a three-coat render is used, this should include a second undercoat that is:
the same thickness but a slightly weaker mix than the first
a slightly thinner coat of the same strength mix.
undercoat, or
Surfaces should be appropriately prepared to receive following coats. This can be achieved by either combing or scratching.
The final coat should be applied to an undercoat that is suitably keyed.
The size of the background to be rendered should be assessed to determine if it can be rendered in the time available.
This will help to establish the most suitable location for day joints.
The final coat should be of uniform thickness and not used to even out irregularities, which should be accommodated in
previous coats.
Factory-made renders
Factory-made renders should be applied in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations, including those for ancillary
components.
Factory-made renders with a declared mix in accordance with Table 4, applied to the thickness recommended in Table 6, and that
otherwise comply with the recommendations for site-made renders, will generally be acceptable to NHBC.
Lime
Render mixes containing hydrated lime can improve the ability of the render to accommodate movement, improving resistance to
cracking and crazing. The use of lime should be in accordance with BS EN 459.
Natural hydraulic lime (NHL) is used without cement, which can allow greater moisture vapour movement through the structure.
6.11
Detailing 6.11.7
Rendering shall be detailed to ensure appropriate weathertightness and durability. Issues to be taken into
account include:
a) copings, cappings and sills e) exposed elements
b) abutments and interfaces f) ancillary items
c) weepholes g) render below the DPC
d) detailing at openings h) resistance to sulfate attack.
metal coping
throating clear plywood plate
DPC supported of the render
over cavity tray
40mm
optional render 40mm overhang
optional render
150mm 150mm
min. min.
weep holes weep holes
(max. spacing 1m) (max. spacing 1m)
render render
Weepholes
frame construction
to the last tray at stepped abutments
Detailing at openings
6.11
Design features around openings and at the head of the
external min. 12mm overlap to frame
rendering should provide shelter and help shed water away from
the surface below. window
sill
internal
Exposed elements
Render to exposed masonry elements, such as parapets, freestanding walls, pillars, retaining walls or chimneys, should be of a type
appropriate for severe exposure conditions.
When rendering both sides of freestanding or parapet walls of single leaf construction, care should be taken to prevent damage
caused by moisture becoming trapped. For example:
the detailing should prevent the masonry from becoming saturated
rendering both sides of single leaf walls in areas of very severe exposure to frost attack should be avoided (see Clause 6.1.6c).
Bricks with S1 or S0 designation are not recommended for exposed elements that are to be rendered.
Ancillary items
Stop beads and render stops should be austenitic stainless steel or PVC. Long runs of steel beads and stops should be avoided due
to their expansion potential.
Corner beads should have an appropriate projection to prevent thin tapering of the render which reduces the its overall thickness.
Beads should be:
adhesive-fixed using a material appropriate for external
mechanically fixed using suitably durable fixings.
use and in accordance with the manufacturers
recommendations, or
The system should be used in full accordance with the manufacturers guidance and recommendations.
Weather resistance
Timber and steel framed backing walls should have a minimum 25mm cavity.
Cavities to timber framed walls should be drained and vented, and cavities to steel framed walls should be drained.
To reduce the risk of damage from impact, especially at low level, where people have access around balconies and where cradle
systems etc. can come into contact with the faade, appropriate precautions such as closer supports should be considered.
Movement joints
Movement joints should be provided to accommodate movement in timber frame structures. Where board backgrounds are used,
movement joints should be:
6.11
formed in accordance with the system
manufacturers recommendations
continued through the background board
movement
provided at floor zones.
movement
across
floor zone
15mm*
15mm*
Board backgrounds
Board backgrounds to be rendered should be external grade and recommended for use in the render manufacturers system
manual.
Boards should be set out in accordance with the system manufacturers recommendations, taking account of possible compression,
deflection and alignment of joints in relation to openings in the external wall, such as windows and doors.
The render should have alkali-resistant mesh embedded into the base coat across the whole surface.
Edges of boards should be suitably treated to provide protection from weather during construction and to maintain durability after the
render is completed.
Finishes 6.11.9
Finishes shall be to a satisfactory standard. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) decorative finishes
b) appearance.
Decorative finishes
The choice of decorative finish should take account of :
the exposure zone
background movement potential.
Scraped or textured finishes can reduce the risk of crazing and can break up the drainage path of rain-water as it runs down the face
of the wall.
Wet dash and dry dash finishes should have an aggregate size generally between 6mm and 14mm. Dry dash should be applied to
the final coat before it has fully cured.
Appearance
Render on external walls should be reasonably consistent in texture, finish, colour and line. Clause 9.1.2b provides further guidance
on tolerances to render finishes.
6.11
Consideration should be given to detailing that will avoiding obvious staining (e.g. the positioning of discharge pipes).
Completed render should be protected from damage that could be caused by construction activities.
Render may not be resistant to staining and may require periodic maintenance such as cleaning.
7.1.1 Compliance 01
7.1.2 Provision of information 01
7.1.3 Flat roof and balcony design 01
7.1.4 Timber and timber decks 02
7.1.5 Profiled metal decks 04
7.1.6 Concrete decks 04
7.1.7 Thermal insulationand vapour control 05
7.1.8 Waterproofing and surface treatments 05
7.1.9 Green and proprietaryroofs 07
7.1.10 Detailing of flat roofs 09
7.1.11 Accessible thresholds 11
7.1.12 Drainage 12
7.1.13 Guarding to balconies 14
including treatments for durability and the position of the Details and fixing methods of balcony support and
vapour control layer, insulation andwaterproofing layers. guarding components.
deck
preservative treated or naturally durable, in accordance with
7.1
Maximum board width 100mm
Requirement R5.
Where holding-down straps are required to prevent the roof from lifting from thesupporting structure, they should be:
spaced at a maximum of 2m centres
fixed with the lowest fixing secured within 150mm of the
fixed with a minimum of four hardened nails 4mm in diameter
bottom of the vertical strap
x 75mm long, or No 12. wood screws x 50mm long, 30mm x 2.5mm and 1m long
into plugs (where fixed to masonry) predrilled for fixings.
gap between joist and
hanger is 6mm max.
min 4 screw
fixings per
no gap between strap
the hanger
and the wall
notched to keep
ceiling line level
Over 4.5 Equally spaced along the span at maximum 2.5m centres
fixed with two ring shank nails to each joist or firring, with nail
insulation
vapour control layer
profiled metal deck
plaster or
plasterboard profile width
7.1
Concrete decks 7.1.6
Concrete flat roofs and balconies shall form a satisfactorysubstrate for the waterproofing system.
Concrete flat roofs should be constructed to ensure they achieve therequired design, strength and durability, and be in accordance
with BS EN 1992-1-1 and Chapter 3.1 Concrete andits reinforcement.
In-situ reinforced concrete decks should:
be formed using a mix which has low
be protected until adequately cured and dried
shrinkage characteristics (permanent waterproofing should not be installed until the
have accurately constructed and suitably
deck has fully dried).
supported formwork surface
treatment waterproofing
Precast concrete decks should:
be installed on an even and true supporting structure
insulation
have a minimum 90mm bearing (unless the design specifies a
vapour control layer
smaller dimension) screed to falls
have allowance for continuity or anti-crack reinforcement
concrete deck
Thermal insulationand vapour control 7.1.7 Also see: BRE Report Thermal insulation: avoiding risks and BS 5250
Thermal insulation, vapour control and ventilation shall ensure satisfactory performance, and prevent the
formation of condensation which could adversely affect the construction.
Insulation should be:
bonded ormechanically fixed in accordance with
kept dry and installed in quantities which can be quickly
themanufacturers recommendations; where mechanically covered if it rains (to aid bondingand to avoid
fixed, it should be installed using fixings of sufficient length trapping moisture).
toensure adequate penetrationinto the supporting structure
Cold flat roofs are difficult to detail correctly but, where used, they should be in accordance with BS 5250 and have:
an effective vapour control layer atceiling level
adequate cross ventilation (openings at both ends of
an unobstructed 50mm ventilation space above
each joist void).
the insulation
Composite decks should: two continuous beads
of sealant beneath
have two beads of sealantalong each board joint at the foil
each board
ensure adequate
bearing area for
composite deck
sealed to thewaterproofing).
Installation of waterproofing
Prior to the waterproofing being installed:
the structure and receiving surface should be checked
the surface should be even and dry and nails should be
andapproved by the waterproofing contractor punched below the surface
the manufacturers recommendations for preparation,
the manufacturers recommendations for conditioning,
including priming upstands, roof outlets, etc. and unrolling in advance of laying, should be followed
should be followed to achieve a satisfactory bond with concrete and screed surfaces should be adequately dry.
the waterproofing
Waterproofing systems
Reinforced bitumen membrane
Reinforced bitumen membrane should be high performance and reinforced with polyester reinforcement, e.g. type 5U, 5B/180,
5E/250 to BS 747 (type 5 reinforced bitumen membranes are colour-coded blue for identification).
Table 3: Reinforced bitumen membrane used in warm roof construction
Insulation material First/preparatory layer Second layer/underlay Final layer/cap sheet
Rigid urethane foam Type 3G perforated layer S2P3 S5P5 with either integral mineral finish or
(RUF) boards (loose laid and lapped, to separate solar protection.
polyurethane (PU) and produce partial bonding). Elastomeric underlay Elastomeric capsheet achieving S2P3,
polyisocyanurate (PIR). achieving S2P3 mineral surfaced where exposed.
Compressed cork, rock S2P3 (fully bonded in S2P3 S5P5 with either integral mineral finish or
fibre or glass fibre accordance with separate solar protection.
7.1
boards, cellular glass BS 8217). Elastomeric underlay Elastomeric capsheet achieving S2P3,
slabs, perlite boards or achieving S2P3 mineral surfaced where exposed.
composite products.
Surface treatments
Surface treatments should be in accordance with Table 5.
Table 5: Surface treatments for flat roofs
Access for maintenance only roofs up to 10 Access roof, walkway or terrace deck
Reinforced bitumen
Mineral surfaced capsheets (e.g. type S5P5). Precast semi-porous concrete tiles bedded in
membranes Reflective stone chippings(1), bedded in a
bitumen or approved adhesive.
dressing compound. Precast concrete proprietary paving slabs on
A suitable thickness of washed, rounded 20-40mm
supports or sand/cement blinding(2).
shingle ballast laid loose. Proprietary timber decking systems(3).
Mastic asphalt Reflective stone chippings(1), bedded in a bitumen
Precast semi-porous concrete tiles bedded in
based compound. bitumen or approved adhesive.
A solar reflective paint approved by the MAC.
Precast concrete proprietary paving slabs on
supports or sand/cement blinding(2).
Thermoplastic Supplementary solar reflective coatings or other
Proprietary flexible, non-slip walkway sheets or
single-ply finishes not required. tiles, compatible with the membrane product.
membranes Where laid loose, membranes can be ballasted
Precast concrete proprietary paving slabs on
with a suitable thickness of washed, rounded adjustable supports or suitable non-woven
20-40mm shingle installed on a non-woven polymeric protection layer.
polymeric protection layer. Proprietary timber decking systems with bearers
set on an additional membrane or suitable
non-woven polymeric protection layer.
Cold applied liquid
Products generally do not require supplementary Proprietary surface treatments compatible with the
roofing membranes solar reflective coatings or other finishes. membrane product.
Proprietary flexible, non-slip walkway tiles,
compatible with the membrane product.
Precast concrete proprietary paving slabs on
supports on a suitable non-woven polymeric
protection layer.
Proprietary timber decking systems with bearers
set on additional pads on a suitable non-woven
polymeric protection layer.
Hot melt rubberised
Use in inverted/buried roof membrane applications or in roof garden/green roofs.
7.1
bitumen systems Must be protected with a substantial reinforced bitumen membrane protection sheet.
All upstands/details where the membrane becomes exposed need a protective membrane to be applied to
prevent UV degradation.
Notes
1 Loose surface finishes should be prevented from being removed by weather and discharged into gutters and drain pipes. Chippings shouldbe a minimum of 12.5mm
limestone or white spar, not pea gravel.
2 Cement/sand blinding should be installed on two layers of waterproof building paper or two layers of 1000 gauge polyethylene separatingmembrane.
Slabs should be kept back 75mm at perimeters and a 25mm movement gap incorporated for every 9m2 of paving.
3 Timber decking systems should only use compatible preservative treatments. The undersides of the bearers should have large, smoothcontact areas, with no sharp
edges or corners.
The complete green roof should be installed by a contractor trained and approved by the system supplier.
Waterproofing for green roofs should be either:
reinforced bitumen membrane
single-ply membrane, or
mastic asphalt
a liquid applied system.
The system should be installed in accordance with the design and the membrane manufacturers recommendations.
Before covering:
the membrane should be visually inspected and
7.1
weeding/planting.
Structure 20 maximum roof pitch, accounting for full
45 maximum roof pitch deck (profiled metal
weight of wet soil (generally supported by a decks may be an alternative to concrete,
concrete deck). depending on loadings).
Drainage falls 1:60min.
Moisture control Irrigation system may be required.
Can be designed to retainsome water in order to maintain the vegetation and to reduce run off.
Vapour control Fully bonded polyester-reinforced RBM (S2P3), a suitable self-adhesive membrane or torch-on membrane.
layer
Insulation Insulation material should have adequate compressive strength to withstand likely applied loads.
Where the insulation is above the weatherproofing, only extruded polystyrene (XPS) should be used.
Roots A root resistant element, such as a copper foil or Preventol treatment, is required above the
waterproofing membrane. Alternatively, an approved root resistant waterproofing membrane can be used.
Protection and A protection layer (or board) should be placed
In accordance with the
filter layers above the waterproofing membrane. manufacturers recommendations.
A filter layer should be placed above the
reservoir layer.
Concrete decks
Upstands Skirting to rooflights or ventilator kerb
Upstands may be fixed to the wall. Similar details apply to inverted roofs.
Upstands should be a minimum of 150mm high. Allow for thickness of ballast to achieve a minimum
Similar details apply to inverted roofs with concrete decks. 150mm upstand.
Preformed preformed
coping OSB or plywood kerb
(e.g.GRP) capping surface treatment
(where required)
min.
150mm
surface treatment
(where required) waterproof membrane
min. insulation
150mm
waterproof membrane screed
insulation
vapour control layer concrete deck
concrete deck
vapour control layer
upstand screed
metal flashing
Timber decks
Mansard edge Pitched roof abutment
Elements should be firmly fixed to prevent peelback
in high winds. battens, tiles/slates surface treatment
(where required)
surface treatment min.
(where required) 150mm
waterproof membrane
waterproof membrane vapour control layer
vapour control layer insulation
metal flashing
insulation
min.
min. 150mm
300mm waterproof membrane
insulation
vapour control layer
7.1
50mm
displacement by thermal expansion of rainwater pipe.
Similar details apply to concrete roofs.
surface treatment
(where required) vapour control
min. surface treatment layer turned back
mineral 150mm
surfaced (where required) over insulation
top layer to waterproof membrane
face of insulation waterproof
timber kerb vapour control layer membrane
50 x 50mm
triangular fillet
Note
The drainage layer is not necessarily the waterproofing layer (i.e. the top of the insulation of an inverted roof should be considered as the drainage layer).
Drainage 7.1.12
Flat roofs and balconies shall have adequate and effective rainwater drainage to a suitable outfall. Issues to be
taken into account include:
a) falls
b) outlets.
The principles for drainage given in Chapter 7.2 Pitched roofs are applicable to flat roofs and balconies.
7.1
Rainwater disposal from roofs and balconies 6m2 or less in area should be considered. Where run-off may cause damage or staining
to a faade, or damage to landscaping, then rainwater gutters and downpipes should be provided. The cumulative effect of water
discharging from multiple balconies in vertical alignment should be taken into account.
Open slatted balcony decking should drain away from the home.
Falls
Flat roofs and balconies should:
be designed with a fall no shallower than 1:40 to ensure a
min.
achieved using screeds (particularly on large roofs). 150mm
overflow
Where decking or paving is installed above the waterproofing
and is less than 150mm below the sill, it should be of a type and
design that prevents a build-up of standing water.
fall no less than 1:40
(for design purposes)
fall away from door
Concrete roofs
Concrete roofs can be finished with sand/cement screed topping set to achieve the falls. Screed finishesshould be:
free from ridges and indentations
to the minimum thickness in Table 7 where a cement/sand
finished with a wooden float to provide a smooth, even
screed, 1:4 (cement:sand) is used
surface for the vapour control layer and waterproof finish suitably dry and primed to receive the waterproofing system.
installed by specialist contractors where a lightweight
finish is used, and have a topping of 1:6 (cement:sand),
13mm thick
Table 7: Minimum screed thicknesses
Location of screed Nominal thickness (mm)
Bonded monolithically to in-situ or precast concrete 40 (25 minimum.)
Unbonded (on separating layer) 70 (50 minimum.)
Timber roofs
Firring pieces should be:
used to form falls,unless the design specifies a sloping joist
or ceiling
of the sizes given in Table 8 where installed across the joists.
Rainwater outlets
Rainwater outlets should:
be of the size and number required to deal with the expected
be accessiblefor maintenance.
rainfall intensity in accordance with BS EN 12056-3
be recessed to facilitate the free flow of water
Where a flat roof or balcony has an upstand on all sides, drainage should consist of either two outlets or one outlet plus an overflow.
The overflow should be:
provided through parapet walls or perimeter upstands
of higher capacity than the combined capacity of the
sized and positioned to prevent water from entering
other outlet(s).
the building
Guarding
Guarding should:
not be easily climbed
be toughened glass, laminated glass or glass blocks where
be to an adequate height
glazed balustrading is used
not be fixed through the waterproofing unless suitable
precautions are taken.
Stability of guarding
Guarding, including parapet walls, and balustrading used as guarding, should be designed in accordance with BS EN 1991-1-1
to resist horizontal loading and as required by the building regulations. Particular care is needed when the design incorporates
balustrading fixed to parapet walls to ensure stability and prevent overturning. End fixings or returns may be needed to
ensure stability.
In balcony walls (especially long balconies) the structural stability should be checked, as the DPC at the base of the wall can create
a slip plane that can seriously limit the ability of the wall to resist horizontal forces. In such cases, it may be necessary to incorporate
a ring beam or other support to ensure stability.
7.1
7.2.1 Compliance 01
7.2.2 Provision of information 01
7.2.3 Design of pitched roofs 01
7.2.4 Protection of trusses 03
7.2.5 Durability 04
7.2.6 Wall plates 04
7.2.7 Joints and connections 05
7.2.8 Restraint 06
7.2.9 Bracing for trussed rafter roofs 07
7.2.10 Strutting for attic trusses and cut roofs
that form a floor 09
7.2.11 Support for equipment 09
7.2.12 Access 09
7.2.13 Dormer construction 09
7.2.14 Underlay and sarking 10
7.2.15 Ventilation, vapour control and insulation 11
7.2.16 Firestopping and cavity barriers 13
7.2.17 Battens 14
7.2.18 Roof coverings 14
7.2.19 Fixing tiles and slates 15
7.2.20 Weatheringdetails 18
7.2.21 Valleys and hidden gutters 20
7.2.22 Drainage 21
7.2.23 Fascias and trim 21
Design of pitched roofs 7.2.3 Also see: TRADA Eurocode 5 span tables (3rd edition) and BS 8103
The sizing and spacing of members shall ensure structural stability and provide restraint to the structure
without undue movementor distortion. Issues to be taken into account include:
7.2
Structural timber should be of a suitable grade and specified according to the strength classes in BS EN 338, e.g. C16,
C24 or TR26. When using the BS 4978 grading rules:
the timber specification should be in accordance with
the timber should be marked accordingly.
BS EN 1912, or the timber species and strength
class identified
7.2
4m or more 75mm 35mm
Ceiling finishes should be fixed according to the spacing of the support members and the thicknessof the sheet.
Plasterboard should be fixed as follows:
9.5mm plasterboard should be fixed at a maximum support
Additional members will generally be required to support
spacing of 450mm. coverings and finishes where trusses are spaced
12.5-15mm plasterboard should be fixed at a maximum
further apart.
support spacing of 600mm.
Where the width of a gable ladder exceedsthat of the trussed rafter centres, noggings shouldbe used to reduce the span of the
roofing tile battens.
ridge
purlin
collar pole plate
spanning between
hanger load-bearing walls
strut
binder
wall plate
load-bearing
wall
Generally sizes should be as Table 3, unless designed byan jack hip valley
rafter rafter rafter
engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
Table 3: Typical sizes for timber members
Member Minimum size
7.2
Protection of trusses 7.2.4 Also see: International Truss Plate Association Technical Handbook
Trusses shall be protected from damage.
Where the trusses or timber members are damaged, they should be rejected and not repaired. To avoid distortionand to
prevent damage, trusses should be:
protected against weather to prevent the corrosion oftruss
stored vertically and propped
plates and the deterioration of the timber stored with level bearers under the joints
adequately ventilated during storage
carried upright (fasteners can loosen when carried flat).
stored clear of the ground
Durability 7.2.5
Timber shall be of suitable durability.
The following timber members should be naturally durable or treated in accordance with Chapter 3.3 Timber Preservation
(natural solid timber):
Porch posts.
Bargeboard.
Tiling battens.
Fascias and other trim.
Soffits.
Where the roof is to include a fully supported weatherproofing membrane, the following timber components should either be
naturally durable or suitably treated:
Rafters.
Sarking.
Purlins.
Wall plates.
Ceiling joists.
Battens for fixing vertical cladding.
Bracing.
rafters or trusses
joined using half-lapped joints, including at corners
max. projection=
38 x 100mm or in accordance with local practice.
50mm or xS
whichever is larger
Fixings used to connect the roof structure to thewall plate should be specified according to theroof construction and exposure of
the site.
Where trussed rafter roofs are not subject touplift, a minimum of two 4.5mm x 100mm galvanized round wire nails, skew nailed,
7.2
one on each side of the trussed rafter, or truss clips (fixed in accordance with the manufacturers instructions) are acceptable.
Where the roof is required to resist uplift, skew nailing is unlikely to provide sufficient strength, and appropriate metal straps should
be used. Holding-down straps should be:
provided according to the geographical location and
a minimum cross section of 30mm x 2.5mm and spaced
construction type at a maximum of 2m centres (galvanised steel straps are
provided where the self-weight of the roof is insufficient
generally acceptable)
against uplift fixed to the wall, or turned into a bed joint.
provided in accordance with the design
d
steel tie
prevents
angle tie spread of
hip rafter
plywood angle
tie prevents
wall plates
spreading
Figure 1 Figure 2
strap underneath the 25x100mm bracing fitted
strap underneath solid noggings, longitudinal bracing (or an tightly to internal
fixed with a minimum of four additional timber member) fixed face of block
fixings (at least one in the third rafter) with a minimum of eight screws inner leaf
block removed
for clarity
packing between
rafter and wall
strap held tightly
against block
inner leaf
nogging fixed horizontally to avoid strap held tightly against block inner leaf
twisting the restraint strap
7.2
length and number of bends and twists anchorage downturn to 100mm or propriatory straps in
provided at rafter level on gable walls, where the home is of
accordance with Technical Requirement R3 and installed in
masonry construction (larger or separating walls may require acordance with the manufacturers reccomendations
restraint at ceiling level) fixed with the downturn on a substantial piece of blockwork,
protected against corrosion in accordance with BS EN 845
preferably fitted over the centre of an uncut block
- Tables A.1 and A.2 (sherardised straps or fixings are not in accordance with BS EN 1995-1-1, where the home is of
acceptable in Northern Ireland and the Isle of Man) timber frame construction.
of sufficient length to be fixed to a minimum of three trusses
In framed roofs, as an alternative, purlins and pole plates can be used to provide restraint where the timber abuts a gable
construction. Where purlins are used to provide restraint, the maximum permissible spacing is 2m unless the design
shows otherwise.
Gable ladders can be used to provide restraint to the external wall where:
there is blocking between the last trussed rafter and the
the soffit board is cut carefully and then fixed securely to
inner leaf (maximum 2m spacing) restrain the outer leaf.
Bracing fortrussedrafter roofs 7.2.9 Also see: ITPA Technical Handbook BS 5268-3 (AMD.5931) Appendix A
Trussed rafters shall be suitably braced to support applied loads and self-weight without undue movement.
For the purposes of this chapter, the guidance and use of standard trussed rafter bracing does not apply to homes on or near
exposed sites, e.g. flat coastal fringes, fens, airfields and moorland. In such cases, bracing should be designed by an engineer in
accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
Standard trussed rafter bracing, in accordance with Table 4, is generally acceptable, where the home:
has a rectangular roof (including hip ends) and is either a
has trusses which are only supported at each end
duo-pitched or a mono-pitch structure does not have unsupported masonry spanning more
is not taller than 8.4m (to the underside of the ceiling tie)
than 9m (between buttressing walls, piers orchimneys)
is braced in accordance with this chapter
has a ceiling of plasterboard directly under each truss
is braced according to the conditions of the site and in
(where there is no plasterboard, i.e. garages, additional
accordance with the design diagonal ceiling bracing and longitudinal binder bracing at
does not have trusses which span more than 12m
each ceiling node point is required.
Bracing for roofs that areapproximately square Bracing for larger roofs
Bracing for roofs less than 6.6m wide on detached or Bracing for mono-pitch trusses
staggered/stepped buildings
truss span
Longitudinal bracing member at ridge node point Longitudinal bracing member at rafter node point
Applicable to all trussed rafter roofs. Not necessary where rigid Applicable to all rafter node points. Not necessary where:
sarking, such as OSB, timber boarding or plywood sheeting,
spacing between braced nodes is less than 4.2m, or
is used.
rigid sarking, such as OSB, timberboarding or plywood
sheeting, is used.
7.2
Longitudinal binders at ceiling node points Chevron bracing between webs
Applicable to all ceiling node points. Not necessary where the Where the span exceeds 8m. For mono-pitch roofs of any span
spacing between braced nodes is lessthan 3.7m. and duo-pitch roofs over 11m span, bracing should be designed
by an engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
It should be approximately 45 to the web members.
more than 8m
Access hatches should be in accordance with Clause 7.2.15. Where an access hatch is required to provide fire resistance,
the fire-resistance period should be supported by test evidence.
layboard
lintel supports
dormer roof
plate
Underlay should:
be provided to all tiled roofs
be cut neatly, fit tightly and not be torn, i.e. where pipes
where it is above rigid sarking (fully supported), be of low
project through the underlay
vapour resistance, i.e. less than 0.25MNs/g (where the be dressed into the gutter and cut neatly to fit tightlyaround
underlay is highly vapour-resistant, increased ventilation to service penetrations
the roof space or between the underlay and sarking should where traditional mortar pointing isused to bed ridge tiles,
be provided as necessary) extend over the ridge
where exposed at eaves level, be UV resistant or of type 5U
continue over hips to form a 150mm minimum lap parallel
felt or a proprietary eaves guard used (type 1F may be used with the hip rafter
7.2
for the remainder of the roof) at abutments, be supported and turned up by a minimum
be supported by a continuous fillet or proprietary eaves
of 100mm
support tray to prevent sagging (which can form a water trap) be draped to allow water to drain behind the tiling battens.
be securely fixed
At valleys:
the main roof underlay should be cut to the valley batten line
underlay and held down by the valley battens (where used). lapped to suit
pitch of roof
underlay supported
by tilting fillet and
dressed into gutter
Ridge or high-level ventilation equivalent to a continuous opening of 5mm should be provided at the highest point of each roof slope
in accordance with BS 5250 in the following situations:
Unventilated cold roofs have insulation placed over a
The roof is covered with high water vapour resistant (type
horizontal ceiling and a vapour-permeable underlay (type HR) underlay and the pitch exceeds 35 or the span exceeds
LR) is used. 10m (this is in addition to eaves ventilation).
Vapour permeable underlays are used on sloping roofs with
areas covered by non-permeable materials (e.g. at roofed
areas of mansard roofs).
10mm 10mm
opening opening
7.2
Where high water vapour-resistant (type HR) underlay (e.g. types 1F/5U felts) is used, eavesventilation should be provided on
opposite sides of the roof to permit cross ventilation, and:
where the roof pitch is 15or more, ventilation equivalent to
for mono-pitched roofs, cross ventilation should be in
a10mm slot running the full length of the eaves should accordance with BS 5250 and have ventilation equivalent
be provided of a continuous high-level 5mm slot, in addition to
where the ceiling follows the slope of a roof, regardless
eaves ventilation.
of pitch, or where a cold roof has a pitch less than15,
ventilation equivalent to a 25mm slot running the full length
ofthe eaves should be provided (a nominal clearance of
50mm should be maintained between the insulation and the
roof underlay)
10mm or 25mm
opening to suit pitch
mono-pitched roof
25mm 25mm
opening opening
room-in-roof (partially sloping ceiling) room-in-roof (completely sloping ceiling)
10mm or
25mm opening
to suit pitch
25mm 25mm
opening opening
roof pitch below 15
insultation above
min. 50mm cavity closer and
clear airway wall plate avoids
5mm a cold bridge
opening
ventilation
opening
25mm
opening
25mm
opening
7.2
room in roof (flat roof dormer)
Dormer construction
Ventilation to dormers should be provided from eaves to eaves or from eaves to ridge.
Pipework
To reduce the risk of freezing or condensation forming
pipes insulated
on pipework, the following precautions should be taken: when above
loft insulation
Where possible, water pipes should be below the main
roof insulation. lap the tank
insulation
Water pipes should be insulated in accordance with
and the loft
insulation
Chapter 8.1 Internal services.
Roof insulation should be placed above and around water
tanks, but not below them.
Cold rising pipework above ceiling level should be insulated,
rising main insulated
even where it is below themain roof insulation. above ceiling level
Pitched roofs shall be constructed to provide adequate fire resistance and separation.
Firestopping should be provided in accordance with building regulations, including:
at the junctions between a separating or compartment wall
above separating walls
and a roof within the boxed eaves at separating walls.
at the junctions between cavities
When providing firestopping:
3D
gaps between compartments should be sealed
firestop between
batten and above
separating walls should stop approximately25mm below the
underlay
top of adjacent roof trusses, and a soft fire-resistant packing,
such as mineral wool, should be used to allow for movement firestop
in roof timbers and prevent hogging of the tiles below underlay
Battens 7.2.17
Battens and counter battens shall be adequately sized and spaced to support the roof covering.
Battens and counter battens should be:
in accordance with BS 5534, accompanied by a delivery
cut square, butt jointed over rafters and nailed to eachrafter
note and marked with the supplier, origin, grade and size they span
preservative treated
fixed by skew driven nails on each side of the joint.
where cut ends are in contact with mortar,
Counter battens should be fixed to the rafters and not only to sarking boards.
Battens should be:
a minimum of 1.2m long and span a minimum of
fixed through counter battens to rafters
three rafters where on rigid sarking boards, supported on counter battens
set out in straight lines parallel to the ridge and to the gauge
at verges, tile battens should finish 25mm-50mm from the
required for the tile or slate (the lap should not be decreased face of the protecting undercloak
as this would reduce weathertightness) sized in accordance with the roof covering manufacturers
set out so that the tiles project a minimum of 50mm over
recommendations, but not less than shown in Table 9.
the gutter
Table 9: Suitable batten sizes
450mm span 600mm span
Double lap slates Natural: sized or random 25mm x 50mm 25mm x 50mm
Fibre cement or concrete 25mm x 38mm 25mm x 50mm
Clay/concrete tiles Double lap 25mm x 38mm 25mm x 38mm
Single lap 25mm x 38mm 25mm x 50mm
Notes
1 Actual size should be within +/3mm of the nominal size).
too many battens (in a group
Battens should be set out to avoid joints occurring over the of four) joined over the same rafter
same rafter. Where batten spacing is:
more than 200mm, no morethan one batten in any group of
7.2
200mm
spacing
Where slates and concrete or clay tiles are designated AA to BS 476-3, they can beused without limitation on pitched roofs.
Table 11: Acceptable characteristics for natural slates
Characteristics Grade (to BS EN 12326)
Water absorption less than 0.6% A1
Thermal cycle T1
Carbonate content less than 20% S1
Careful setting out will improve the finished appearance of the roof, help avoid problems such as unequal overhangs, and reduce
excessive tile cutting at abutments, chimneys and similar obstructions.
When installing coverings:
clay tiles that do not meet the dimensional and geometric
double tiles, tile-and-a-half or half tiles can be used when
requirements given in BS EN 1304 should not be laid at available from the manufacturer (to avoid the use of
pitches less than 40 small sections of cut tiles). Alternatively, where the tile
7.2
underlay dressed
into gutter below
under-eaves tiles
At hips:
underlay should continue to form a 150mm minimum lap
where wet bedded tiles are used, they should be supported
parallel with the hip rafter at the base by a galvanized hip iron and project to the centre
line of the gutter.
All ridge and hip tiles should be mechanically fixed with self-sealing non-ferrous fixings into timber battens, and have a nominal joint
thickness of 10mm where wet bedded.
Proprietary dry fixed systems should be assessed in accordance with Technical Requirement R3.
Verges
Unless a proprietary dry verge system or cloaked verge is used, tiles should be bedded into a 100mm wide bed of mortar on
an undercloak of cement-based board, plain tile or slate. Plain tiles should not be used as an undercloak below 30pitch or
on a bargeboard.
cut tiles
avoided
at verges
38-50mm
tile-and-a-half or
tiles used 30-60mm
for correct
coursing
Where verge tiles and slates are wet bedded, pointing should be completed as soon as possible using the same mix.
Verge clips should be in full contact with the tile to resist uplift, nailed twice to battens and sized to ensure that they are in direct
contact with the top surface of the verge tile.
Where plain tiles and slates are used at the verge:
they should project 38-50mm beyond the gable wall
natural slate verges should be formed with full slates and
or bargeboard either slate-and-a-half or half slates that are a minimum of
cut plain tiles are not acceptable, and purpose-made plain
150mm wide.
tile-and-a-half tiles should be used
Where interlocking tiles are used at the verge:
they should project 30-60mm beyond the gable wall
small sections (less than a half tile width) ofcut interlocking
or bargeboard tiles should not be used.
Mortar
When bedding tiles or slates in mortar:
the mortar should be 1:3 cement:sand with plasticiser
pointing should be completed as soon as possible using the
the mortar should be a mix based on sharp sand with soft
same mix.
7.2
sand added to achieve workability; the proportion of sharp tiles should be wetted on their contact surface, and surface
sand should not be less than one third of the total sand water allowed to drain away before fixing
content (proprietary mixes may be accepted by NHBC concealed or decorative dentil tiles should be fully bedded
where they are shown to have similar strength, durability into joints in excess of 25mm thick.
and workability)
Flashing details should be appropriate for the roof and the type of roof covering used, in accordance with BS 5534. Where flashings
come into contact with metal, they should be formed using non-ferrous material.
Table 13: Suitable materials for flashings
Material Standard Additional information
Aluminium and alloys BS EN 515 0.6-0.9mm thick, and protected from contact with mortar by a coating of
bituminous paint
Copper BS EN 1172 Flashings, soakers and saddles should be:
fully annealed
0.55mm thick (0.7mm thick is suitable for gutters)
Rolled lead sheet BS EN 12588 Flashings, gutter linings etc. should:
be a minimum of code 4, and soakers a minimum of code 3
sections should not exceed 1.5m in length
Zinc alloy BS EN 988 Should be a minimum of 0.6mm thick
Proprietary products Technical Requirement R3 Should be securely fixed in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations
Abutments
At abutments:
flashings, soakers and gutters should be
joints between the masonry and flashing should be pointed
provided as necessary with cement mortar or suitable exterior grade sealantin
lead flashings should have a minimum lap of 100mm
accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
flashings should be tucked 25mm into a brick joint and
7.2
should be used where slates, flat interlocking tiles or plain tiles are used,
stepped flashings should be cut from a strip a minimum of
soakers (or a secret gutter) should be installed.
150mm wide
lead flashing
wedged into joint
min. below wall DPC
75mm min. 150mm
underlay turned
underlay turned up at abutment
up behind flashing
approx.
150mm
fall
min. 150mm
3D
cover flashing
cover
flashing
stepped side
flashing
back gutter
front apron
flashing
Copings
Copings, including those manufactured from natural stone reconstituted stone, and GRP, should be securely fixed to gable walls
using suitably durable fixings, and be weathertight.
To resist wind uplift and gravitational forces, L-shaped brackets should be used to secure stone copings to masonry walls.
The brackets should:
have dowel bars that fit into restraint holes in the copings
be fixed to a solid piece of masonry, with fixings of a
be manufactured from stainless steel
suitable length, gauge and durability.
(such as type 304 to BS EN 10088-2)
DPCs should be installed under the coping to ensure that the wall is weathertight. The DPC should:
be bitumen-based material to BS 6398, or other material
be fully bedded in mortar
assessed in accordance with Technical Requirement R3 be supported over the cavity.
extend the full width of the wall
Fixing methods that penetrate the DPC should be designed to ensure weathertightness. This can be achieved by extending the
lower DPC under the bracket, and installing the next section of the DPC over it to create a lap that covers the fixing point.
GRP coping
plywood plate
compression
lead flashing seal
lead soakers cavity closer
Further guidance can be found in Chapter 6.2 External timber framed walls.
7.2
Valleys shall have suitable weathering details, including flashings, to resist the passage of moisture to the
inside of the building.
Valleys, and the components used, should:
be in accordance with the design
have a lead flashing (minimum code 4) or other suitable
have a finished pitch which complies with the minimum
saddle flashing, at the head of each valley
recommended for the roof be formed using either preformed GRP, valley coursing tiles
be fixed in accordance with the
(plain tiles), valley trough tiles (interlocking tiles), non-ferrous
manufacturers recommendations metal or a proprietary system to Technical Requirement R3.
small cut tiles should be avoided
Where the roof covering is slate or plain tiles, the following may be used:
A laced valley.
A mitred valley with soakers.
A swept valley.
Lead-lined valleys
For lead-lined valleys, the tiles should be cut and bedded as for valley tiles,except that the mortar should be bedded on an
undercloak (to prevent direct contact between the lead and themortar). Mortar should not bridge the welt detail.
Lead should be:
either code 4 (colour-coded blue) or code 5
laid in strips no longer than 1.5m
(colour-coded red) lapped by a minimum of 150mm, where pitches are
supported on gutter boards of 19mm exterior grade ply, or as
above 30.
specified in the design
Drainage 7.2.22
Roof drainage shall adequately carry rainwater to a suitable outlet.
Drainage should be:
provided where roofs are greater than 6m2; however,
fixed in accordance with the design, using the correct type of
consideration should be given to providing drainage to fittings for internal and external angles, outlets etc.to ensure
smaller roofs such as dormer, porch roofs and balconies efficient drainage of the roof
(see Clause 7.1.12) supported and jointed in accordance with the
of a sufficient size to accommodate normal rainfall,
manufacturers recommendations
and sized to cope with concentrated ows, i.e. where insulated when passing through a home, in accordance with
there are dormer roofs Chapter 8.1 Internal services
designed and fitted to preventerosion of the lower surface,
installed ensuring gutters are provided with stop ends,
where water from a large roof surface discharges onto and are laid with a sufficient fall towards the outlet,
another surface unless designed to be at.
Where gutters are behind parapet walls, a suitably sized overflow should be provided.
Where a downpipe discharges above ground level, or above a drainage gully, the downpipe should be fitted with shoes.
8.1.1 Compliance 01
8.1.2 Provision of information 01
8.1.3 Water services and supply 01
8.1.4 Cold water storage 03
8.1.5 Hot water service 03
8.1.6 Soil and waste systems 04
8.1.7 Electrical services and installations 05
8.1.8 Gas service installations 06
8.1.9 Meters 06
8.1.10 Space heating systems 07
8.1.11 Installation 07
8.1.12 Extract ducts 09
8.1.13 Testing and commissioning 10
Water services and supply 8.1.3 Also see: water regulations and guides, BS EN 806
Water services shall be based on the pressures and flow rates supplied from the incoming main.
Components shall be selected and installed to ensure satisfactory service for the life of the system,
with suitable precautions taken against corrosion and damage. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) suitability of materials and components c) durability
b) adequate supply d) protection from the cold.
Adequate supply
The design and installation of the water services supply should:
be in accordance with building regulations, statutory
ensure that stop valves within the curtilage and outside the
8.1
requirements and the recommendations of the water supplier home are protected by a shaft or box
ensure drinking water is provided at the kitchen sink direct
ensure service pipes are a minimum of 750mm below the
from the supply pipe or, where this is impracticable, from a ground surface where this is not possible, adequate
storage cistern containing an adequate supply of precautions should be taken against frost and
drinking water mechanical damage
be based on a minimum 1.5 bar dynamic pressure at the
ensure that underground ducts are sealed at both ends to
stop valve inside the home prevent the entry of fluids, vermin and insects
ensure a minimum 20L/min flow rate is available at the stop
be of materials which are safe and minimise the risk
valve inside the home of corrosion
account for pressure and flow rate reductions (a wider supply
be in accordance with the recommendations of the water
pipe may be required inside the home) supplier, including compatibility of the supplywith the
account for pressure fluctuations and surges, which may
materials and fittings.
occur within the system and potentially damage fittings
(surge arresters may be required)
The water system should becapable of being drained (hot and cold services separately).
Durability
The hot and cold water service should be installed using corrosion resistant pipes and fittings.
In areas where pitting corrosion of copper cylinders occurs, it may be necessary to fit aluminium protector rods. These should be
fitted during manufacture in accordance with the relevant British Standard. Sacrificial anodes should be installed where required by
the water supplier.
insulation
thickness
insulated
water pipes
cold air
Table 1: Minimum insulation thickness to delay freezing inside domestic premises for cold water systems
Outside pipe Minimum insulation thickness (mm)
diameter (mm) Thermal conductivity of material at 0C W/(mK)
0.025 0.030 0.035 0.040
15 30 45 70 91
22-28 12 15 19 24
min.
750mm
any distance
Access should:
be provided to the main roof space and voids that contain
include a minimum 1m2 platform located for
cisterns and tanks, etc. (not required to roof spaces maintenance purposes
containing only water pipes) include securely fixed boarded walkways between the
be via an opening (access hatch) with a minimum width of
opening and the cistern or other permanent equipment
520mm in each direction (boarding should be securely fixed without compressing
not be located directly over stairs or in other
the insulation).
hazardous locations
statutory requirements and generally be available; it may be total demand does not exceed 0.3L/s (where simultaneous
less where the pressure and flow rate of the incoming supply discharge occurs, the flow rate at individual outlets should
falls below 1.5 bar not be less than the minimum rate).
Table 3: Flow rate and temperature requirements
Outlet Design flow rate L/s Minimumflow rate L/s Supplytemperature C
Bath (from storage) 0.3 0.2 60
Bath (from combi) 0.2 0.15 40
Shower (excluding instantaneous electric showers) 0.2 0.1 40
Wash basin 0.15 0.1 40
Sink 0.2 0.1 60
Hot water storage should comply with the minimum capacity in Table 4 (based on a draw-off temperature of 60C), and where
appliances require greater volumes, the capacity should be increased accordingly.
Where systems are heated by off-peak electricity, the storage capacity should be inaccordance with the recommendations ofthe
electricity supplier.
Where homes have one bathroom or shower room, the system should be able to provide adequate hot water:
immediately after the bath has been filled, for tasks such
for a second bath after 20 minutes.
as washing
Instantaneous systems (using combinationboilers) produce hot water ondemand (generally atlower flow rates than
storage systems), and should only be used where:
simultaneous demand for hot wateris limited. Where there
storage combination boilers have the capacity as required
are three or more outlets, the design for simultaneous in Table 4.
discharge can omit the outlet at the kitchen sink
Where homes have two or more bathrooms, the system should be able to provide adequate hot water immediately after each of the
baths have been filled, for tasks such as washing.
Where a shower is installed, adequateprovision should be made to ensure thatthe outlet temperature of the water is
notsignificantly affected by the use of other hotor cold outlets in the home. This may beachieved by the provision of a
thermostaticshower mixing valve, the appropriate design ofpipe sizes or dedicated supplies.
Where boilers can control andprioritise hot water outputs:
storagecapacities can be less than the figures in Table 4
thestorage capacity should be in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
Storage systems provide higher flow ratesthan instantaneous systems, and:
requirea suitable space for the siting of thestorage vessel
where vented, should be provided with anexpansion pipe.
Unvented hot water storage systemsshould be:
assessed in accordance with Technical Requirement R3,
installed by competentinstallers.
or meet the requirements of BS 7206 and be the subject of
third-party certification, e.g. Kitemarking (applies to both the
assembled system and components)
The junctions of wall tiling with baths and showers should be made watertight using a flexible sealant to accommodate movement.
The manufacturers instructions should befollowed.
Electrical services and installations 8.1.7 Also see: BREreport Thermal insulation: avoiding risks
Electrical installations shall be provided in accordance with relevantregulations, codes and standards.
The installation shall ensure safe and satisfactory operation and be protected from chemical attack.
Electrical services and installations should:
comply with BS 7671 Requirements for
be installed in accordance with the
electrical installations manufacturers recommendations
comply with BS 6004 Electric cables. PVC insulated and
ensure cables are not placed under, againstor within thermal
PVC sheathed cables for voltages up to and including insulation, unless they have been appropriately sized
300/500 V, for electric power and lighting. and derated
have fittings and components located in accordance with
ensure PVC covered cables are not in contact with
relevant building regulations polystyrene insulation.
Rooms should be provided with the minimum number of 13A outlets listed in Table 5 (dual outlets count as two).
Table 5: Minimum number of outlets
8.1
Cables without special protection, suchas an earthed vertically or horizontally in shaded zone
to switch or outlet 150mm wide
metal conduit, should bepositioned:
vertically or horizontally from the outlet or switch being served
within the shaded zone in the diagram, or
a minimum of 50mm from the surface of a wall, or a minimum
of 50mm from the top or bottom of a timber joist, or batten in
a floor or ceiling.
Where the position of switches or sockets can be determined
from the reverse side of the wall or partition, the zone on one
side of the wall or partition applies to the reverse side.
Lighting outlets
Lighting outlets should be provided:
in each room, hall, landing and staircases
in the common areas of homes and controlled by either
with two-way switching at each floor level in a staircase
manual switching or automatic light-sensitive controls.
Cooking spaces
Cooking spaces should:
have a minimum 30A supply which is suitably switched
where provided, have cooker panels located to the side of
and terminated the cooker space.
have a 13A socket outlet where there is a gas supply
Gas service installations 8.1.8 Also see: Chapters 6.2, 6.8, BS 5482, BS 6400 and BS 6891
Gas service installations shall be adequate and comply with the gas safety regulations, and be in accordance
with relevant standards and codes to ensure safe and satisfactory operation.
Gas service installations should ensure:
service pipework up to and including theemergency control where there is a gas supply to the home, a gas point at the
valve and meter is in accordance with the requirementsof cooker space should be provided. This is not required where
the gas transporter, gas supplier andprimary meter owner an electric hob is provided
installation of pipework and appliances complies with where gas pipework is to be installed in timberframe,
relevantstandards and codes including thosepublished by allowance is made for differential movement.
the Institution of Gas Engineers and Managers (IGEM) or
Gas Safe Register (GSR)
Openings in walls for metercabinets shall be structurally adequateand prevent dampness entering the home.
Openings set into external walls should beprovided with: cavity tray
outer wall).
meter box
Individually purpose-made compartments in accordance with
Space heating appliances, including all components and controls, should be of atype approved by the relevant authority,including:
Solid fuel Solid Fuel Association, Heating Equipment
Electricity British Electrotechnical Approvals Board
Testing & Approval Scheme Oil OFTEC.
The provision of whole home or centralheating is discretionary. Where provided, it should be designed in accordance with Table 6,
recognised standards, and:
the number of air changes per hour from kitchens and
design temperatures should be verified by calculations and
bathrooms should account for any mechanical ventilation not by performance tests
where rooms contain open flued appliances, the rate of
the main living room should have a heating appliance or a
air change used for the design should be increased in heat output as part of a whole home heating system
accordance with BS EN 12828 temperature calculations should be based on
a -3C external temperature.
Table 6: Room temperatures and ventilation rates
Room Room temperature C Ventilation rate(air changes per hour)
Living room 21 1.5
Dining room 21 1.5
Bedroom 18 1
Hall and landing 18 1.5
Kitchen 18 2
Bathroom 22 2
Toilet 18 2
Installation 8.1.11
Internal services shall not adversely affect the stability of the home and be installed to ensure
satisfactory operation. Issues to be taken into account include:
a) fitting of pipes and cables c) concealed services.
b) notching and drilling of joists
Services should:
comply with Chapter 5.1 Substructure and ground-bearing
not be located in the cavity of anexternal wall, except for
floors where they pass through the substructure electricitymeter tails
be protected by a sleeve, or ducted, when passing through
not be buried in screeds unless permitted by relevant codes
structural elementsand not solidly embedded of practice.
Where copper pipes are permitted in floor screeds, they should be:
sleeved or wrapped so that they can move freely along the
jointed with capillary joints.
length and at joints and bends
Pipes should:
be adequately securedwith suitable clips or brackets have adequatefalls (where appropriate)
be installed neatly with clips spaced toprevent sagging, be installed with adequate room for thermal expansion and
but not restrict thermalmovement contractionto avoid damage and noise.
Plastic pipework should be wrapped with metallic tape where it is in, or behind,wall surfaces, and would otherwise notbe located by
a metal detector or similarequipment.
Joints in pipes should be made:
strictlyin accordance with the manufacturersinstructions
using lead-free flux recommended by the pipe manufacturer,
with traces removed immediately after jointing.
Fire stopping should be provided around any services which penetrate fire-resisting floors, walls or partitions. Where a proprietary
system, such as an intumescent seal is used, it should be installed in accordance with the manufacturers instructions.
holes separated
by a min. 3 x
hole diameter
Where the structural strength is impaired by notching or drilling, the element should bereplaced or correctly repaired.
Holes should be spaced at a minimum of three times the hole diameter.
Notches and holes in the same joist should be separated by a minimum horizontal distance of 100mm.
Instructions should be obtained from the designer when notching anddrilling, where:
the joist is deeper than 250mm, or
it is close to heavy loads, such asthose from partitions,
the dimensions are not in accordance with Table 7, or
cisterns, cylindersand stair trimming.
I-joists
Preformed holes are provided,and additional holes and notches should not be cutwithout the approval of the manufacturer.
Metal web joists
Services should run inthe gaps between the metal webs. Conduits mayneed to be inserted before the joistsare fixed in position.
Lightweight steel
8.1
Light weight steel should be used in accordance with Chapter 6.10 Light steel framed walls and floors.
Concealed services
Services concealed in walls or floors should be located so that significant cracking of the surface does not occur. Where chases in
walls are necessary, their depth should not exceed:
1/6 thickness of the single leaf for horizontal chases
1/3 thickness for vertical chases.
Hollow blocks should not be chased unlessspecifically permitted by the manufacturer.
Building integration
Routing of ductwork should take account of other building elements. Ductwork passing through structural elements should not
adversely affect the structural or fire performance of the building. Where alterations to structural elements, such as I-joists,
are required, this should only be carried out in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations, or be designed by an
engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
The fire requirements of the building should be in accordance with relevant building regulations and standards. Issues that should be
taken into account include:
suitable detailing of components passing through other the integrity of protected stairs and halls
elements of the building the integrity of walls and floors.
the location and type of dampers and firestops to be used
Resistance to airflow
Ductwork systems should be designed to minimise the resistance to airflow, and be formed from compatible components.
Rigid duct is preferable to flexible, but where flexible duct is used, it should be restricted in length to ensure that the airflow
resistance does not prevent the designed ventilation rate from being achieved. Flexible duct should be installed:
straight
in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
Bends should generally be formed with proprietary rigid components. Where flexible duct is used to form bends on an intermittent
extract system, they should be restricted to a maximum of:
two for systems up to 30 L/s one for extract rates higher than 30 L/s.
Control of condensation
Where extract ductwork passes through unheated spaces, it should be continuously insulated to achieve a thermal resistance
equivalent to a minimum of 25mm of insulating material with a thermal conductivity of 0.04W/(mK). This can be achieved by using:
suitable pre-insulated ductwork, or
a proprietary insulation system.
8.1
Alternatively, the ductwork can be fitted with a condensate trap that discharges to the outside or installing the duct to slope to
the outside.
unheated
unheated space
space
condensate trap
Installation
Ductwork should be installed in a neat and workmanlike manner, be securely fixed, and have:
adequate support throughout its length
sealed mechanically fixed joints and connections.
Where ductwork passes through an external wall, it should be positioned to slope slightly outwards to prevent water entering
the building. Clips and supports for ductwork should be spaced at equal distances and in accordance with the ductwork
manufacturers recommendations. For rigid ductwork, they should not generally be more than 750mm apart.
Ductwork should not be in direct contact with other surfaces, such as plasterboard ceilings, that may transfer noise to the home.
Terminals
Ventilation systems should terminate freely to open air.
The air flow resistance of terminals should not adversely affect the performance of the ventilation system. Airflow resistance of
terminals can be obtained through testing in accordance with BS EN 13141-2.
terminal extracting
to open air
insulation removed
for clarity
8.2.1 Compliance 02
8.2.2 Provision of information 03
8.2.3 Clean Air Act 03
8.2.4 System design 03
8.2.5 Access 04
8.2.6 Handling, storage and protection 04
8.2.7 Sequence of work 04
8.2.8 Location 04
8.2.9 Building integration 04
8.2.10 Fixing 05
8.2.11 Electrical installation requirements 06
8.2.12 Pipes, insulation and protection from cold 06
8.2.13 Ground collectors 06
8.2.14 Fuel storage 07
8.2.15 Safe discharge 07
8.2.16 Testing and commissioning 07
8.2.17 Handover requirements 07
8.2.18 Further information 07
Introduction
This chapter provides guidance on low or zero carbon (LZC) technologies acceptable to NHBC. Other systems that follow
the general principles of this chapter may also be acceptable, subject to specific agreement with NHBC.
Additional requirements for solid fuel and oil fired boilers are given in Chapter 6.8 Fireplaces, chimneys and flues.
Guidance on other internal services is given in Chapter 8.1 Internal services.
This chapter provides guidance on the following technologies:
expansion pump
vessel
feed
feed
pump
output
(export)
output
solar
consumer import thermal
unit meter
PV array
expansion
vessel +
relief valve discharge
AC mains supply storage
feed vessel
Wind turbine
Systems which convert wind energy into electricity.
8.2
output
(demand)
generation export
inverter meter meter
output
(export)
consumer import
unit meter
AC mains supply
The illustrations provided within the introduction are generic and do not indicate the only possible systems acceptable to NHBC.
Relevant standards
LZC should comply with relevant standards including where applicable:
Product certification
LZC technologies should have current certification confirming satisfactory assessment by an appropriate independent authority
acceptable to NHBC.
Systems, products and installations that are assessed through theMicrogeneration Certification Scheme (MCS) will generally be
acceptable to NHBC. Certification and test documentation should bemade available to NHBC upon request.
Other certification bodies or test documentation may be acceptable where they are considered by NHBC to be a suitable alternative.
Operative competency
LZC systems should be installed by operatives:
competent and familiar with the system being installed, and
certified to a standard acceptable to NHBC.
Installers who have been trained in accordance with the MCS installer standards will generally be acceptable to NHBC.
Location
The design and location of LZC technologies should take account of factors such asorientation, roof pitch and shading.
For stand-alone wind turbine systems, suitable exclusion zones should be provided in accordance with the manufacturers
recommendations and geographical location.
Acoustics
Design and location should take account of:
internal and external noise
the effect on neighbouring properties, particularly the
vibration
positioning of the LZC technology in relation to openings.
Systems
Each system should generally be supplied from one manufacturer as a package and not as individual components or materials.
However, where components from more than one manufacturer are used, they should be compatible to ensure
satisfactory performance.
Compatibility
LZC technologies should be installed soas not to adversely affect the performance of the building to which they are fixed, and in
accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
Multiple systems should be compatible with each other.
Performance
LZC technologies designed to contribute towards space and water heating should be designed in accordance with the performance
requirements in Chapter 8.1 Internal services.
Access 8.2.5
Appropriate arrangements shall be provided for the purposes of cleaning, inspection, maintenance and repair
of LZC technologies.
Safe access should be provided to the LZC technologies, includingswitchgear, inverters, meters and controls. This is to
enable the cleaning, inspection, maintenance and repair of systems. Access should be provided in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
Location 8.2.8
LZC technologies shall be correctly located.
LZC technologies, including ancillary components should be located and identified in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
8.2
All interfaces between the LZC technology and the building should ensure adequate weather resistance, sealed to limit air leakage
and prevent moisture from reaching the interior or any part of the structure that could be adversely affected by its presence.
The envelope should be weatherproofed using appropriate flashings and fixings. Weatherproofing details that rely solely on sealant
are not acceptable. Flashings should be formed from the materials listed in Table 1.
Table 1: Materials for flashings
Flashing material Guidance
Rolled lead sheet Minimum code 4. BS EN 12588.
Aluminium and aluminium alloys BS EN 485 and BS EN 573, 0.6-0.9mm thick and protected from contact with mortar by a
coating of bituminous paint.
Zinc alloys BS EN 988 and 0.6mm thick.
Copper BS EN 1172 0.55mm thick and fully annealed. Where two metals are to be joined, they
should be compatible and not cause bimetallic corrosion in that environment Alternatively,
they should be isolated from each other.
Proprietary flashing, Assessed in accordance with Technical Requirement R3.
including plastic and composite.
To avoid potential surface or interstitial condensation, the design should take account of thermal bridging, particularly where any part
of the system, including fixings, penetrates the thermal envelope.
Materials that comply with recognised standards, which provide equal or better performance to those above, are also acceptable.
The type, size, number, position and fitting tolerance of fixings should be in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
Issues that should be taken into account include:
the provision of suitable locking nuts and washers
the isolation of aluminium from cementitious material.
the isolation of dissimilar metals
The installation of ground collectors shall take structural and environmental factors into account.
The depth and layout of ground collectors should be specified to avoid freezing of adjacent ground. Where open loop systems are
proposed, consultation with the appropriate environment agency should be made and may require one or more of the following:
A licence to investigate groundwater.
A discharge consent.
An abstraction licence.
Excavations for the installation of ground collectors should not adversely affect aquifers, foundations, drainage, water supply pipes
and other services. Design should take account of local planning authority guidance, including excavations that are close to trees
and hedgerows.
Ground collectors should be protected and tested prior to backfilling.
Fuel storage 8.2.14 Also see: The HVCA Guideto Good Practice Installation of Biofuel Heating (TR/38)
Fuel storage for biomass boilers shall be suitable for the installation.
Fuel stores should have appropriate:
access for delivery
volume to take account of peak load and period of demand
fire detection and extinguishing equipment where elevated
fire resistance and separation to prevent fire and gases
dust levels are expected entering other parts of the building.
BS EN ISO 14713: Part 1-4
Photovoltaics in buildings.
8.3.1 Compliance 01
8.3.2 Provision of information 01
8.3.3 Building integration 01
8.3.4 Noise 02
8.3.5 Design considerations 02
8.3.6 Access and operation 04
8.3.7 Ductwork 04
8.3.8 Fixing and jointing of ductwork 04
8.3.9 Commissioning and balancing 05
8.3.10 Handover requirements 05
Also see: Chapter 2.1, Approved Document F, Domestic Ventilation Compliance Guide, Section 3 of the
Compliance 8.3.1 Technical Handbooks, Domestic Ventilation Guide in Scotland and Technical Booklets in Northern Ireland
MVHR design, materials and sitework shall comply with the Technical Requirements, and be installed by
competent operatives.
MVHR systems that comply with the guidance in this chapter and are in accordance with the relevant British Standards and
building regulations will generally be acceptable.
MVHR systems should be installed by operatives:
competent and familiar with thesystem being installed, and
trained in accordance with the BPEC installer scheme,
or other suitable scheme acceptable to NHBC.
Weathertightness
Proprietary roof terminals should be used to ensure the weathertightness of the roof covering.
Firestopping
The MVHR system should not adversely affect the fire performance of the building. Issues to be taken into account include:
ensuring that the fire requirements of the building are in
location and type of firestops to beused
accordance with relevant building regulations integrity of protected stairs and halls
suitable detailing of components passing through other
integrity of walls and floors.
elements of the building
Proprietary fire components should besuitably tested, and specified to take account of the test conditions.
Relevant standards include:
BS 476 Fire tests on building materials and structures.
BS EN 1365-2 Fire resistance tests for loadbearing elements. Floors and roofs.
BS EN 1366-3 Fire resistance tests for service installations. Penetration seals.
Noise 8.3.4
MVHR systems shall be designed to minimise disturbance caused by noise.
MVHR fan units should be sized to run at their optimum speed and to provide suitable performance whilst taking the resulting noise
and vibration into account. Specifying MVHR fan units that can provide the required airflow rates when running at less than full
speed can reduce unnecessary noise.
Ductwork should be sized to allow air to pass freely without causing excessive noisedisturbance. To reduce noise transfer
along ductwork, a short length of flexible duct can be installed adjacent to air valves and fan units. Other issues to be taken into
account include:
noise between habitable rooms
location of the MVHR fan unit
external noise
the type of mountings used to secure the MVHR fan unit.
Performance
The MVHR system should be designed to provide satisfactory performance and be installed according to the design and
manufacturers recommendations. Variations from the design should maintain the satisfactory performance of the system and be
approved by the designer.
Issues that should be taken into account include:
ventilation rates as set out in appropriate building regulations
ensuring the even distribution of airflow, taking into account
and standards airflow resistance, including from bends and fittings.
fan capacity, accounting for airflow resistance of
8.3
the system
Airflow resistance should be calculated using figures for air valves and terminals determined in accordance with BS EN 13141-2
and data supplied by the duct manufacturer. Ductwork should be as direct as possible to reduce the number of bends.
Allowance should be made for air transfer within the home. Where gaps between the underside of internal doors and the floor finish
are used for air transfer, the guidance in Chapter 9.1 A consistent approach to finishes should be considered.
Systemised approach
The MVHR system should be designed as a complete package, taking into account the performance of all components
and materials, to ensure compatibility and the performance requirements of the system.
Particular consideration should be given where components fromdifferent manufacturers are specified on the same system.
To create cross-ventilation within a room and to ensure satisfactory operation, air valves on low velocity systems should be:
positioned on the opposite side of the room from internal
a minimum of 600mm (on plan) from hobs in kitchens
door openings positioned to account for the likely location of tall furniture
a minimum of 200mm from walls, where located on a ceiling and to avoid draughts over beds and seating areas
a maximum of 400mm from the ceiling, where located lockable, where adjustable.
on a wall
To prevent cross-contamination, intake terminals should generally be separated from exhaust terminals and other potential sources
of pollution by a minimum of 1m measured on plan. Increased separation distances may be required between the intake and any:
soil and vent pipe terminal biomass or solid fuel chimney terminal.
boiler flue outlet
Control of condensation
Ductwork should be insulated to prevent condensation formation where:
it passes through spaces outside the insulated parts of
carrying cold air through spaces that are within the insulated
the home, such as a roof void parts of the home.
This can be achieved by using suitable pre-insulated ductwork, or a proprietary insulation system with a thermal resistance
equivalent to a minimum of 25mm of insulating material, with a thermal conductivity of 0.04W/Mk.
Ductwork insulation, including that used for proprietary duct insulation systems and pre-insulated ducts should be:
inert, durable and suitable for use with the ductwork system
installed in a neat and workmanlike manner to ensure that
continuous and vapour resistant
there are no gaps
not adversely affected by moisture vapour
installed in accordance with the
manufacturers recommendations.
Where a vapour control layer is incorporated, thejoints should be sealed using appropriate tapes or sealants as recommended by
the manufacturer.
Table 1: Ductwork insulation
Type of duct Ductwork continuously insulated
Ductwork located inside the insulated part Ductwork located outside the insulated part of
of the home the home
Intake Yes Yes
Exhaust Yes Yes
Service (supply and extract) No Yes(1)
Notes
1 Additional insulation should be provided to protect the system from the cold.
8.3
Any condensate that forms within the fan unit or ductwork should be able to drain to a suitable outfall. Fan units should be located to
enable connection of the condensate drain to the soil and waste system via a dry trap.
To prevent damage to the components and ensure satisfactory operation, MVHR systems should be fitted with automatic
frost protection.
Horizontal sections of service ductwork, outside the insulated pre-insulated to achieve a thermal
performance equivalent to at least 25mm
parts of the home, should be insulated to achieve a thermal of insulating material with a thermal
conductivity of 0.04W/Mk
resistance equivalent to at least 150mm of insulating material
with a thermal conductivity of 0.04W/Mk. This may be
achieved by installing the ductwork between the layers
of horizontal insulation.
Condensate drains located outside the insulated part of the
home should be insulated to prevent freezing.
loft insulation used to achieve a total thermal performance
equivalent to at least 150mm of insulating material with
a thermal conductivity of 0.04W/Mk
Table 2: Guidance for the suitable functioning of, and access to, the MVHR system
Fan unit located inside the insulated part of Fan unit located outside the insulated part of
the home the home
Access Access should not be obstructed and panels should A safe means of access, including a suitable walkway
be located and sized to enable routine servicing to be and a working platform 1m2 immediately adjacent to the
carried out. MVHR fan unit, should be provided. The walkway and
platform should be designed to ensure the continuity of
any insulation, and the supporting structure should be
designed to take account of the additional load.
Control and Where a boost function is provided, it should switch off automatically and be located in, or adjacent to, the room it
functionality serves. Where a summer bypass function is provided, it should operate automatically and divert the airflow around
the heat exchanger. The MVHR system should be capable of being isolated by a switched fused spur.
Indication MVHR systems should include visual indicators showing maintenance and servicing requirements, and mode
and controls of operation. These should be visible from within the insulated envelope, not obscured from view,
and be simple to use.
Cleaning To maintain operating performance, extract service ductwork and air valves should either be fitted with filters,
or ductwork should be accessible for cleaning.
Ductwork 8.3.7
Ductwork design and the materials used should be suitable for the intended purpose and not adversely affect
the performance of the building.
Ductwork should:
provide satisfactory performance for the life of the system
8.3
air valve
Bends, connections and junctions should be formed using proprietary components that are part of the ductwork system.
Flexible ducting should:
only be located adjacent to fan units or airvalves
not be used to form bends.
not be more than 300mm in length
Where ductwork routes require alterations tostructural elements, these should be in accordance with the manufacturers
recommendations or in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
Fixing
Parallel ductwork runs should be positioned to maintain a reasonably even gap.
To prevent condensate collecting, horizontal ductwork should be to a suitable outfall in accordance withthe design, and installed to a
true line to avoid localised dips.
Where ductwork passes through an external wall, it should be positioned toslope slightly outwards to prevent water entering
the building.
Ductwork should be securely held in position by evenly spaced clips no more than 750mm apart, or in accordance with the ductwork
manufacturers recommendations.
Ductwork should not be in direct contact with other surfaces, such as plasterboard ceilings, that may transfer noise to the home.
Jointing
The method and materials used for jointingductwork should be specified by the duct manufacturer, and be:
durable and airtight
sealed with purpose-designed connections in accordance
securely fixed
with the manufacturers recommendations.
Where tapes and sealants are used, they should be suitable for the intended purpose and be recommended by the
ductwork manufacturer. Issues to be taken into account in relation to the durability of the jointing method include:
thermal movement
temperature
moisture
compatibility with the duct material.
Tape should be installed in a neat and workmanlike manner, and surfaces should be dry and freefrom grease and dust
before applying. Excess sealant should not extrude to the inside of the duct.
Where the system cannot be balanced using the air valves and system controls, the complete system should be checked to ensure
that it complies with the design.
Any changes from the design should be referred back to the designer. Adjusting the fan speed above the designed output may result
in noise disturbance, and should be avoided.
8.3
A copy of the commissioning certificate should be made available to NHBC upon request.
9.1.1 Compliance 01
9.1.2 External walls 01
9.1.3 Walls and ceilings 03
9.1.4 Doors and windows 05
9.1.5 Floors 05
9.1.6 Glazing 06
9.1.7 Ceramic, concrete, terrazzo
and similar tile finishes 06
9.1.8 Fitted furniture 06
9.1.9 Joint sealants 06
9.1.10 Other surfaces and finishes 07
9.1.11 External works 07
Fairfaced masonry
Fairfaced masonry should:
be reasonably uniform in texture, finish and colour,
including mortar
not have excessive colour banding
max. 4mm
not have significant cracks in the facing bricks or other
deviation
Also note:
Some mortar blemishes will occur on individual
Efflorescence occurs naturally in sometypes of masonry.
masonry units. It is not harmful and generally disappears over time.
Some variation will occur in the texture, finish and colour of
Some brick products have features or marks which may be
mortar, in individual masonry units and generally over in excess of 15mm in diameter.
the wall. Some minor shrinkage cracking may occur between
masonry units (bricks and blocks) and mortar joints.
plan
2.5m storey height
Example:
Using 25mm wide spacing blocks, the masonry line should be
17-33mm from the reference line. nominal line of wall
with max. 8mm
Spacing block dimensions are a guide and final dimensions should deviation (17-33mm
ensure reference line is kept clear of the wall face. from reference line)
section section
Example: Example:
Using 25mm wide spacing blocks, the masonry Using 50mm wide spacing block,
line should be 17-33mm from the reference line. the plumb bob should be 42-58mm from the wall.
The thickness of an individual bed jointshould not vary from the average of any eightsuccessive joints by a maximum of 5mm.
The vertical alignment of perpend jointsshould not deviate significantly from theperpendicular. As bricks can vary in length, not all
perpend joints will align; however, thereshould not be a cumulative displacementof the perpend joints in a wall.
deviation in 5m, though this may increase where render is in reference line
close proximity to features
not have crazing more than 0.2mm wide.
Also note: 5m
Curtain walling
Curtain walling should be within:
reasonable tolerances and appearance for the materials
a maximum deviation of 2mm in any storey height or
structural bay width, and 5mm overall, unless otherwise
specified in the design.
Rainscreen cladding
Rainscreen cladding should be within:
reasonable tolerances and appearance for the materials a maximum deviation of 3mm in any storey height or
structural bay width, unless otherwise specified in
the design.
Timber cladding
Variation in colour may occur inuncoated timber exposed to the weather, and the rate and extent mayvary.
Also note:
The effects of normal weathering maycause certain
uncoated timber, over time, to develop a silver/grey colour.
Tile hanging
Panels should be reasonably uniform in appearance,particularly at abutments, and may vary in colour and size depending on the
manufacturing process.
max. 10mm
deviation in 2m
plumb of wall finish: flatness of wall finish:
max. 8mm out of plumb max. 5mm deviation
in a storey height of from a 2m straight edge
up to 2.5m with equal offsets
(applies in all directions)
max. 12mm out of plumb 2m
in a continuous wall height
greater than 2.5m
level of ceiling
2m
flatness of ceiling
Setting out of corners, duct casings, access covers and anyassociated framing should be:
square
provided with an appropriate decorative finish.
neat and tidy
max. 10mm
max. 10mm
5mm maximum
deviation in 250mm
5mm maximum
10mm deviation in 500mm deviation in 250mm
Also note:
In plastered walls and ceilings, some toolingmarks may
Small cracks may occur in wall finishes which pass
be visible. across floors (e.g. in staircase walls).
Some cracking (up to 2mm wide) may occur at wall,
Where stair strings abut a wall, a crack of up to 4mm may
floor and ceiling junctions, due to shrinkageand differential appear as a result of shrinkage of materials.
movement of materials.
Skirtings
Where skirtings are installed:
the gap between the floor finish (withoutcoverings) and the
joints should present a continuousappearance when viewed
bottom of theskirting should not exceed 5mm from a distanceof 2m in daylight (some initial shrinkage of
the skirting may already be evident at completion of
the property).
9.1
Also note:
The gap between the floor finish and the skirting may
Gaps may appear at jointsand corners due to shrinkage,
increase due to of normal drying out, shrinkage and/or and between the wall finishand skirting due to drying out,
deflection, particularly in timber floors. shrinkageand fixing position.
be level within 3mm across the sill measured from the frame
5mm maximum deviation of
square for reveals up to
(tiled sills may slope away from the window) 250mm deep
max. 3mm out of level across
have level heads and sills, a maximum of 5mm from level for
reveal (measured from frame)*
openings up to 1.5m, and 8mm where larger reveals: max. 5mm out of plumb
have plumb reveals, a maximum of 5mm for openings up to
for openings up to 1.5m high
performance for weathertightness, exclusion of draught and the gap between the
fire resistance. underside of an internal
door and unfinished floor
should be 10-22mm
Floors shall be built toappropriate tolerances. In England and Wales, where the builder provides a floor finish there
should be a gap of 10mm between the bottom of the door and
floor finish (for a 760mm wide door)
Floors should be: the dimensions are without prejudice to satisfactory performance
in terms of weathertightness, draught exclusion and fire resistance
level within a 4mm deviation per 1m for floors up to 6m across
flat within a 5mm deviation, measured using a 2m straight
a maximum of 25mm out of level for floors over 6m across
edge with equal offsets.
Underfloor service ducts should be constructed so that the cover is level with the adjacent floor finish. The selection of floor finish
9.1
should take into account that drying shrinkage of the floor may result in minor differences in level between the floor and duct cover,
which may become evident with some types of thin floor coverings.
Also note:
The effects of normal drying shrinkage on screeded floors
Timber floors and staircases naturally shrink as they dry.
may cause minor cracking. As this drying occurs, it may result in squeaking components
as they move against each other. This is normal and to
be expected.
Glazing 9.1.6
Glass shall be free of undue defects.
Glass should be checked in daylight, fromwithin the room and from a minimum distance of 2m (3m for toughened, laminatedor
coated glass). The following are acceptable where they arenot obtrusive or bunched:
Bubbles or blisters.
Fine scratches not more than 25mm long.
Hairlines or blobs.
Minute particles.
The above does not apply to areas within 6mmof the edge of the pane, where minorscratching may occur.
Also note:
Joints should be viewed from a distance of 2m, but may be
9.2.1 Compliance 01
9.2.2 Provision of information 01
9.2.3 Plastering 01
9.2.4 Dry lining 02
9.2.5 Ceramic wall tiling 05
Mixed background materials and associated differential movement can lead to cracks and should be avoided. Suitable precautions
should be taken, e.g. using metal lathing.
Metal beads should be used to provideedge protection, and be fixed with zinc-plated fasteners, as recommended by
the manufacturer.
Table 2: Recommended treatments for substrates
Surface Treatment
High-density clay, or concrete bricks and Suitable bonding treatment,hacking,spatterdash,or stipple.
blocks and dense concrete (including soffits)
Mixed backgrounds, May require expanded metal to provide key for plastering and to reduce the effects
e.g. concrete with bricks/blocks of differential movement.
Lightweight concrete blocks Plaster should not be stronger than recommended by the blockwork manufacturer.
Autoclaved aerated concrete blocks Plastering should be conducted inaccordance with the manufacturers
recommendations, accounting for the moisture content of the blocks.
Normal clay brickwork and concrete block May require raked joints or the use of keyed bricks.
9.2
Installation
Dry lining should:
not be started until the building is
provide performance in accordance with building regulations
9.2
Vapour control
Vapour control layers should be used to reduce the risk of interstitialcondensation, and be installed in accordance with:
Chapter 6.2 External timberframed walls
Chapter 7.2 Pitched roofs.
Chapter 7.1 Flat roofs, porches and balconies
Fixing
Plasterboard should be fixed to:
timber using plasterboard nails or drywall screws
masonry using adhesive dabs.
top shelf
9.2
Dry lining to receive ceramic wall tiling should be supported in accordance withTable 9 or the guidance given in BS 8212.
Table 9: Board fixing guidance for walls to receive ceramic tiles
Description Board thickness Support centres Additional support Maximum Comments
(mm) (mm) height (mm)
Timber frame 12.5, 15 400-450 No 3 600
(including stud walling) 600 Timber noggings 600mm 3 600
centres (measured vertically)
Timber battens 12.5, 15 400 Battens at head, base and 3 600
intermediate positions not
exceeding 1200mm centres
Direct bond 9.5 450 dabs of Horizontal dabs at 3 600 Complete at
adhesive in rows mid-storey height least 10 days
before tiling
Independent steel 2 x 12.5 400 Mid-point support 3 000
stud lining, 48mm or 60mm
48mm metal stud partitions 15 400 2 700
2 x 12.5 each side, 400 3 600
or 2 x 15 each side
70mm metal stud partitions 15 400 3 600
2 x 12.5 each side, 400 3 600
or 2 x 15 each side
146mm metal stud partitions 2 x 15 each side 600 Additional stud at 300mm up 3 600
to tile height
9.2
Where the backing surface contains soluble salts, and where cement mortar is used as an adhesive, precautions should be taken,
such as the use of mortar with sulfate-resisting cement.
Gypsum plasters should not be used where:
repeated or persistent heating occurs, e.g.on flues or near
repeated or persistent wetting mayoccur.
heat sources
Tiles should be appropriate for their location and intended use. When specifying tiles, consideration should be given to:
surface finish
edge shape
size and thickness
fittings (coves, skirtings, etc.)
colour
accessories (soap tray, paper holder,hooks, etc.).
Tiles should be:
fixed in accordance with manufacturers instructions
solidly bedded in water-resistant adhesive on a
suitable for the location, intended use and background; their
moisture-resistant background, where frequent
weight on lightweight plaster should not exceed 20kg/m2 wetting occurs.
fixed according to the background, using cement mortar or
proprietary adhesive
When tiling:
courses should be straight and even to form a plane and
spacing should besufficient to allow for expansion
regular surface, especially around fittings and fixtures up to sanitary fittings and fixings, the sealing method should
there should be no cut or unfinished tilesat exposed edges
be in accordance with the design and account for movement
or external corners proprietary water-resistant grouting shouldbe used in
joints should be even and cut neatly
accordance with the manufacturersrecommendations.
9.2
9.3.1 Compliance 01
9.3.2 Provision of information 01
9.3.3 Insulation 01
9.3.4 Screed 01
9.3.5 Ceramic, concrete, terrazzo
and similar tile finishes 03
9.3.6 Wood finishes 04
9.3.7 Flexible sheet and tile finishes 05
9.3.8 Asphalt finishes 06
9.3.9 Staircase finishes 06
Compliance 9.3.1 Also see: Chapters 2.1, 5.1, 5.2, 6.4 and 8.1
Floor finishes shall comply with the Technical Requirements.
Floor finishes which comply with the guidance in this chapter will generally be acceptable (structural floors should be in accordance
with the relevant Standards chapter).
Insulation 9.3.3
Thermal and acoustic insulation shall provide appropriate performance, and be suitable for the intended
location and use.
Materials and constructions which are in accordance with buildingregulations are generally acceptable.
Suitable sound insulation materials include:
flexible material
proprietary products which have been assessed in
mineral fibre quilt insulation
accordance with Technical Requirement R3.
board material for use under screeds (e.g. impact sound duty
(ISD) grade pre compressed expanded polystyrene)
Table 1: Thermal insulation materials
Material Standard Grade or description
EPS (expanded polystyrene) BS EN 13163 70
PUR (rigid polyurethane) BS 4841 For use under screeds
PIR (rigid polyisocyanurate)
Fibre building board BS 1142 Part 3 Insulating board (softboard)
Proprietary material Technical Requirement R3
Installation
Before screeding, background surfaces should be:
clean and free of debris (e.g. dust and gypsum removed);
suitably prepared to provide an adequate mechanical key,
concrete should be wetted and brushed where bonded screeds are required, cement grouting
or a bonding agent should be specified to provide
9.3
adequate adhesion.
water pipes
Non-structural screed over underfloor heating should:
be sub-divided into bays not exceeding40m2, with a
have expansion joints which are consistent with those in
maximum lengthof 8m, or installed per room the slab.
Where concrete floor slabs are to serve directly as a wearingsurface without anadditional topping, they should be in accordance
with BS 8204-2 and power floated.
Completed floor finishes should be protected against damage from traffic.
Standards relevant to screeding include:
BS 8204 Screeds, bases and in-situ floorings. Code of practice.
BS 8201 Code of practice for installation of flooring of wood and wood-based panels.
BS 8203 Code of practice for installation of resilient floor coverings.
For concrete ground-bearing floors, a maximum 20mm monolithic screedmay be acceptable as part of the requiredthickness.
Wood finishes 9.3.6 Also see: BS 5250 and BRE Report Thermal insulation: avoiding risks
Wood and wood-based flooring shall provide a suitable wearing surface for the location and intended use.
Issues to be taken into account include:
a) thermal insulation and DPMs
b) sound insulation
c) condition of the substrate
d) directly applied finishes
e) indirectly applied finishes.
Wood and wood-based flooring should be installed ensuring that:
services beneath thefloor finish are tested before the floor
wood finishes are conditioned tothe appropriate
is installed moisture content
underfloor heating is kept on, before and during the
where required, DPMs are incorporated, in accordance with
floor laying manufacturers recommendations and the design.
Standards relevant to wood floor finishes include:
BS 8201 Code of practice for installation of flooring of wood and wood-based panels.
BS 1187 Specification for wood blocksfor floors.
BS 4050 Specification for mosaicparquet panels.
BS 1202 Specification for nails.
BS 1297 Specification for tongued and grooved.
precast floor
ventilated void
Sound insulation
Floating floor finishes should be designed and constructed to:
isolate the floor finish from thesupporting floor and walls
avoid the use of fixings which penetratethe insulation layer
avoid excessive movement or squeaking
ensure there are no airpaths, especially at the perimeter.
Where flooring is to be installed on a resilientmaterial on a separating floor, edges should be isolated fromwalls and skirtings by a
resilient layer.
Where a floor relies on a soft floorcovering to provide the minimum standardof sound insulation, the covering should befixed
permanently in position.
Flexible sheet and tilefinishes 9.3.7 Also see: BS 5250 and BRE Report Thermal insulation: avoiding risks
Flexible sheet and tile finishes shall provide a suitable wearing surface for the location andintended use.
Flexible sheet and tile finishes should be:
installedin accordancewith the manufacturers
reasonably leveland smooth, particularly at doorways
recommendations, and generally be fully bonded and junctions
installed on a backing surface which is even and without high
fitted with skirtings, coves, coverstrips and other preformed
spots or cracks; where necessary, using a levelling underlay components, where required, and in accordance with the
of a type and thickness recommended by the flooring manufacturers recommendations.
manufacturer or in accordance with Table 4
9.3
The substrate should be sufficiently dry toprevent adverse effects on the flooring, and where:
there is a risk of trapping moistureor interstitial
flexible sheet or tile flooring is installedon ground bearing
condensation,permeable finishes should be used concrete floors, a DPMshould be incorporated to prevent
risingmoisture adversely affecting floor finishes.
When installing flexible sheet or tile flooring:
ensure underfloor services are not damaged
surplus adhesive should beremoved
it should be cut so that it fits neatly aroundfittings, pipes, etc.
welded joints should be providedin accordance withthe
adhesives should be spreadevenly and leftfor the correct
manufacturers recommendations
period of time to ensure fullbonding adjustment afterinitial contraction or expansion should
the surface should be pressed downfirmly, loaded or rolled
bemade where necessary.
as necessary to preventcurling, lifting or bubbling
Standards relevant to flexible sheet and tile finishes include:
BS EN ISO 10581 Resilient floor coverings. Homogeneous poly(vinyl chloride) floor covering
BS EN ISO 10595 Resilient floor coverings. Semi-flexible/vinylcomposition (VCT) poly(vinyl chloride) floor tiles
BS EN 650 Resilient floor coverings. Polyvinyl chloride floor coverings on jute backing or on polyester felt backing or on
a polyester felt with a polyvinyl chloride backing
BS EN 651 Resilient floor coverings. Polyvinyl chloride floorcoverings with foam layer
BS EN 12104 Resilient floor coverings. Cork floor tiles
BS 8203 Code of practice for installation of resilient floor coverings.
manufacturers recommendations.
9.4.1 Compliance 01
9.4.2 Provision of information 01
9.4.3 General provisions cupboards and fitments 01
9.4.4 Finishings and internal trim 01
9.4.5 Joinery 02
9.4.6 Airing cupboards, cupboards,
worktops and fitments 02
9.4.7 Ironmongery, prefabricated items
and other materials 02
9.4.8 Protection and handover 03
A depth of 600mm can be assumed for appliances (where intended but not provided).
Space or facilities for laundering andcleaning items may be provided outside the kitchen area.
Space should be provided for general storage, clothes, linen and bedding. Airing cupboards are required in homeswhich do not
have central or whole homeheating.
Shelving supports should be fixed securely and so that shelves are level.
Joinery 9.4.5
Wood and wood-based materials shall be of the quality and dimensions required by the design.
Joinery and the materials used should be installed to established standards of workmanship, and have no visible defects after the
finish has been applied. Issues that should be taken into account include:
fit and construction of joints (including finger joints)
construction of moving parts
gluing and laminating
surface finishes.
Relevant standards include:
BS EN 942 Timber in joinery. General requirements
BS EN 312 Particleboards
BS 1186 Timber for and workmanship in joinery.
Ironmongery, prefabricated Items and other similar materials shall be suitable for the intended use.
Relavant standards include:
BS EN 1935 Building hardware. Single-axis hinges.
9.5.1 Compliance 01
9.5.2 Provision of information 01
9.5.3 Storage 01
9.5.4 Conditions for painting and decorating 01
9.5.5 Timber 01
9.5.6 Steel 02
9.5.7 Walls 02
9.5.8 Wallpapering 03
9.5.9 Other surfaces 03
9.5.10 Completed painting and decorating 03
Storage 9.5.3
Materials for painting and decorating shall beadequately protected from the cold.
Painting and decorating materials should:
be protected against frost beforeuse not be used where they have been damaged by frost.
Timber 9.5.5
The painting and decorating of timber and timber-based materials shall be compatible with the
species of timber, provide adequate protection and be suitable for the intended useand location.
Prefabricated components and joinery shall be finished to asuitable quality, and protected.
When painting or decorating timber, the moisture content should be a maximum of 18%.
Paintand paint systems should be used in accordance withthe manufacturers recommendations, and be compatiblewith the
surface to be decorated.
Preparation should ensure:
door and window furniture is removed
sharp arrises arerubbed down (to enable an even coating)
unsound wood, loose or highly resinousknots, etc.
surfaces are free fromdirt, dust and moisture
are cut out, replaced andmade good where there is deterioration ofthe primer or seal coat,
raised grains, tool and machine marks are removed
surfaces are rubbed downand a second coat applied
9.5
One full round coat of primer should be applied to all surfaces to be painted, including:
hidden surfaces of external woodwork
rebates for glazing and backs of glazing beads.
cut ends of external woodwork
for woodwork
Paint or stain should be applied to external timber to provide protection and stability, even where the timber has been preservative
treated (unless the preservative treatment manufacturer confirms otherwise). Primer, paint and stain finishes should be compatible
with preservative treatment.
Undercoat and gloss should be applied ensuring that it provides a satisfactory finish, and:
it is not thinned (unless recommended by the manufacturer)
a minimum of one priming coat, one undercoat and
each application is a full round coat and surfaces are lightly
one finishing coat are used (unless an alternative
rubbed down with glasspaperbetween coats recommendation is made by the manufacturer)
each coat is applied within one month ofthe previous.
Stain and varnishes should be:
applied as recommended by themanufacturer to provide
applied whenthe substrate is dry
appropriate cover suitablefor the species of timber.
applied to surfaces which have been suitably prepared to
Steel 9.5.6
Steelwork shall be coated to provide adequate protection and be suitable for the intended useand location.
Decorative finishes may be applied to galvanised steel following suitable preparation with a mordant wash.
Decorative finishes applied to steelwork that has been protected by coatings (including intumescent paint for fire resistance) in
accordance with Chapter 6.5 Steelwork, must be compatible with the protective coating. The manufacturers recommendations
should be followed. Any damage to the protective coatings should be made good prior to decorative finishes being applied.
Walls 9.5.7
Walls shall be finished to provide an even and consistent appearance, to established levels of workmanship.
Issues to be taken into account include:
a) external masonry and rendering b) plaster and plasterboard surfaces.
9.5
Where bricks have no upper limit on their soluble salt content, the brick manufacturers writtenagreement to the application of a
finish should be obtained.
Where the decorative system is part of the weather resistance of the rendering, it should be assessed in accordance with
Technical Requirement R3.
Where surfaces have varying suction, they should be stabilised with a treatment recommended by themanufacturer.
Wallpapering 9.5.8
Wallpapering shall be finished to provide an even and consistent appearance, to established levels
of workmanship.
Where wallpaper or coverings are used:
surfaces should be dry, even and smooth before wallpaper
they should be properly aligned and neatly fixed
is applied electrical switch plates should be temporarily removed and
surfaces should be sized or sealed as necessary
the papering accurately trimmed so that it will tuck behind
adhesives should be in accordance with the wallpaper
the fitting upon completion.
manufacturers recommendations
brush marks, and the background or undercoat should not badly applied
be visible protected against dirt and damage until handover.
10.1.1 Compliance 01
10.1.2 Provision of information 01
10.1.3 Garage foundations 01
10.1.4 Garage floors 02
10.1.5 Garage walls 03
10.1.6 Resistance to fire spread 03
10.1.7 Security 04
10.1.8 Doors and windows 04
10.1.9 Garage roofs 04
10.1.10 Permanent prefabricated garages
and carports 05
10.1.11 Services 05
Hazardous ground
For foundations on hazardous ground, the following chapters are relevant:
4.1 Land quality managing ground conditions.
4.4 Raft, pile, pier and beam foundations.
4.2 Building near trees.
Any existing fill on the site of the garage should be examined and identified. Where any potential health hazard or risk of damage is
indicated, appropriate precautions should be taken, as described in the following chapters:
4.1 Land quality managing ground conditions.
5.1 Substructure and ground-bearing floors.
Type of foundation required for integral/attached garages
Foundations for integral or attached garages should be the same as those for the home, unless proper consideration is given to
each foundation, and the possibility of differential movement between them.
min. 300mm
should be provided.
Adjacent structures
Foundations for garages should not impair the stability of the home or any other adjacent structure.
Underground services
Garage foundations that are to be above or near services should be constructed so that no excessive settlement of foundations or
damage to services occurs (see Chapter 5.3 Drainage below ground).
Unless ventilation is specifically required, the void beneath a garage floor which is suspended precast concrete may be
unventilated where:
the floor has adequate durability
there is unlikely to be a build-up of soil gases.
the ground beneath is well drained
Floor drainage
When practicable, garage floors should to be laid to falls to ensure that water or spillage is directed out of the garage via the
vehicle doorway.
Structural topping
Where reinforced screeds are to be incorporated as structural topping, they should be designed by an engineer in accordance with
Technical Requirement R5.
10.1
home
fire-resisting fire-resisting
wall partition
Security 10.1.7
Garages shall be constructed to provide reasonable security against unauthorised entry, in particular where
garages are linked.
Where garages of different ownership are linked, walls should prevent direct access from one garage to another.
Robustness
Frames should be selected and fixed having taken into account the type and weight of the garage door.
Ease of operation
Proprietary doors and door gear should be installed in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations.
Care should be taken to ensure that garage doors are in proper working order at handover.
Bracing
The building designer should specify all bracing. Trussed rafter roofs should be braced in accordance with Chapter 7.2
Pitched roofs, unless the roof is designed and braced in accordance with PD 6693-1.
All timber bracing to trussed rafters should be at least 100mm x 25mm in section and nailed twice to each trussed rafter.
Nailing should be 3.35mm (10 gauge) x 65mm long galvanized round wire nails.
10.1
Detailing at abutments
Precautions should be taken at abutments between a garage roof and the main building or between stepped garages, including:
flashings and weatherproofing that allow for
cavity trays that divert water from inside the cavity to the
differential movement external surface of the roof.
cover flashings formed from metal or other
approved material
Movement
Movement joints in foundations and the structure should be continued through roof coverings and be provided with appropriate
weather protection.
Services 10.1.11
The provision of any service or appliance within a garage shall be in accordance with relevant regulations.
Issues to be taken into account include:
a) protection of water services against frost c) risk of fire or explosion.
b) provision of electricity
Where services or appliances are provided in garages, they should comply with the guidance below and with the following chapters,
as appropriate:
5.3 Drainage below ground
8.1 Internal services.
Protection of water services against frost
A rising main should not be located within a garage.
A water supply or outlet in a garage should have adequate provision for isolating and draining down.
Pipes should be insulated and located so as to minimise the risk of freezing.
Provision of electricity
The provision of electric lighting and socket outlets in a garage is at the discretion of the builder.
All electrical installations should comply with BS 7671 Requirements for Electrical Installations. IET Wiring Regulations.
statutory regulations.
10.2.1 Compliance 01
10.2.2 Provision of information 01
10.2.3 Stability 01
10.2.4 Freestanding walls and retaining structures 01
10.2.5 Guarding and steps 01
10.2.6 Drives, paths and landscaping 02
10.2.7 Materials 06
10.2.8 Garden areas 07
10.2.9 Waterlogging 07
10.2.10 Timber decking 07
10.2.11 Landscaping 07
Stability 10.2.3
Precautions shall be taken to ensure stability of theground.
Where the ground may become surcharged during construction, precautions should be taken to ensure stability.
Gabion and timber structures should not be used to provide support to homes, garages, roads, drives, car parking areas or
drainage systems.
Retaining structures that give support to the foundations of a home should be completed before work starts on the construction of
the foundations of the home.
All retaining structures, more than 600mm high, should be designed by an engineer in accordance with Technical Requirement R5.
Where timber structures more than 600mm high are used for retaining ground in boundary situations, they should be designed with
a desired service life of 60 years.
Where planters are provided, they should be designed to support the volume of retained soil and the plant species.
be reasonably uniform.
Underground drainage or services that are below a private road, shared privatedrive, private drive, car parking area, path or patio
should be protected against damage, as described in Chapter 5.3 Drainage below ground.
Edge restraint or kerbing should have a profile and foundation, which is suitable to form a permanent supporting edge for the
expected vehicle loads on the road or drive.
Pedestrian access should be provided within the curtilage of each home to the main entrance and thesecondary entrance
where present:
Where entry to the home can begained directly from a
Where a garage, carport or car parking areais provided
garage, a path to a secondary access door is not required. within the curtilage, a pathshould be provided to it from
Where the secondary entrance is to a mid-terrace home
the home.
or ground floor flat, a path to a secondary access door is
notrequired.
Where appropriate, a drive can beregarded as a path for the provision of access.
Paths should have a maximum slope of 1:6. On steeper sloping ground, stepsmay be required.
Table 1: Suitable path widths
Location and use Minimum width (mm)
Within curtilage to main entrance, or any entrance designated by Building Regulations. 900
Paths used for the removal of refuse to the collection point. 900
Paths adjoining a home. 700
Paths 100mm or morefrom the wall of a home. 600
All other cases. 600
Drainage
Private roads, shared private drives andprivate drives should have adequate rainwater drainage and disposal.
Paved areas should:
have vertical alignment, finished levels,
have surfaces with a minimum finished fall of 1:80
transition arrangements and gradients in accordance where they form private drives and paths
with the design drain away from the home (and garage), or drain to a
have surfaces with adequate falls, cross-falls and drainage
channel or other suitable means of collection and disposal
toensure that surface water is suitably drained adjacent to the home
have sub-base levels with the samelongitudinal gradient
not drain surface water from private areas onto
and cross-fall as the finished level adopted areas
have surfaces not flatter than 1:40 or have a camber of 1:40
not be within 2m of a soakaway.
where no fall is available to avoid flat spots
Where paving slabs are laid abutting drainage channels and gully grates, etc., the upper surface of the paving slab should be set
approximately 5mm above the grating.
Where it is intended to use porous orpermeable surfaces as part, or all, of the rainwater drainage system, reference should be
made to CIRIA report C522 Sustainable urban drainage systems design manual for England and Wales.
10.2
Construction details
The construction of private roads, shared private drives, private drives and car parking areas should be constructed in accordance
with the tables below, or anequivalent alternative.
Table 2a: Private road having frequent use by commercial vehicles
Construction(1) Road type
Road Road Footpath
(bituminous (block pavers) (bituminous
macadam) macadam)
Sub-base Granular sub-base material type 1 to Table 3 Where California Bearing 225(3)
clause 803 table 8/2 MCHW Volume 1 Ratio (CBR) is 5% or less
Series 800(2) = 150(3)
Where CBR is greater than
5% = Table 3
Base Dense bituminous macadam (100/150 pen 100 (0/32mm size N/A N/A
(road base) paving grade bitumen) with crushed rock to clause 5.2)
aggregate to BS 4987 (group 1 mix)
Concrete designation (BS 8500-2 table 7) N/A N/A N/A
Binder course Dense bituminous macadam (100/150 pen 60 (0/20mm size 60 (0/20mm size to 60 (0/20mm
(base course) paving grade bitumen) with crushed rock to clause 6.5) clause 6.5) size to
aggregate to BS 4987 (group 2 mix) clause 6.5)
Surface course Dense bituminous macadam (100/150 pen 30 (0/10mm size N/A 20 (0/6mm
(wearing course) paving grade bitumen) with crushed rock to clause 7.4) size to
aggregate to BS 4987 (group 3 mix) clause 7.5)
Hot rolled asphalt to BS 594-1 40 (designation N/A N/A
30% 0/14)
Mastic asphalt to BS 1447 30 (grade S 40% N/A N/A
0/10mm size)
Concrete designation (BS 8500-2 table 7) N/A N/A N/A
Bedding course Sharp sand to BS 7533-3 category II of N/A 50 N/A
annex D
Pavers Block pavers to BS 6717 of class markings N/A 80 N/A
W2, A2 and S3 (weathering, abrasion and
slip/skid classes)(6)
Table 2b: Shared parking and associated access areas having frequent use by commercial vehicles
Construction(1) Road type
Bituminous macadam Block pavers
Sub-base Granular sub-base material type 1 to clause 803 table 8/2 MCHW Table 3 Table 3
Volume 1 Series 800(2)
Base Dense bituminous macadam (100/150 pen paving grade bitumen) 80 (0/32mm size to N/A
(road base) with crushed rock aggregate to BS 4987 (group 1 mix) clause 5.2)
Concrete designation (BS 8500-2 table 7) 100 grade GEN2(4) N/A
Binder course Dense bituminous macadam (100/150 pen paving grade bitumen) 60 (0/20mm size to N/A
(base course) with crushed rock aggregate to BS 4987 (group 3 mix) clause 6.5)
Surface course Dense bituminous macadam (100/150 pen paving grade bitumen) 30 (0/10mm size to N/A
(wearing course) with crushed rock aggregate to BS 4987 (group 2 mix) clause 7.4)
Hot rolled asphalt to BS 594-1 N/A N/A
Mastic asphalt to BS 1447 N/A N/A
Concrete designation (BS 8500-2 table 7) N/A N/A
Bedding course Sharp sand to BS 7533-3 category II of annex D N/A 50
Pavers Block pavers to BS 6717 of class markings W2, A2 and S3 N/A 80
(weathering, abrasion and slip/skid classes)(6)
10.2
Table 2d: Private drives and parking areas having use by cars and light vehicles
Construction(1) Road type
Bituminous macadam Concrete Block Gravel
pavers
Sub-base Granular sub-base material type 1 to clause 803 table Table 3 Table 3 Table 3 Table 3
8/2 MCHW Volume 1 Series 800(2)
Base Dense bituminous macadam (100/150 pen paving N/A N/A N/A N/A
(road base) grade bitumen) with crushed rock aggregate to
BS 4987 (group 1 mix)
Concrete designation (BS 8500-2 table 7) N/A N/A N/A N/A
Binder course Dense bituminous macadam (100/150 pen paving 60 (0/20 mm size to N/A N/A N/A
(base course) grade bitumen) with crushed rock aggregate to clause 6.5)
BS 4987 (group 2 mix)
Surface course Dense bituminous macadam (100/150 pen paving 20 (0/6mm size to N/A N/A (7)
Concrete paths and patios should be not less than 75mm thick and have a tamped or textured finish. The concrete mix should
be suitable to give a durable and frost resistant surface, as described in Chapter 3.1 Concrete and its reinforcement. Movement
joints, not less than 10mm wide, should be provided across the full width of the path at not more than 4m centres. A movement
joint is not required at the abutment with a wall unless the opposite edge of the concrete is also restrained.
Materials 10.2.7
Materials shall be suitable for their intended use. Concrete shall be of a mix design which will achieve
sufficient strength for its purpose and be sufficiently durable to remain unaffected by chemical or frost
action.
Sub-base material should be type 1 to clause 803 Table 8/2, MCHW Volume I Series 800.
Hot rolled and mastic asphalts and macadam should comply with relevantstandards, including:
BS EN 13108-1 Bituminous mixtures. Material specifications. Asphalt Concrete.
BS EN 13108-4 Bituminous mixtures. Material specifications. Hot Rolled Asphalt.
Aggregates used in asphalt and macadam mixtures and unbound aggregate (graded 15/20mm gravel) for surfacing should comply
with relevant standards, including:
BS EN 13043 Aggregates for bituminous mixtures and surface treatments for roads, airfields and other
trafficked areas.
PD 6682-2 Guidance on the use of BS EN 13043.
BS EN 13242 Aggregates for unbound and hydraulically bound materials.
PD 6682-6 Guidance on the use of BS EN 13242.
Blocks, slabs, pavers, edgings, etc. should comply with relevant standards, including:
BS EN 771 Specification for masonry units.
BS EN 1344 Clay pavers. Requirements and test methods.
BS EN 1339 Concrete paving flags. Requirements and test methods.
BS 7533 Pavements constructed with clay natural stone or concrete pavers.
Topsoil should be of a quality that will not present a hazard to users of the garden area. BS 3882 and the Contaminated Land
Exposure Assessment (CLEA) guidelines provide advice on determining the suitability of topsoil.
10.2
10.2.8
Garden areas within 3m of the home
In order to provide for adequate access to and utility immediately around the home areas up to 3m from the
habitable parts of the home shall not be waterlogged.
Waterlogging of garden areas within 3m of the habitable parts of the home should be prevented by drainage or other suitable
means.
Subsoil should not be placed over topsoil. Construction rubbish and debris should be removed from the garden and other areas
around the home.
Access is not required to small isolated garden areas, such as narrow strips of land at the top or bottom of retaining walls, but
should be provided to other areas where appropriate by steps or other suitable means.
Landscaping 10.2.11
Planting shall be completedin a manner appropriate for the siteconditions and layout. Possible future
damage to the home caused by planting shall be minimised.
Where trees or shrubs have been removed, are to be retained or are to be planted by the builder, precautions should be taken to
reduce the risk of future damage to homes and services in accordance with Chapter 4.2 Building near trees.
10.2